doc: document 'cmsis-dap cmd' command
[openocd.git] / doc / openocd.texi
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c %**start of header
3 @setfilename openocd.info
4 @settitle OpenOCD User's Guide
5 @dircategory Development
6 @direntry
7 * OpenOCD: (openocd). OpenOCD User's Guide
8 @end direntry
9 @paragraphindent 0
10 @c %**end of header
11
12 @include version.texi
13
14 @copying
15
16 This User's Guide documents
17 release @value{VERSION},
18 dated @value{UPDATED},
19 of the Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD).
20
21 @itemize @bullet
22 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 The OpenOCD Project
23 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2007-2008 Spencer Oliver @email{spen@@spen-soft.co.uk}
24 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008-2010 Oyvind Harboe @email{oyvind.harboe@@zylin.com}
25 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 Duane Ellis @email{openocd@@duaneellis.com}
26 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2009-2010 David Brownell
27 @end itemize
28
29 @quotation
30 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
31 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.2 or
32 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
33 Invariant Sections, no Front-Cover Texts, and no Back-Cover Texts. A
34 copy of the license is included in the section entitled ``GNU Free
35 Documentation License''.
36 @end quotation
37 @end copying
38
39 @titlepage
40 @titlefont{@emph{Open On-Chip Debugger:}}
41 @sp 1
42 @title OpenOCD User's Guide
43 @subtitle for release @value{VERSION}
44 @subtitle @value{UPDATED}
45
46 @page
47 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
48 @insertcopying
49 @end titlepage
50
51 @summarycontents
52 @contents
53
54 @ifnottex
55 @node Top
56 @top OpenOCD User's Guide
57
58 @insertcopying
59 @end ifnottex
60
61 @menu
62 * About:: About OpenOCD
63 * Developers:: OpenOCD Developer Resources
64 * Debug Adapter Hardware:: Debug Adapter Hardware
65 * About Jim-Tcl:: About Jim-Tcl
66 * Running:: Running OpenOCD
67 * OpenOCD Project Setup:: OpenOCD Project Setup
68 * Config File Guidelines:: Config File Guidelines
69 * Server Configuration:: Server Configuration
70 * Debug Adapter Configuration:: Debug Adapter Configuration
71 * Reset Configuration:: Reset Configuration
72 * TAP Declaration:: TAP Declaration
73 * CPU Configuration:: CPU Configuration
74 * Flash Commands:: Flash Commands
75 * Flash Programming:: Flash Programming
76 * PLD/FPGA Commands:: PLD/FPGA Commands
77 * General Commands:: General Commands
78 * Architecture and Core Commands:: Architecture and Core Commands
79 * JTAG Commands:: JTAG Commands
80 * Boundary Scan Commands:: Boundary Scan Commands
81 * Utility Commands:: Utility Commands
82 * GDB and OpenOCD:: Using GDB and OpenOCD
83 * Tcl Scripting API:: Tcl Scripting API
84 * FAQ:: Frequently Asked Questions
85 * Tcl Crash Course:: Tcl Crash Course
86 * License:: GNU Free Documentation License
87
88 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
89 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
90 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
91 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
92 * OpenOCD Concept Index:: Concept Index
93 * Command and Driver Index:: Command and Driver Index
94 @end menu
95
96 @node About
97 @unnumbered About
98 @cindex about
99
100 OpenOCD was created by Dominic Rath as part of a 2005 diploma thesis written
101 at the University of Applied Sciences Augsburg (@uref{http://www.hs-augsburg.de}).
102 Since that time, the project has grown into an active open-source project,
103 supported by a diverse community of software and hardware developers from
104 around the world.
105
106 @section What is OpenOCD?
107 @cindex TAP
108 @cindex JTAG
109
110 The Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD) aims to provide debugging,
111 in-system programming and boundary-scan testing for embedded target
112 devices.
113
114 It does so with the assistance of a @dfn{debug adapter}, which is
115 a small hardware module which helps provide the right kind of
116 electrical signaling to the target being debugged. These are
117 required since the debug host (on which OpenOCD runs) won't
118 usually have native support for such signaling, or the connector
119 needed to hook up to the target.
120
121 Such debug adapters support one or more @dfn{transport} protocols,
122 each of which involves different electrical signaling (and uses
123 different messaging protocols on top of that signaling). There
124 are many types of debug adapter, and little uniformity in what
125 they are called. (There are also product naming differences.)
126
127 These adapters are sometimes packaged as discrete dongles, which
128 may generically be called @dfn{hardware interface dongles}.
129 Some development boards also integrate them directly, which may
130 let the development board connect directly to the debug
131 host over USB (and sometimes also to power it over USB).
132
133 For example, a @dfn{JTAG Adapter} supports JTAG
134 signaling, and is used to communicate
135 with JTAG (IEEE 1149.1) compliant TAPs on your target board.
136 A @dfn{TAP} is a ``Test Access Port'', a module which processes
137 special instructions and data. TAPs are daisy-chained within and
138 between chips and boards. JTAG supports debugging and boundary
139 scan operations.
140
141 There are also @dfn{SWD Adapters} that support Serial Wire Debug (SWD)
142 signaling to communicate with some newer ARM cores, as well as debug
143 adapters which support both JTAG and SWD transports. SWD supports only
144 debugging, whereas JTAG also supports boundary scan operations.
145
146 For some chips, there are also @dfn{Programming Adapters} supporting
147 special transports used only to write code to flash memory, without
148 support for on-chip debugging or boundary scan.
149 (At this writing, OpenOCD does not support such non-debug adapters.)
150
151
152 @b{Dongles:} OpenOCD currently supports many types of hardware dongles:
153 USB-based, parallel port-based, and other standalone boxes that run
154 OpenOCD internally. @xref{Debug Adapter Hardware}.
155
156 @b{GDB Debug:} It allows ARM7 (ARM7TDMI and ARM720t), ARM9 (ARM920T,
157 ARM922T, ARM926EJ--S, ARM966E--S), XScale (PXA25x, IXP42x), Cortex-M3
158 (Stellaris LM3, STMicroelectronics STM32 and Energy Micro EFM32) and
159 Intel Quark (x10xx) based cores to be debugged via the GDB protocol.
160
161 @b{Flash Programming:} Flash writing is supported for external
162 CFI-compatible NOR flashes (Intel and AMD/Spansion command set) and several
163 internal flashes (LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4300, AT91SAM7, AT91SAM3U,
164 STR7x, STR9x, LM3, STM32x and EFM32). Preliminary support for various NAND flash
165 controllers (LPC3180, Orion, S3C24xx, more) is included.
166
167 @section OpenOCD Web Site
168
169 The OpenOCD web site provides the latest public news from the community:
170
171 @uref{http://openocd.org/}
172
173 @section Latest User's Guide:
174
175 The user's guide you are now reading may not be the latest one
176 available. A version for more recent code may be available.
177 Its HTML form is published regularly at:
178
179 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/html/index.html}
180
181 PDF form is likewise published at:
182
183 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/pdf/openocd.pdf}
184
185 @section OpenOCD User's Forum
186
187 There is an OpenOCD forum (phpBB) hosted by SparkFun,
188 which might be helpful to you. Note that if you want
189 anything to come to the attention of developers, you
190 should post it to the OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
191 instead of this forum.
192
193 @uref{http://forum.sparkfun.com/viewforum.php?f=18}
194
195 @section OpenOCD User's Mailing List
196
197 The OpenOCD User Mailing List provides the primary means of
198 communication between users:
199
200 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-user}
201
202 @section OpenOCD IRC
203
204 Support can also be found on irc:
205 @uref{irc://irc.libera.chat/openocd}
206
207 @node Developers
208 @chapter OpenOCD Developer Resources
209 @cindex developers
210
211 If you are interested in improving the state of OpenOCD's debugging and
212 testing support, new contributions will be welcome. Motivated developers
213 can produce new target, flash or interface drivers, improve the
214 documentation, as well as more conventional bug fixes and enhancements.
215
216 The resources in this chapter are available for developers wishing to explore
217 or expand the OpenOCD source code.
218
219 @section OpenOCD Git Repository
220
221 During the 0.3.x release cycle, OpenOCD switched from Subversion to
222 a Git repository hosted at SourceForge. The repository URL is:
223
224 @uref{git://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
225
226 or via http
227
228 @uref{http://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
229
230 You may prefer to use a mirror and the HTTP protocol:
231
232 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/r/openocd.git}
233
234 With standard Git tools, use @command{git clone} to initialize
235 a local repository, and @command{git pull} to update it.
236 There are also gitweb pages letting you browse the repository
237 with a web browser, or download arbitrary snapshots without
238 needing a Git client:
239
240 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/w/openocd.git}
241
242 The @file{README} file contains the instructions for building the project
243 from the repository or a snapshot.
244
245 Developers that want to contribute patches to the OpenOCD system are
246 @b{strongly} encouraged to work against mainline.
247 Patches created against older versions may require additional
248 work from their submitter in order to be updated for newer releases.
249
250 @section Doxygen Developer Manual
251
252 During the 0.2.x release cycle, the OpenOCD project began
253 providing a Doxygen reference manual. This document contains more
254 technical information about the software internals, development
255 processes, and similar documentation:
256
257 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/html/index.html}
258
259 This document is a work-in-progress, but contributions would be welcome
260 to fill in the gaps. All of the source files are provided in-tree,
261 listed in the Doxyfile configuration at the top of the source tree.
262
263 @section Gerrit Review System
264
265 All changes in the OpenOCD Git repository go through the web-based Gerrit
266 Code Review System:
267
268 @uref{https://review.openocd.org/}
269
270 After a one-time registration and repository setup, anyone can push commits
271 from their local Git repository directly into Gerrit.
272 All users and developers are encouraged to review, test, discuss and vote
273 for changes in Gerrit. The feedback provides the basis for a maintainer to
274 eventually submit the change to the main Git repository.
275
276 The @file{HACKING} file, also available as the Patch Guide in the Doxygen
277 Developer Manual, contains basic information about how to connect a
278 repository to Gerrit, prepare and push patches. Patch authors are expected to
279 maintain their changes while they're in Gerrit, respond to feedback and if
280 necessary rework and push improved versions of the change.
281
282 @section OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
283
284 The OpenOCD Developer Mailing List provides the primary means of
285 communication between developers:
286
287 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-devel}
288
289 @section OpenOCD Bug Tracker
290
291 The OpenOCD Bug Tracker is hosted on SourceForge:
292
293 @uref{http://bugs.openocd.org/}
294
295
296 @node Debug Adapter Hardware
297 @chapter Debug Adapter Hardware
298 @cindex dongles
299 @cindex FTDI
300 @cindex wiggler
301 @cindex printer port
302 @cindex USB Adapter
303 @cindex RTCK
304
305 Defined: @b{dongle}: A small device that plugs into a computer and serves as
306 an adapter .... [snip]
307
308 In the OpenOCD case, this generally refers to @b{a small adapter} that
309 attaches to your computer via USB or the parallel port.
310
311
312 @section Choosing a Dongle
313
314 There are several things you should keep in mind when choosing a dongle.
315
316 @enumerate
317 @item @b{Transport} Does it support the kind of communication that you need?
318 OpenOCD focuses mostly on JTAG. Your version may also support
319 other ways to communicate with target devices.
320 @item @b{Voltage} What voltage is your target - 1.8, 2.8, 3.3, or 5V?
321 Does your dongle support it? You might need a level converter.
322 @item @b{Pinout} What pinout does your target board use?
323 Does your dongle support it? You may be able to use jumper
324 wires, or an "octopus" connector, to convert pinouts.
325 @item @b{Connection} Does your computer have the USB, parallel, or
326 Ethernet port needed?
327 @item @b{RTCK} Do you expect to use it with ARM chips and boards with
328 RTCK support (also known as ``adaptive clocking'')?
329 @end enumerate
330
331 @section USB FT2232 Based
332
333 There are many USB JTAG dongles on the market, many of them based
334 on a chip from ``Future Technology Devices International'' (FTDI)
335 known as the FTDI FT2232; this is a USB full speed (12 Mbps) chip.
336 See: @url{http://www.ftdichip.com} for more information.
337 In summer 2009, USB high speed (480 Mbps) versions of these FTDI
338 chips started to become available in JTAG adapters. Around 2012, a new
339 variant appeared - FT232H - this is a single-channel version of FT2232H.
340 (Adapters using those high speed FT2232H or FT232H chips may support adaptive
341 clocking.)
342
343 The FT2232 chips are flexible enough to support some other
344 transport options, such as SWD or the SPI variants used to
345 program some chips. They have two communications channels,
346 and one can be used for a UART adapter at the same time the
347 other one is used to provide a debug adapter.
348
349 Also, some development boards integrate an FT2232 chip to serve as
350 a built-in low-cost debug adapter and USB-to-serial solution.
351
352 @itemize @bullet
353 @item @b{usbjtag}
354 @* Link @url{http://elk.informatik.fh-augsburg.de/hhweb/doc/openocd/usbjtag/usbjtag.html}
355 @item @b{jtagkey}
356 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey.shtml}
357 @item @b{jtagkey2}
358 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey2.shtml}
359 @item @b{oocdlink}
360 @* See: @url{http://www.oocdlink.com} By Joern Kaipf
361 @item @b{signalyzer}
362 @* See: @url{http://www.signalyzer.com}
363 @item @b{Stellaris Eval Boards}
364 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - The Stellaris eval boards
365 bundle FT2232-based JTAG and SWD support, which can be used to debug
366 the Stellaris chips. Using separate JTAG adapters is optional.
367 These boards can also be used in a "pass through" mode as JTAG adapters
368 to other target boards, disabling the Stellaris chip.
369 @item @b{TI/Luminary ICDI}
370 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - TI/Luminary In-Circuit Debug
371 Interface (ICDI) Boards are included in Stellaris LM3S9B9x
372 Evaluation Kits. Like the non-detachable FT2232 support on the other
373 Stellaris eval boards, they can be used to debug other target boards.
374 @item @b{olimex-jtag}
375 @* See: @url{http://www.olimex.com}
376 @item @b{Flyswatter/Flyswatter2}
377 @* See: @url{http://www.tincantools.com}
378 @item @b{turtelizer2}
379 @* See:
380 @uref{http://www.ethernut.de/en/hardware/turtelizer/index.html, Turtelizer 2}, or
381 @url{http://www.ethernut.de}
382 @item @b{comstick}
383 @* Link: @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=383}
384 @item @b{stm32stick}
385 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/stm32-stick}
386 @item @b{axm0432_jtag}
387 @* Axiom AXM-0432 Link @url{http://www.axman.com} - NOTE: This JTAG does not appear
388 to be available anymore as of April 2012.
389 @item @b{cortino}
390 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=cortino}
391 @item @b{dlp-usb1232h}
392 @* Link @url{http://www.dlpdesign.com/usb/usb1232h.shtml}
393 @item @b{digilent-hs1}
394 @* Link @url{http://www.digilentinc.com/Products/Detail.cfm?Prod=JTAG-HS1}
395 @item @b{opendous}
396 @* Link @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous/wiki/JTAG} FT2232H-based
397 (OpenHardware).
398 @item @b{JTAG-lock-pick Tiny 2}
399 @* Link @url{http://www.distortec.com/jtag-lock-pick-tiny-2} FT232H-based
400
401 @item @b{GW16042}
402 @* Link: @url{http://shop.gateworks.com/index.php?route=product/product&path=70_80&product_id=64}
403 FT2232H-based
404
405 @end itemize
406 @section USB-JTAG / Altera USB-Blaster compatibles
407
408 These devices also show up as FTDI devices, but are not
409 protocol-compatible with the FT2232 devices. They are, however,
410 protocol-compatible among themselves. USB-JTAG devices typically consist
411 of a FT245 followed by a CPLD that understands a particular protocol,
412 or emulates this protocol using some other hardware.
413
414 They may appear under different USB VID/PID depending on the particular
415 product. The driver can be configured to search for any VID/PID pair
416 (see the section on driver commands).
417
418 @itemize
419 @item @b{USB-JTAG} Kolja Waschk's USB Blaster-compatible adapter
420 @* Link: @url{http://ixo-jtag.sourceforge.net/}
421 @item @b{Altera USB-Blaster}
422 @* Link: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_usb_blstr.pdf}
423 @end itemize
424
425 @section USB J-Link based
426 There are several OEM versions of the SEGGER @b{J-Link} adapter. It is
427 an example of a microcontroller based JTAG adapter, it uses an
428 AT91SAM764 internally.
429
430 @itemize @bullet
431 @item @b{SEGGER J-Link}
432 @* Link: @url{http://www.segger.com/jlink.html}
433 @item @b{Atmel SAM-ICE} (Only works with Atmel chips!)
434 @* Link: @url{http://www.atmel.com/tools/atmelsam-ice.aspx}
435 @item @b{IAR J-Link}
436 @end itemize
437
438 @section USB RLINK based
439 Raisonance has an adapter called @b{RLink}. It exists in a stripped-down form on the STM32 Primer,
440 permanently attached to the JTAG lines. It also exists on the STM32 Primer2, but that is wired for
441 SWD and not JTAG, thus not supported.
442
443 @itemize @bullet
444 @item @b{Raisonance RLink}
445 @* Link: @url{http://www.mcu-raisonance.com/~rlink-debugger-programmer__@/microcontrollers__tool~tool__T018:4cn9ziz4bnx6.html}
446 @item @b{STM32 Primer}
447 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer.php}
448 @item @b{STM32 Primer2}
449 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer2.php}
450 @end itemize
451
452 @section USB ST-LINK based
453 STMicroelectronics has an adapter called @b{ST-LINK}.
454 They only work with STMicroelectronics chips, notably STM32 and STM8.
455
456 @itemize @bullet
457 @item @b{ST-LINK}
458 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32VLDISCOVERY.
459 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/219866.jsp}
460 @item @b{ST-LINK/V2}
461 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32F4DISCOVERY.
462 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/251168.jsp}
463 @item @b{STLINK-V3}
464 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits.
465 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/stlink-v3}
466 @end itemize
467
468 For info the original ST-LINK enumerates using the mass storage usb class; however,
469 its implementation is completely broken. The result is this causes issues under Linux.
470 The simplest solution is to get Linux to ignore the ST-LINK using one of the following methods:
471 @itemize @bullet
472 @item modprobe -r usb-storage && modprobe usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i
473 @item add "options usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i" to /etc/modprobe.conf
474 @end itemize
475
476 @section USB TI/Stellaris ICDI based
477 Texas Instruments has an adapter called @b{ICDI}.
478 It is not to be confused with the FTDI based adapters that were originally fitted to their
479 evaluation boards. This is the adapter fitted to the Stellaris LaunchPad.
480
481 @section USB Nuvoton Nu-Link
482 Nuvoton has an adapter called @b{Nu-Link}.
483 It is available either as stand-alone dongle and embedded on development boards.
484 It supports SWD, serial port bridge and mass storage for firmware update.
485 Both Nu-Link v1 and v2 are supported.
486
487 @section USB CMSIS-DAP based
488 ARM has released a interface standard called CMSIS-DAP that simplifies connecting
489 debuggers to ARM Cortex based targets @url{http://www.keil.com/support/man/docs/dapdebug/dapdebug_introduction.htm}.
490
491 @section USB Other
492 @itemize @bullet
493 @item @b{USBprog}
494 @* Link: @url{http://shop.embedded-projects.net/} - which uses an Atmel MEGA32 and a UBN9604
495
496 @item @b{USB - Presto}
497 @* Link: @url{http://tools.asix.net/prg_presto.htm}
498
499 @item @b{Versaloon-Link}
500 @* Link: @url{http://www.versaloon.com}
501
502 @item @b{ARM-JTAG-EW}
503 @* Link: @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag-ew.html}
504
505 @item @b{Buspirate}
506 @* Link: @url{http://dangerousprototypes.com/bus-pirate-manual/}
507
508 @item @b{opendous}
509 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous-jtag/} - which uses an AT90USB162
510
511 @item @b{estick}
512 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/estick-jtag/}
513
514 @item @b{Keil ULINK v1}
515 @* Link: @url{http://www.keil.com/ulink1/}
516
517 @item @b{TI XDS110 Debug Probe}
518 @* Link: @url{https://software-dl.ti.com/ccs/esd/documents/xdsdebugprobes/emu_xds110.html}
519 @* Link: @url{https://software-dl.ti.com/ccs/esd/documents/xdsdebugprobes/emu_xds_software_package_download.html#xds110-support-utilities}
520 @end itemize
521
522 @section IBM PC Parallel Printer Port Based
523
524 The two well-known ``JTAG Parallel Ports'' cables are the Xilinx DLC5
525 and the Macraigor Wiggler. There are many clones and variations of
526 these on the market.
527
528 Note that parallel ports are becoming much less common, so if you
529 have the choice you should probably avoid these adapters in favor
530 of USB-based ones.
531
532 @itemize @bullet
533
534 @item @b{Wiggler} - There are many clones of this.
535 @* Link: @url{http://www.macraigor.com/wiggler.htm}
536
537 @item @b{DLC5} - From XILINX - There are many clones of this
538 @* Link: Search the web for: ``XILINX DLC5'' - it is no longer
539 produced, PDF schematics are easily found and it is easy to make.
540
541 @item @b{Amontec - JTAG Accelerator}
542 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtag_accelerator.shtml}
543
544 @item @b{Wiggler2}
545 @* Link: @url{http://www.ccac.rwth-aachen.de/~michaels/index.php/hardware/armjtag}
546
547 @item @b{Wiggler_ntrst_inverted}
548 @* Yet another variation - See the source code, src/jtag/parport.c
549
550 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler}
551 @* Unknown - probably not on the market today
552
553 @item @b{arm-jtag}
554 @* Link: Most likely @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag.html} [another wiggler clone]
555
556 @item @b{chameleon}
557 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/chameleon.shtml}
558
559 @item @b{Triton}
560 @* Unknown.
561
562 @item @b{Lattice}
563 @* ispDownload from Lattice Semiconductor
564 @url{http://www.latticesemi.com/lit/docs/@/devtools/dlcable.pdf}
565
566 @item @b{flashlink}
567 @* From STMicroelectronics;
568 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/com/TECHNICAL_RESOURCES/TECHNICAL_LITERATURE/DATA_BRIEF/DM00039500.pdf}
569
570 @end itemize
571
572 @section Other...
573 @itemize @bullet
574
575 @item @b{ep93xx}
576 @* An EP93xx based Linux machine using the GPIO pins directly.
577
578 @item @b{at91rm9200}
579 @* Like the EP93xx - but an ATMEL AT91RM9200 based solution using the GPIO pins on the chip.
580
581 @item @b{bcm2835gpio}
582 @* A BCM2835-based board (e.g. Raspberry Pi) using the GPIO pins of the expansion header.
583
584 @item @b{imx_gpio}
585 @* A NXP i.MX-based board (e.g. Wandboard) using the GPIO pins (should work on any i.MX processor).
586
587 @item @b{jtag_vpi}
588 @* A JTAG driver acting as a client for the JTAG VPI server interface.
589 @* Link: @url{http://github.com/fjullien/jtag_vpi}
590
591 @item @b{jtag_dpi}
592 @* A JTAG driver acting as a client for the SystemVerilog Direct Programming
593 Interface (DPI) for JTAG devices. DPI allows OpenOCD to connect to the JTAG
594 interface of a hardware model written in SystemVerilog, for example, on an
595 emulation model of target hardware.
596
597 @item @b{xlnx_pcie_xvc}
598 @* A JTAG driver exposing Xilinx Virtual Cable over PCI Express to OpenOCD as JTAG/SWD interface.
599
600 @item @b{linuxgpiod}
601 @* A bitbang JTAG driver using Linux GPIO through library libgpiod.
602
603 @item @b{sysfsgpio}
604 @* A bitbang JTAG driver using Linux legacy sysfs GPIO.
605 This is deprecated from Linux v5.3; prefer using @b{linuxgpiod}.
606
607 @end itemize
608
609 @node About Jim-Tcl
610 @chapter About Jim-Tcl
611 @cindex Jim-Tcl
612 @cindex tcl
613
614 OpenOCD uses a small ``Tcl Interpreter'' known as Jim-Tcl.
615 This programming language provides a simple and extensible
616 command interpreter.
617
618 All commands presented in this Guide are extensions to Jim-Tcl.
619 You can use them as simple commands, without needing to learn
620 much of anything about Tcl.
621 Alternatively, you can write Tcl programs with them.
622
623 You can learn more about Jim at its website, @url{http://jim.tcl.tk}.
624 There is an active and responsive community, get on the mailing list
625 if you have any questions. Jim-Tcl maintainers also lurk on the
626 OpenOCD mailing list.
627
628 @itemize @bullet
629 @item @b{Jim vs. Tcl}
630 @* Jim-Tcl is a stripped down version of the well known Tcl language,
631 which can be found here: @url{http://www.tcl.tk}. Jim-Tcl has far
632 fewer features. Jim-Tcl is several dozens of .C files and .H files and
633 implements the basic Tcl command set. In contrast: Tcl 8.6 is a
634 4.2 MB .zip file containing 1540 files.
635
636 @item @b{Missing Features}
637 @* Our practice has been: Add/clone the real Tcl feature if/when
638 needed. We welcome Jim-Tcl improvements, not bloat. Also there
639 are a large number of optional Jim-Tcl features that are not
640 enabled in OpenOCD.
641
642 @item @b{Scripts}
643 @* OpenOCD configuration scripts are Jim-Tcl Scripts. OpenOCD's
644 command interpreter today is a mixture of (newer)
645 Jim-Tcl commands, and the (older) original command interpreter.
646
647 @item @b{Commands}
648 @* At the OpenOCD telnet command line (or via the GDB monitor command) one
649 can type a Tcl for() loop, set variables, etc.
650 Some of the commands documented in this guide are implemented
651 as Tcl scripts, from a @file{startup.tcl} file internal to the server.
652
653 @item @b{Historical Note}
654 @* Jim-Tcl was introduced to OpenOCD in spring 2008. Fall 2010,
655 before OpenOCD 0.5 release, OpenOCD switched to using Jim-Tcl
656 as a Git submodule, which greatly simplified upgrading Jim-Tcl
657 to benefit from new features and bugfixes in Jim-Tcl.
658
659 @item @b{Need a crash course in Tcl?}
660 @*@xref{Tcl Crash Course}.
661 @end itemize
662
663 @node Running
664 @chapter Running
665 @cindex command line options
666 @cindex logfile
667 @cindex directory search
668
669 Properly installing OpenOCD sets up your operating system to grant it access
670 to the debug adapters. On Linux, this usually involves installing a file
671 in @file{/etc/udev/rules.d,} so OpenOCD has permissions. An example rules file
672 that works for many common adapters is shipped with OpenOCD in the
673 @file{contrib} directory. MS-Windows needs
674 complex and confusing driver configuration for every peripheral. Such issues
675 are unique to each operating system, and are not detailed in this User's Guide.
676
677 Then later you will invoke the OpenOCD server, with various options to
678 tell it how each debug session should work.
679 The @option{--help} option shows:
680 @verbatim
681 bash$ openocd --help
682
683 --help | -h display this help
684 --version | -v display OpenOCD version
685 --file | -f use configuration file <name>
686 --search | -s dir to search for config files and scripts
687 --debug | -d set debug level to 3
688 | -d<n> set debug level to <level>
689 --log_output | -l redirect log output to file <name>
690 --command | -c run <command>
691 @end verbatim
692
693 If you don't give any @option{-f} or @option{-c} options,
694 OpenOCD tries to read the configuration file @file{openocd.cfg}.
695 To specify one or more different
696 configuration files, use @option{-f} options. For example:
697
698 @example
699 openocd -f config1.cfg -f config2.cfg -f config3.cfg
700 @end example
701
702 Configuration files and scripts are searched for in
703 @enumerate
704 @item the current directory,
705 @item any search dir specified on the command line using the @option{-s} option,
706 @item any search dir specified using the @command{add_script_search_dir} command,
707 @item a directory in the @env{OPENOCD_SCRIPTS} environment variable (if set),
708 @item @file{%APPDATA%/OpenOCD} (only on Windows),
709 @item @file{$HOME/Library/Preferences/org.openocd} (only on Darwin),
710 @item @file{$XDG_CONFIG_HOME/openocd} (@env{$XDG_CONFIG_HOME} defaults to @file{$HOME/.config}),
711 @item @file{$HOME/.openocd},
712 @item the site wide script library @file{$pkgdatadir/site} and
713 @item the OpenOCD-supplied script library @file{$pkgdatadir/scripts}.
714 @end enumerate
715 The first found file with a matching file name will be used.
716
717 @quotation Note
718 Don't try to use configuration script names or paths which
719 include the "#" character. That character begins Tcl comments.
720 @end quotation
721
722 @section Simple setup, no customization
723
724 In the best case, you can use two scripts from one of the script
725 libraries, hook up your JTAG adapter, and start the server ... and
726 your JTAG setup will just work "out of the box". Always try to
727 start by reusing those scripts, but assume you'll need more
728 customization even if this works. @xref{OpenOCD Project Setup}.
729
730 If you find a script for your JTAG adapter, and for your board or
731 target, you may be able to hook up your JTAG adapter then start
732 the server with some variation of one of the following:
733
734 @example
735 openocd -f interface/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
736 openocd -f interface/ftdi/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
737 @end example
738
739 You might also need to configure which reset signals are present,
740 using @option{-c 'reset_config trst_and_srst'} or something similar.
741 If all goes well you'll see output something like
742
743 @example
744 Open On-Chip Debugger 0.4.0 (2010-01-14-15:06)
745 For bug reports, read
746 http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/bugs.html
747 Info : JTAG tap: lm3s.cpu tap/device found: 0x3ba00477
748 (mfg: 0x23b, part: 0xba00, ver: 0x3)
749 @end example
750
751 Seeing that "tap/device found" message, and no warnings, means
752 the JTAG communication is working. That's a key milestone, but
753 you'll probably need more project-specific setup.
754
755 @section What OpenOCD does as it starts
756
757 OpenOCD starts by processing the configuration commands provided
758 on the command line or, if there were no @option{-c command} or
759 @option{-f file.cfg} options given, in @file{openocd.cfg}.
760 @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage}.
761 At the end of the configuration stage it verifies the JTAG scan
762 chain defined using those commands; your configuration should
763 ensure that this always succeeds.
764 Normally, OpenOCD then starts running as a server.
765 Alternatively, commands may be used to terminate the configuration
766 stage early, perform work (such as updating some flash memory),
767 and then shut down without acting as a server.
768
769 Once OpenOCD starts running as a server, it waits for connections from
770 clients (Telnet, GDB, RPC) and processes the commands issued through
771 those channels.
772
773 If you are having problems, you can enable internal debug messages via
774 the @option{-d} option.
775
776 Also it is possible to interleave Jim-Tcl commands w/config scripts using the
777 @option{-c} command line switch.
778
779 To enable debug output (when reporting problems or working on OpenOCD
780 itself), use the @option{-d} command line switch. This sets the
781 @option{debug_level} to "3", outputting the most information,
782 including debug messages. The default setting is "2", outputting only
783 informational messages, warnings and errors. You can also change this
784 setting from within a telnet or gdb session using @command{debug_level<n>}
785 (@pxref{debuglevel,,debug_level}).
786
787 You can redirect all output from the server to a file using the
788 @option{-l <logfile>} switch.
789
790 Note! OpenOCD will launch the GDB & telnet server even if it can not
791 establish a connection with the target. In general, it is possible for
792 the JTAG controller to be unresponsive until the target is set up
793 correctly via e.g. GDB monitor commands in a GDB init script.
794
795 @node OpenOCD Project Setup
796 @chapter OpenOCD Project Setup
797
798 To use OpenOCD with your development projects, you need to do more than
799 just connect the JTAG adapter hardware (dongle) to your development board
800 and start the OpenOCD server.
801 You also need to configure your OpenOCD server so that it knows
802 about your adapter and board, and helps your work.
803 You may also want to connect OpenOCD to GDB, possibly
804 using Eclipse or some other GUI.
805
806 @section Hooking up the JTAG Adapter
807
808 Today's most common case is a dongle with a JTAG cable on one side
809 (such as a ribbon cable with a 10-pin or 20-pin IDC connector)
810 and a USB cable on the other.
811 Instead of USB, some dongles use Ethernet;
812 older ones may use a PC parallel port, or even a serial port.
813
814 @enumerate
815 @item @emph{Start with power to your target board turned off},
816 and nothing connected to your JTAG adapter.
817 If you're particularly paranoid, unplug power to the board.
818 It's important to have the ground signal properly set up,
819 unless you are using a JTAG adapter which provides
820 galvanic isolation between the target board and the
821 debugging host.
822
823 @item @emph{Be sure it's the right kind of JTAG connector.}
824 If your dongle has a 20-pin ARM connector, you need some kind
825 of adapter (or octopus, see below) to hook it up to
826 boards using 14-pin or 10-pin connectors ... or to 20-pin
827 connectors which don't use ARM's pinout.
828
829 In the same vein, make sure the voltage levels are compatible.
830 Not all JTAG adapters have the level shifters needed to work
831 with 1.2 Volt boards.
832
833 @item @emph{Be certain the cable is properly oriented} or you might
834 damage your board. In most cases there are only two possible
835 ways to connect the cable.
836 Connect the JTAG cable from your adapter to the board.
837 Be sure it's firmly connected.
838
839 In the best case, the connector is keyed to physically
840 prevent you from inserting it wrong.
841 This is most often done using a slot on the board's male connector
842 housing, which must match a key on the JTAG cable's female connector.
843 If there's no housing, then you must look carefully and
844 make sure pin 1 on the cable hooks up to pin 1 on the board.
845 Ribbon cables are frequently all grey except for a wire on one
846 edge, which is red. The red wire is pin 1.
847
848 Sometimes dongles provide cables where one end is an ``octopus'' of
849 color coded single-wire connectors, instead of a connector block.
850 These are great when converting from one JTAG pinout to another,
851 but are tedious to set up.
852 Use these with connector pinout diagrams to help you match up the
853 adapter signals to the right board pins.
854
855 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's other end} once the JTAG cable is connected.
856 A USB, parallel, or serial port connector will go to the host which
857 you are using to run OpenOCD.
858 For Ethernet, consult the documentation and your network administrator.
859
860 For USB-based JTAG adapters you have an easy sanity check at this point:
861 does the host operating system see the JTAG adapter? If you're running
862 Linux, try the @command{lsusb} command. If that host is an
863 MS-Windows host, you'll need to install a driver before OpenOCD works.
864
865 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's power supply, if needed.}
866 This step is primarily for non-USB adapters,
867 but sometimes USB adapters need extra power.
868
869 @item @emph{Power up the target board.}
870 Unless you just let the magic smoke escape,
871 you're now ready to set up the OpenOCD server
872 so you can use JTAG to work with that board.
873
874 @end enumerate
875
876 Talk with the OpenOCD server using
877 telnet (@code{telnet localhost 4444} on many systems) or GDB.
878 @xref{GDB and OpenOCD}.
879
880 @section Project Directory
881
882 There are many ways you can configure OpenOCD and start it up.
883
884 A simple way to organize them all involves keeping a
885 single directory for your work with a given board.
886 When you start OpenOCD from that directory,
887 it searches there first for configuration files, scripts,
888 files accessed through semihosting,
889 and for code you upload to the target board.
890 It is also the natural place to write files,
891 such as log files and data you download from the board.
892
893 @section Configuration Basics
894
895 There are two basic ways of configuring OpenOCD, and
896 a variety of ways you can mix them.
897 Think of the difference as just being how you start the server:
898
899 @itemize
900 @item Many @option{-f file} or @option{-c command} options on the command line
901 @item No options, but a @dfn{user config file}
902 in the current directory named @file{openocd.cfg}
903 @end itemize
904
905 Here is an example @file{openocd.cfg} file for a setup
906 using a Signalyzer FT2232-based JTAG adapter to talk to
907 a board with an Atmel AT91SAM7X256 microcontroller:
908
909 @example
910 source [find interface/ftdi/signalyzer.cfg]
911
912 # GDB can also flash my flash!
913 gdb_memory_map enable
914 gdb_flash_program enable
915
916 source [find target/sam7x256.cfg]
917 @end example
918
919 Here is the command line equivalent of that configuration:
920
921 @example
922 openocd -f interface/ftdi/signalyzer.cfg \
923 -c "gdb_memory_map enable" \
924 -c "gdb_flash_program enable" \
925 -f target/sam7x256.cfg
926 @end example
927
928 You could wrap such long command lines in shell scripts,
929 each supporting a different development task.
930 One might re-flash the board with a specific firmware version.
931 Another might set up a particular debugging or run-time environment.
932
933 @quotation Important
934 At this writing (October 2009) the command line method has
935 problems with how it treats variables.
936 For example, after @option{-c "set VAR value"}, or doing the
937 same in a script, the variable @var{VAR} will have no value
938 that can be tested in a later script.
939 @end quotation
940
941 Here we will focus on the simpler solution: one user config
942 file, including basic configuration plus any TCL procedures
943 to simplify your work.
944
945 @section User Config Files
946 @cindex config file, user
947 @cindex user config file
948 @cindex config file, overview
949
950 A user configuration file ties together all the parts of a project
951 in one place.
952 One of the following will match your situation best:
953
954 @itemize
955 @item Ideally almost everything comes from configuration files
956 provided by someone else.
957 For example, OpenOCD distributes a @file{scripts} directory
958 (probably in @file{/usr/share/openocd/scripts} on Linux).
959 Board and tool vendors can provide these too, as can individual
960 user sites; the @option{-s} command line option lets you say
961 where to find these files. (@xref{Running}.)
962 The AT91SAM7X256 example above works this way.
963
964 Three main types of non-user configuration file each have their
965 own subdirectory in the @file{scripts} directory:
966
967 @enumerate
968 @item @b{interface} -- one for each different debug adapter;
969 @item @b{board} -- one for each different board
970 @item @b{target} -- the chips which integrate CPUs and other JTAG TAPs
971 @end enumerate
972
973 Best case: include just two files, and they handle everything else.
974 The first is an interface config file.
975 The second is board-specific, and it sets up the JTAG TAPs and
976 their GDB targets (by deferring to some @file{target.cfg} file),
977 declares all flash memory, and leaves you nothing to do except
978 meet your deadline:
979
980 @example
981 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
982 source [find board/csb337.cfg]
983 @end example
984
985 Boards with a single microcontroller often won't need more
986 than the target config file, as in the AT91SAM7X256 example.
987 That's because there is no external memory (flash, DDR RAM), and
988 the board differences are encapsulated by application code.
989
990 @item Maybe you don't know yet what your board looks like to JTAG.
991 Once you know the @file{interface.cfg} file to use, you may
992 need help from OpenOCD to discover what's on the board.
993 Once you find the JTAG TAPs, you can just search for appropriate
994 target and board
995 configuration files ... or write your own, from the bottom up.
996 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
997
998 @item You can often reuse some standard config files but
999 need to write a few new ones, probably a @file{board.cfg} file.
1000 You will be using commands described later in this User's Guide,
1001 and working with the guidelines in the next chapter.
1002
1003 For example, there may be configuration files for your JTAG adapter
1004 and target chip, but you need a new board-specific config file
1005 giving access to your particular flash chips.
1006 Or you might need to write another target chip configuration file
1007 for a new chip built around the Cortex-M3 core.
1008
1009 @quotation Note
1010 When you write new configuration files, please submit
1011 them for inclusion in the next OpenOCD release.
1012 For example, a @file{board/newboard.cfg} file will help the
1013 next users of that board, and a @file{target/newcpu.cfg}
1014 will help support users of any board using that chip.
1015 @end quotation
1016
1017 @item
1018 You may need to write some C code.
1019 It may be as simple as supporting a new FT2232 or parport
1020 based adapter; a bit more involved, like a NAND or NOR flash
1021 controller driver; or a big piece of work like supporting
1022 a new chip architecture.
1023 @end itemize
1024
1025 Reuse the existing config files when you can.
1026 Look first in the @file{scripts/boards} area, then @file{scripts/targets}.
1027 You may find a board configuration that's a good example to follow.
1028
1029 When you write config files, separate the reusable parts
1030 (things every user of that interface, chip, or board needs)
1031 from ones specific to your environment and debugging approach.
1032 @itemize
1033
1034 @item
1035 For example, a @code{gdb-attach} event handler that invokes
1036 the @command{reset init} command will interfere with debugging
1037 early boot code, which performs some of the same actions
1038 that the @code{reset-init} event handler does.
1039
1040 @item
1041 Likewise, the @command{arm9 vector_catch} command (or
1042 @cindex vector_catch
1043 its siblings @command{xscale vector_catch}
1044 and @command{cortex_m vector_catch}) can be a time-saver
1045 during some debug sessions, but don't make everyone use that either.
1046 Keep those kinds of debugging aids in your user config file,
1047 along with messaging and tracing setup.
1048 (@xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.)
1049
1050 @item
1051 You might need to override some defaults.
1052 For example, you might need to move, shrink, or back up the target's
1053 work area if your application needs much SRAM.
1054
1055 @item
1056 TCP/IP port configuration is another example of something which
1057 is environment-specific, and should only appear in
1058 a user config file. @xref{tcpipports,,TCP/IP Ports}.
1059 @end itemize
1060
1061 @section Project-Specific Utilities
1062
1063 A few project-specific utility
1064 routines may well speed up your work.
1065 Write them, and keep them in your project's user config file.
1066
1067 For example, if you are making a boot loader work on a
1068 board, it's nice to be able to debug the ``after it's
1069 loaded to RAM'' parts separately from the finicky early
1070 code which sets up the DDR RAM controller and clocks.
1071 A script like this one, or a more GDB-aware sibling,
1072 may help:
1073
1074 @example
1075 proc ramboot @{ @} @{
1076 # Reset, running the target's "reset-init" scripts
1077 # to initialize clocks and the DDR RAM controller.
1078 # Leave the CPU halted.
1079 reset init
1080
1081 # Load CONFIG_SKIP_LOWLEVEL_INIT version into DDR RAM.
1082 load_image u-boot.bin 0x20000000
1083
1084 # Start running.
1085 resume 0x20000000
1086 @}
1087 @end example
1088
1089 Then once that code is working you will need to make it
1090 boot from NOR flash; a different utility would help.
1091 Alternatively, some developers write to flash using GDB.
1092 (You might use a similar script if you're working with a flash
1093 based microcontroller application instead of a boot loader.)
1094
1095 @example
1096 proc newboot @{ @} @{
1097 # Reset, leaving the CPU halted. The "reset-init" event
1098 # proc gives faster access to the CPU and to NOR flash;
1099 # "reset halt" would be slower.
1100 reset init
1101
1102 # Write standard version of U-Boot into the first two
1103 # sectors of NOR flash ... the standard version should
1104 # do the same lowlevel init as "reset-init".
1105 flash protect 0 0 1 off
1106 flash erase_sector 0 0 1
1107 flash write_bank 0 u-boot.bin 0x0
1108 flash protect 0 0 1 on
1109
1110 # Reboot from scratch using that new boot loader.
1111 reset run
1112 @}
1113 @end example
1114
1115 You may need more complicated utility procedures when booting
1116 from NAND.
1117 That often involves an extra bootloader stage,
1118 running from on-chip SRAM to perform DDR RAM setup so it can load
1119 the main bootloader code (which won't fit into that SRAM).
1120
1121 Other helper scripts might be used to write production system images,
1122 involving considerably more than just a three stage bootloader.
1123
1124 @section Target Software Changes
1125
1126 Sometimes you may want to make some small changes to the software
1127 you're developing, to help make JTAG debugging work better.
1128 For example, in C or assembly language code you might
1129 use @code{#ifdef JTAG_DEBUG} (or its converse) around code
1130 handling issues like:
1131
1132 @itemize @bullet
1133
1134 @item @b{Watchdog Timers}...
1135 Watchdog timers are typically used to automatically reset systems if
1136 some application task doesn't periodically reset the timer. (The
1137 assumption is that the system has locked up if the task can't run.)
1138 When a JTAG debugger halts the system, that task won't be able to run
1139 and reset the timer ... potentially causing resets in the middle of
1140 your debug sessions.
1141
1142 It's rarely a good idea to disable such watchdogs, since their usage
1143 needs to be debugged just like all other parts of your firmware.
1144 That might however be your only option.
1145
1146 Look instead for chip-specific ways to stop the watchdog from counting
1147 while the system is in a debug halt state. It may be simplest to set
1148 that non-counting mode in your debugger startup scripts. You may however
1149 need a different approach when, for example, a motor could be physically
1150 damaged by firmware remaining inactive in a debug halt state. That might
1151 involve a type of firmware mode where that "non-counting" mode is disabled
1152 at the beginning then re-enabled at the end; a watchdog reset might fire
1153 and complicate the debug session, but hardware (or people) would be
1154 protected.@footnote{Note that many systems support a "monitor mode" debug
1155 that is a somewhat cleaner way to address such issues. You can think of
1156 it as only halting part of the system, maybe just one task,
1157 instead of the whole thing.
1158 At this writing, January 2010, OpenOCD based debugging does not support
1159 monitor mode debug, only "halt mode" debug.}
1160
1161 @item @b{ARM Semihosting}...
1162 @cindex ARM semihosting
1163 When linked with a special runtime library provided with many
1164 toolchains@footnote{See chapter 8 "Semihosting" in
1165 @uref{http://infocenter.arm.com/help/topic/com.arm.doc.dui0203i/DUI0203I_rvct_developer_guide.pdf,
1166 ARM DUI 0203I}, the "RealView Compilation Tools Developer Guide".
1167 The CodeSourcery EABI toolchain also includes a semihosting library.},
1168 your target code can use I/O facilities on the debug host. That library
1169 provides a small set of system calls which are handled by OpenOCD.
1170 It can let the debugger provide your system console and a file system,
1171 helping with early debugging or providing a more capable environment
1172 for sometimes-complex tasks like installing system firmware onto
1173 NAND or SPI flash.
1174
1175 @item @b{ARM Wait-For-Interrupt}...
1176 Many ARM chips synchronize the JTAG clock using the core clock.
1177 Low power states which stop that core clock thus prevent JTAG access.
1178 Idle loops in tasking environments often enter those low power states
1179 via the @code{WFI} instruction (or its coprocessor equivalent, before ARMv7).
1180
1181 You may want to @emph{disable that instruction} in source code,
1182 or otherwise prevent using that state,
1183 to ensure you can get JTAG access at any time.@footnote{As a more
1184 polite alternative, some processors have special debug-oriented
1185 registers which can be used to change various features including
1186 how the low power states are clocked while debugging.
1187 The STM32 DBGMCU_CR register is an example; at the cost of extra
1188 power consumption, JTAG can be used during low power states.}
1189 For example, the OpenOCD @command{halt} command may not
1190 work for an idle processor otherwise.
1191
1192 @item @b{Delay after reset}...
1193 Not all chips have good support for debugger access
1194 right after reset; many LPC2xxx chips have issues here.
1195 Similarly, applications that reconfigure pins used for
1196 JTAG access as they start will also block debugger access.
1197
1198 To work with boards like this, @emph{enable a short delay loop}
1199 the first thing after reset, before "real" startup activities.
1200 For example, one second's delay is usually more than enough
1201 time for a JTAG debugger to attach, so that
1202 early code execution can be debugged
1203 or firmware can be replaced.
1204
1205 @item @b{Debug Communications Channel (DCC)}...
1206 Some processors include mechanisms to send messages over JTAG.
1207 Many ARM cores support these, as do some cores from other vendors.
1208 (OpenOCD may be able to use this DCC internally, speeding up some
1209 operations like writing to memory.)
1210
1211 Your application may want to deliver various debugging messages
1212 over JTAG, by @emph{linking with a small library of code}
1213 provided with OpenOCD and using the utilities there to send
1214 various kinds of message.
1215 @xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.
1216
1217 @end itemize
1218
1219 @section Target Hardware Setup
1220
1221 Chip vendors often provide software development boards which
1222 are highly configurable, so that they can support all options
1223 that product boards may require. @emph{Make sure that any
1224 jumpers or switches match the system configuration you are
1225 working with.}
1226
1227 Common issues include:
1228
1229 @itemize @bullet
1230
1231 @item @b{JTAG setup} ...
1232 Boards may support more than one JTAG configuration.
1233 Examples include jumpers controlling pullups versus pulldowns
1234 on the nTRST and/or nSRST signals, and choice of connectors
1235 (e.g. which of two headers on the base board,
1236 or one from a daughtercard).
1237 For some Texas Instruments boards, you may need to jumper the
1238 EMU0 and EMU1 signals (which OpenOCD won't currently control).
1239
1240 @item @b{Boot Modes} ...
1241 Complex chips often support multiple boot modes, controlled
1242 by external jumpers. Make sure this is set up correctly.
1243 For example many i.MX boards from NXP need to be jumpered
1244 to "ATX mode" to start booting using the on-chip ROM, when
1245 using second stage bootloader code stored in a NAND flash chip.
1246
1247 Such explicit configuration is common, and not limited to
1248 booting from NAND. You might also need to set jumpers to
1249 start booting using code loaded from an MMC/SD card; external
1250 SPI flash; Ethernet, UART, or USB links; NOR flash; OneNAND
1251 flash; some external host; or various other sources.
1252
1253
1254 @item @b{Memory Addressing} ...
1255 Boards which support multiple boot modes may also have jumpers
1256 to configure memory addressing. One board, for example, jumpers
1257 external chipselect 0 (used for booting) to address either
1258 a large SRAM (which must be pre-loaded via JTAG), NOR flash,
1259 or NAND flash. When it's jumpered to address NAND flash, that
1260 board must also be told to start booting from on-chip ROM.
1261
1262 Your @file{board.cfg} file may also need to be told this jumper
1263 configuration, so that it can know whether to declare NOR flash
1264 using @command{flash bank} or instead declare NAND flash with
1265 @command{nand device}; and likewise which probe to perform in
1266 its @code{reset-init} handler.
1267
1268 A closely related issue is bus width. Jumpers might need to
1269 distinguish between 8 bit or 16 bit bus access for the flash
1270 used to start booting.
1271
1272 @item @b{Peripheral Access} ...
1273 Development boards generally provide access to every peripheral
1274 on the chip, sometimes in multiple modes (such as by providing
1275 multiple audio codec chips).
1276 This interacts with software
1277 configuration of pin multiplexing, where for example a
1278 given pin may be routed either to the MMC/SD controller
1279 or the GPIO controller. It also often interacts with
1280 configuration jumpers. One jumper may be used to route
1281 signals to an MMC/SD card slot or an expansion bus (which
1282 might in turn affect booting); others might control which
1283 audio or video codecs are used.
1284
1285 @end itemize
1286
1287 Plus you should of course have @code{reset-init} event handlers
1288 which set up the hardware to match that jumper configuration.
1289 That includes in particular any oscillator or PLL used to clock
1290 the CPU, and any memory controllers needed to access external
1291 memory and peripherals. Without such handlers, you won't be
1292 able to access those resources without working target firmware
1293 which can do that setup ... this can be awkward when you're
1294 trying to debug that target firmware. Even if there's a ROM
1295 bootloader which handles a few issues, it rarely provides full
1296 access to all board-specific capabilities.
1297
1298
1299 @node Config File Guidelines
1300 @chapter Config File Guidelines
1301
1302 This chapter is aimed at any user who needs to write a config file,
1303 including developers and integrators of OpenOCD and any user who
1304 needs to get a new board working smoothly.
1305 It provides guidelines for creating those files.
1306
1307 You should find the following directories under
1308 @t{$(INSTALLDIR)/scripts}, with config files maintained upstream. Use
1309 them as-is where you can; or as models for new files.
1310 @itemize @bullet
1311 @item @file{interface} ...
1312 These are for debug adapters. Files that specify configuration to use
1313 specific JTAG, SWD and other adapters go here.
1314 @item @file{board} ...
1315 Think Circuit Board, PWA, PCB, they go by many names. Board files
1316 contain initialization items that are specific to a board.
1317
1318 They reuse target configuration files, since the same
1319 microprocessor chips are used on many boards,
1320 but support for external parts varies widely. For
1321 example, the SDRAM initialization sequence for the board, or the type
1322 of external flash and what address it uses. Any initialization
1323 sequence to enable that external flash or SDRAM should be found in the
1324 board file. Boards may also contain multiple targets: two CPUs; or
1325 a CPU and an FPGA.
1326 @item @file{target} ...
1327 Think chip. The ``target'' directory represents the JTAG TAPs
1328 on a chip
1329 which OpenOCD should control, not a board. Two common types of targets
1330 are ARM chips and FPGA or CPLD chips.
1331 When a chip has multiple TAPs (maybe it has both ARM and DSP cores),
1332 the target config file defines all of them.
1333 @item @emph{more} ... browse for other library files which may be useful.
1334 For example, there are various generic and CPU-specific utilities.
1335 @end itemize
1336
1337 The @file{openocd.cfg} user config
1338 file may override features in any of the above files by
1339 setting variables before sourcing the target file, or by adding
1340 commands specific to their situation.
1341
1342 @section Interface Config Files
1343
1344 The user config file
1345 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1346
1347 @example
1348 source [find interface/FOOBAR.cfg]
1349 @end example
1350
1351 A preconfigured interface file should exist for every debug adapter
1352 in use today with OpenOCD.
1353 That said, perhaps some of these config files
1354 have only been used by the developer who created it.
1355
1356 A separate chapter gives information about how to set these up.
1357 @xref{Debug Adapter Configuration}.
1358 Read the OpenOCD source code (and Developer's Guide)
1359 if you have a new kind of hardware interface
1360 and need to provide a driver for it.
1361
1362 @section Board Config Files
1363 @cindex config file, board
1364 @cindex board config file
1365
1366 The user config file
1367 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1368
1369 @example
1370 source [find board/FOOBAR.cfg]
1371 @end example
1372
1373 The point of a board config file is to package everything
1374 about a given board that user config files need to know.
1375 In summary the board files should contain (if present)
1376
1377 @enumerate
1378 @item One or more @command{source [find target/...cfg]} statements
1379 @item NOR flash configuration (@pxref{norconfiguration,,NOR Configuration})
1380 @item NAND flash configuration (@pxref{nandconfiguration,,NAND Configuration})
1381 @item Target @code{reset} handlers for SDRAM and I/O configuration
1382 @item JTAG adapter reset configuration (@pxref{Reset Configuration})
1383 @item All things that are not ``inside a chip''
1384 @end enumerate
1385
1386 Generic things inside target chips belong in target config files,
1387 not board config files. So for example a @code{reset-init} event
1388 handler should know board-specific oscillator and PLL parameters,
1389 which it passes to target-specific utility code.
1390
1391 The most complex task of a board config file is creating such a
1392 @code{reset-init} event handler.
1393 Define those handlers last, after you verify the rest of the board
1394 configuration works.
1395
1396 @subsection Communication Between Config files
1397
1398 In addition to target-specific utility code, another way that
1399 board and target config files communicate is by following a
1400 convention on how to use certain variables.
1401
1402 The full Tcl/Tk language supports ``namespaces'', but Jim-Tcl does not.
1403 Thus the rule we follow in OpenOCD is this: Variables that begin with
1404 a leading underscore are temporary in nature, and can be modified and
1405 used at will within a target configuration file.
1406
1407 Complex board config files can do the things like this,
1408 for a board with three chips:
1409
1410 @example
1411 # Chip #1: PXA270 for network side, big endian
1412 set CHIPNAME network
1413 set ENDIAN big
1414 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1415 # on return: _TARGETNAME = network.cpu
1416 # other commands can refer to the "network.cpu" target.
1417 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1418
1419 # Chip #2: PXA270 for video side, little endian
1420 set CHIPNAME video
1421 set ENDIAN little
1422 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1423 # on return: _TARGETNAME = video.cpu
1424 # other commands can refer to the "video.cpu" target.
1425 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1426
1427 # Chip #3: Xilinx FPGA for glue logic
1428 set CHIPNAME xilinx
1429 unset ENDIAN
1430 source [find target/spartan3.cfg]
1431 @end example
1432
1433 That example is oversimplified because it doesn't show any flash memory,
1434 or the @code{reset-init} event handlers to initialize external DRAM
1435 or (assuming it needs it) load a configuration into the FPGA.
1436 Such features are usually needed for low-level work with many boards,
1437 where ``low level'' implies that the board initialization software may
1438 not be working. (That's a common reason to need JTAG tools. Another
1439 is to enable working with microcontroller-based systems, which often
1440 have no debugging support except a JTAG connector.)
1441
1442 Target config files may also export utility functions to board and user
1443 config files. Such functions should use name prefixes, to help avoid
1444 naming collisions.
1445
1446 Board files could also accept input variables from user config files.
1447 For example, there might be a @code{J4_JUMPER} setting used to identify
1448 what kind of flash memory a development board is using, or how to set
1449 up other clocks and peripherals.
1450
1451 @subsection Variable Naming Convention
1452 @cindex variable names
1453
1454 Most boards have only one instance of a chip.
1455 However, it should be easy to create a board with more than
1456 one such chip (as shown above).
1457 Accordingly, we encourage these conventions for naming
1458 variables associated with different @file{target.cfg} files,
1459 to promote consistency and
1460 so that board files can override target defaults.
1461
1462 Inputs to target config files include:
1463
1464 @itemize @bullet
1465 @item @code{CHIPNAME} ...
1466 This gives a name to the overall chip, and is used as part of
1467 tap identifier dotted names.
1468 While the default is normally provided by the chip manufacturer,
1469 board files may need to distinguish between instances of a chip.
1470 @item @code{ENDIAN} ...
1471 By default @option{little} - although chips may hard-wire @option{big}.
1472 Chips that can't change endianness don't need to use this variable.
1473 @item @code{CPUTAPID} ...
1474 When OpenOCD examines the JTAG chain, it can be told verify the
1475 chips against the JTAG IDCODE register.
1476 The target file will hold one or more defaults, but sometimes the
1477 chip in a board will use a different ID (perhaps a newer revision).
1478 @end itemize
1479
1480 Outputs from target config files include:
1481
1482 @itemize @bullet
1483 @item @code{_TARGETNAME} ...
1484 By convention, this variable is created by the target configuration
1485 script. The board configuration file may make use of this variable to
1486 configure things like a ``reset init'' script, or other things
1487 specific to that board and that target.
1488 If the chip has 2 targets, the names are @code{_TARGETNAME0},
1489 @code{_TARGETNAME1}, ... etc.
1490 @end itemize
1491
1492 @subsection The reset-init Event Handler
1493 @cindex event, reset-init
1494 @cindex reset-init handler
1495
1496 Board config files run in the OpenOCD configuration stage;
1497 they can't use TAPs or targets, since they haven't been
1498 fully set up yet.
1499 This means you can't write memory or access chip registers;
1500 you can't even verify that a flash chip is present.
1501 That's done later in event handlers, of which the target @code{reset-init}
1502 handler is one of the most important.
1503
1504 Except on microcontrollers, the basic job of @code{reset-init} event
1505 handlers is setting up flash and DRAM, as normally handled by boot loaders.
1506 Microcontrollers rarely use boot loaders; they run right out of their
1507 on-chip flash and SRAM memory. But they may want to use one of these
1508 handlers too, if just for developer convenience.
1509
1510 @quotation Note
1511 Because this is so very board-specific, and chip-specific, no examples
1512 are included here.
1513 Instead, look at the board config files distributed with OpenOCD.
1514 If you have a boot loader, its source code will help; so will
1515 configuration files for other JTAG tools
1516 (@pxref{translatingconfigurationfiles,,Translating Configuration Files}).
1517 @end quotation
1518
1519 Some of this code could probably be shared between different boards.
1520 For example, setting up a DRAM controller often doesn't differ by
1521 much except the bus width (16 bits or 32?) and memory timings, so a
1522 reusable TCL procedure loaded by the @file{target.cfg} file might take
1523 those as parameters.
1524 Similarly with oscillator, PLL, and clock setup;
1525 and disabling the watchdog.
1526 Structure the code cleanly, and provide comments to help
1527 the next developer doing such work.
1528 (@emph{You might be that next person} trying to reuse init code!)
1529
1530 The last thing normally done in a @code{reset-init} handler is probing
1531 whatever flash memory was configured. For most chips that needs to be
1532 done while the associated target is halted, either because JTAG memory
1533 access uses the CPU or to prevent conflicting CPU access.
1534
1535 @subsection JTAG Clock Rate
1536
1537 Before your @code{reset-init} handler has set up
1538 the PLLs and clocking, you may need to run with
1539 a low JTAG clock rate.
1540 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
1541 Then you'd increase that rate after your handler has
1542 made it possible to use the faster JTAG clock.
1543 When the initial low speed is board-specific, for example
1544 because it depends on a board-specific oscillator speed, then
1545 you should probably set it up in the board config file;
1546 if it's target-specific, it belongs in the target config file.
1547
1548 For most ARM-based processors the fastest JTAG clock@footnote{A FAQ
1549 @uref{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} gives details.}
1550 is one sixth of the CPU clock; or one eighth for ARM11 cores.
1551 Consult chip documentation to determine the peak JTAG clock rate,
1552 which might be less than that.
1553
1554 @quotation Warning
1555 On most ARMs, JTAG clock detection is coupled to the core clock, so
1556 software using a @option{wait for interrupt} operation blocks JTAG access.
1557 Adaptive clocking provides a partial workaround, but a more complete
1558 solution just avoids using that instruction with JTAG debuggers.
1559 @end quotation
1560
1561 If both the chip and the board support adaptive clocking,
1562 use the @command{jtag_rclk}
1563 command, in case your board is used with JTAG adapter which
1564 also supports it. Otherwise use @command{adapter speed}.
1565 Set the slow rate at the beginning of the reset sequence,
1566 and the faster rate as soon as the clocks are at full speed.
1567
1568 @anchor{theinitboardprocedure}
1569 @subsection The init_board procedure
1570 @cindex init_board procedure
1571
1572 The concept of @code{init_board} procedure is very similar to @code{init_targets}
1573 (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets procedure}.) - it's a replacement of ``linear''
1574 configuration scripts. This procedure is meant to be executed when OpenOCD enters run stage
1575 (@xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage},) after @code{init_targets}. The idea to have
1576 separate @code{init_targets} and @code{init_board} procedures is to allow the first one to configure
1577 everything target specific (internal flash, internal RAM, etc.) and the second one to configure
1578 everything board specific (reset signals, chip frequency, reset-init event handler, external memory, etc.).
1579 Additionally ``linear'' board config file will most likely fail when target config file uses
1580 @code{init_targets} scheme (``linear'' script is executed before @code{init} and @code{init_targets} - after),
1581 so separating these two configuration stages is very convenient, as the easiest way to overcome this
1582 problem is to convert board config file to use @code{init_board} procedure. Board config scripts don't
1583 need to override @code{init_targets} defined in target config files when they only need to add some specifics.
1584
1585 Just as @code{init_targets}, the @code{init_board} procedure can be overridden by ``next level'' script (which sources
1586 the original), allowing greater code reuse.
1587
1588 @example
1589 ### board_file.cfg ###
1590
1591 # source target file that does most of the config in init_targets
1592 source [find target/target.cfg]
1593
1594 proc enable_fast_clock @{@} @{
1595 # enables fast on-board clock source
1596 # configures the chip to use it
1597 @}
1598
1599 # initialize only board specifics - reset, clock, adapter frequency
1600 proc init_board @{@} @{
1601 reset_config trst_and_srst trst_pulls_srst
1602
1603 $_TARGETNAME configure -event reset-start @{
1604 adapter speed 100
1605 @}
1606
1607 $_TARGETNAME configure -event reset-init @{
1608 enable_fast_clock
1609 adapter speed 10000
1610 @}
1611 @}
1612 @end example
1613
1614 @section Target Config Files
1615 @cindex config file, target
1616 @cindex target config file
1617
1618 Board config files communicate with target config files using
1619 naming conventions as described above, and may source one or
1620 more target config files like this:
1621
1622 @example
1623 source [find target/FOOBAR.cfg]
1624 @end example
1625
1626 The point of a target config file is to package everything
1627 about a given chip that board config files need to know.
1628 In summary the target files should contain
1629
1630 @enumerate
1631 @item Set defaults
1632 @item Add TAPs to the scan chain
1633 @item Add CPU targets (includes GDB support)
1634 @item CPU/Chip/CPU-Core specific features
1635 @item On-Chip flash
1636 @end enumerate
1637
1638 As a rule of thumb, a target file sets up only one chip.
1639 For a microcontroller, that will often include a single TAP,
1640 which is a CPU needing a GDB target, and its on-chip flash.
1641
1642 More complex chips may include multiple TAPs, and the target
1643 config file may need to define them all before OpenOCD
1644 can talk to the chip.
1645 For example, some phone chips have JTAG scan chains that include
1646 an ARM core for operating system use, a DSP,
1647 another ARM core embedded in an image processing engine,
1648 and other processing engines.
1649
1650 @subsection Default Value Boiler Plate Code
1651
1652 All target configuration files should start with code like this,
1653 letting board config files express environment-specific
1654 differences in how things should be set up.
1655
1656 @example
1657 # Boards may override chip names, perhaps based on role,
1658 # but the default should match what the vendor uses
1659 if @{ [info exists CHIPNAME] @} @{
1660 set _CHIPNAME $CHIPNAME
1661 @} else @{
1662 set _CHIPNAME sam7x256
1663 @}
1664
1665 # ONLY use ENDIAN with targets that can change it.
1666 if @{ [info exists ENDIAN] @} @{
1667 set _ENDIAN $ENDIAN
1668 @} else @{
1669 set _ENDIAN little
1670 @}
1671
1672 # TAP identifiers may change as chips mature, for example with
1673 # new revision fields (the "3" here). Pick a good default; you
1674 # can pass several such identifiers to the "jtag newtap" command.
1675 if @{ [info exists CPUTAPID ] @} @{
1676 set _CPUTAPID $CPUTAPID
1677 @} else @{
1678 set _CPUTAPID 0x3f0f0f0f
1679 @}
1680 @end example
1681 @c but 0x3f0f0f0f is for an str73x part ...
1682
1683 @emph{Remember:} Board config files may include multiple target
1684 config files, or the same target file multiple times
1685 (changing at least @code{CHIPNAME}).
1686
1687 Likewise, the target configuration file should define
1688 @code{_TARGETNAME} (or @code{_TARGETNAME0} etc) and
1689 use it later on when defining debug targets:
1690
1691 @example
1692 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1693 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1694 @end example
1695
1696 @subsection Adding TAPs to the Scan Chain
1697 After the ``defaults'' are set up,
1698 add the TAPs on each chip to the JTAG scan chain.
1699 @xref{TAP Declaration}, and the naming convention
1700 for taps.
1701
1702 In the simplest case the chip has only one TAP,
1703 probably for a CPU or FPGA.
1704 The config file for the Atmel AT91SAM7X256
1705 looks (in part) like this:
1706
1707 @example
1708 jtag newtap $_CHIPNAME cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id $_CPUTAPID
1709 @end example
1710
1711 A board with two such at91sam7 chips would be able
1712 to source such a config file twice, with different
1713 values for @code{CHIPNAME}, so
1714 it adds a different TAP each time.
1715
1716 If there are nonzero @option{-expected-id} values,
1717 OpenOCD attempts to verify the actual tap id against those values.
1718 It will issue error messages if there is mismatch, which
1719 can help to pinpoint problems in OpenOCD configurations.
1720
1721 @example
1722 JTAG tap: sam7x256.cpu tap/device found: 0x3f0f0f0f
1723 (Manufacturer: 0x787, Part: 0xf0f0, Version: 0x3)
1724 ERROR: Tap: sam7x256.cpu - Expected id: 0x12345678, Got: 0x3f0f0f0f
1725 ERROR: expected: mfg: 0x33c, part: 0x2345, ver: 0x1
1726 ERROR: got: mfg: 0x787, part: 0xf0f0, ver: 0x3
1727 @end example
1728
1729 There are more complex examples too, with chips that have
1730 multiple TAPs. Ones worth looking at include:
1731
1732 @itemize
1733 @item @file{target/omap3530.cfg} -- with disabled ARM and DSP,
1734 plus a JRC to enable them
1735 @item @file{target/str912.cfg} -- with flash, CPU, and boundary scan
1736 @item @file{target/ti_dm355.cfg} -- with ETM, ARM, and JRC (this JRC
1737 is not currently used)
1738 @end itemize
1739
1740 @subsection Add CPU targets
1741
1742 After adding a TAP for a CPU, you should set it up so that
1743 GDB and other commands can use it.
1744 @xref{CPU Configuration}.
1745 For the at91sam7 example above, the command can look like this;
1746 note that @code{$_ENDIAN} is not needed, since OpenOCD defaults
1747 to little endian, and this chip doesn't support changing that.
1748
1749 @example
1750 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1751 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1752 @end example
1753
1754 Work areas are small RAM areas associated with CPU targets.
1755 They are used by OpenOCD to speed up downloads,
1756 and to download small snippets of code to program flash chips.
1757 If the chip includes a form of ``on-chip-ram'' - and many do - define
1758 a work area if you can.
1759 Again using the at91sam7 as an example, this can look like:
1760
1761 @example
1762 $_TARGETNAME configure -work-area-phys 0x00200000 \
1763 -work-area-size 0x4000 -work-area-backup 0
1764 @end example
1765
1766 @anchor{definecputargetsworkinginsmp}
1767 @subsection Define CPU targets working in SMP
1768 @cindex SMP
1769 After setting targets, you can define a list of targets working in SMP.
1770
1771 @example
1772 set _TARGETNAME_1 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1773 set _TARGETNAME_2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu2
1774 target create $_TARGETNAME_1 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1775 -coreid 0 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG1
1776 target create $_TARGETNAME_2 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1777 -coreid 1 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG2
1778 #define 2 targets working in smp.
1779 target smp $_CHIPNAME.cpu2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1780 @end example
1781 In the above example on cortex_a, 2 cpus are working in SMP.
1782 In SMP only one GDB instance is created and :
1783 @itemize @bullet
1784 @item a set of hardware breakpoint sets the same breakpoint on all targets in the list.
1785 @item halt command triggers the halt of all targets in the list.
1786 @item resume command triggers the write context and the restart of all targets in the list.
1787 @item following a breakpoint: the target stopped by the breakpoint is displayed to the GDB session.
1788 @item dedicated GDB serial protocol packets are implemented for switching/retrieving the target
1789 displayed by the GDB session @pxref{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb,,Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB}.
1790 @end itemize
1791
1792 The SMP behaviour can be disabled/enabled dynamically. On cortex_a following
1793 command have been implemented.
1794 @itemize @bullet
1795 @item cortex_a smp on : enable SMP mode, behaviour is as described above.
1796 @item cortex_a smp off : disable SMP mode, the current target is the one
1797 displayed in the GDB session, only this target is now controlled by GDB
1798 session. This behaviour is useful during system boot up.
1799 @item cortex_a smp : display current SMP mode.
1800 @item cortex_a smp_gdb : display/fix the core id displayed in GDB session see
1801 following example.
1802 @end itemize
1803
1804 @example
1805 >cortex_a smp_gdb
1806 gdb coreid 0 -> -1
1807 #0 : coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
1808 #-> -1 : next resume triggers a real resume
1809 > cortex_a smp_gdb 1
1810 gdb coreid 0 -> 1
1811 #0 :coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
1812 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
1813 > resume
1814 > cortex_a smp_gdb
1815 gdb coreid 1 -> 1
1816 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB ,
1817 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
1818 > cortex_a smp_gdb -1
1819 gdb coreid 1 -> -1
1820 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB,
1821 #->-1 : next resume triggers a real resume
1822 @end example
1823
1824
1825 @subsection Chip Reset Setup
1826
1827 As a rule, you should put the @command{reset_config} command
1828 into the board file. Most things you think you know about a
1829 chip can be tweaked by the board.
1830
1831 Some chips have specific ways the TRST and SRST signals are
1832 managed. In the unusual case that these are @emph{chip specific}
1833 and can never be changed by board wiring, they could go here.
1834 For example, some chips can't support JTAG debugging without
1835 both signals.
1836
1837 Provide a @code{reset-assert} event handler if you can.
1838 Such a handler uses JTAG operations to reset the target,
1839 letting this target config be used in systems which don't
1840 provide the optional SRST signal, or on systems where you
1841 don't want to reset all targets at once.
1842 Such a handler might write to chip registers to force a reset,
1843 use a JRC to do that (preferable -- the target may be wedged!),
1844 or force a watchdog timer to trigger.
1845 (For Cortex-M targets, this is not necessary. The target
1846 driver knows how to use trigger an NVIC reset when SRST is
1847 not available.)
1848
1849 Some chips need special attention during reset handling if
1850 they're going to be used with JTAG.
1851 An example might be needing to send some commands right
1852 after the target's TAP has been reset, providing a
1853 @code{reset-deassert-post} event handler that writes a chip
1854 register to report that JTAG debugging is being done.
1855 Another would be reconfiguring the watchdog so that it stops
1856 counting while the core is halted in the debugger.
1857
1858 JTAG clocking constraints often change during reset, and in
1859 some cases target config files (rather than board config files)
1860 are the right places to handle some of those issues.
1861 For example, immediately after reset most chips run using a
1862 slower clock than they will use later.
1863 That means that after reset (and potentially, as OpenOCD
1864 first starts up) they must use a slower JTAG clock rate
1865 than they will use later.
1866 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
1867
1868 @quotation Important
1869 When you are debugging code that runs right after chip
1870 reset, getting these issues right is critical.
1871 In particular, if you see intermittent failures when
1872 OpenOCD verifies the scan chain after reset,
1873 look at how you are setting up JTAG clocking.
1874 @end quotation
1875
1876 @anchor{theinittargetsprocedure}
1877 @subsection The init_targets procedure
1878 @cindex init_targets procedure
1879
1880 Target config files can either be ``linear'' (script executed line-by-line when parsed in
1881 configuration stage, @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage},) or they can contain a special
1882 procedure called @code{init_targets}, which will be executed when entering run stage
1883 (after parsing all config files or after @code{init} command, @xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage}.)
1884 Such procedure can be overridden by ``next level'' script (which sources the original).
1885 This concept facilitates code reuse when basic target config files provide generic configuration
1886 procedures and @code{init_targets} procedure, which can then be sourced and enhanced or changed in
1887 a ``more specific'' target config file. This is not possible with ``linear'' config scripts,
1888 because sourcing them executes every initialization commands they provide.
1889
1890 @example
1891 ### generic_file.cfg ###
1892
1893 proc setup_my_chip @{chip_name flash_size ram_size@} @{
1894 # basic initialization procedure ...
1895 @}
1896
1897 proc init_targets @{@} @{
1898 # initializes generic chip with 4kB of flash and 1kB of RAM
1899 setup_my_chip MY_GENERIC_CHIP 4096 1024
1900 @}
1901
1902 ### specific_file.cfg ###
1903
1904 source [find target/generic_file.cfg]
1905
1906 proc init_targets @{@} @{
1907 # initializes specific chip with 128kB of flash and 64kB of RAM
1908 setup_my_chip MY_CHIP_WITH_128K_FLASH_64KB_RAM 131072 65536
1909 @}
1910 @end example
1911
1912 The easiest way to convert ``linear'' config files to @code{init_targets} version is to
1913 enclose every line of ``code'' (i.e. not @code{source} commands, procedures, etc.) in this procedure.
1914
1915 For an example of this scheme see LPC2000 target config files.
1916
1917 The @code{init_boards} procedure is a similar concept concerning board config files
1918 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.)
1919
1920 @anchor{theinittargeteventsprocedure}
1921 @subsection The init_target_events procedure
1922 @cindex init_target_events procedure
1923
1924 A special procedure called @code{init_target_events} is run just after
1925 @code{init_targets} (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets
1926 procedure}.) and before @code{init_board}
1927 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.) It is used
1928 to set up default target events for the targets that do not have those
1929 events already assigned.
1930
1931 @subsection ARM Core Specific Hacks
1932
1933 If the chip has a DCC, enable it. If the chip is an ARM9 with some
1934 special high speed download features - enable it.
1935
1936 If present, the MMU, the MPU and the CACHE should be disabled.
1937
1938 Some ARM cores are equipped with trace support, which permits
1939 examination of the instruction and data bus activity. Trace
1940 activity is controlled through an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM)
1941 on one of the core's scan chains. The ETM emits voluminous data
1942 through a ``trace port''. (@xref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.)
1943 If you are using an external trace port,
1944 configure it in your board config file.
1945 If you are using an on-chip ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB),
1946 configure it in your target config file.
1947
1948 @example
1949 etm config $_TARGETNAME 16 normal full etb
1950 etb config $_TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.etb
1951 @end example
1952
1953 @subsection Internal Flash Configuration
1954
1955 This applies @b{ONLY TO MICROCONTROLLERS} that have flash built in.
1956
1957 @b{Never ever} in the ``target configuration file'' define any type of
1958 flash that is external to the chip. (For example a BOOT flash on
1959 Chip Select 0.) Such flash information goes in a board file - not
1960 the TARGET (chip) file.
1961
1962 Examples:
1963 @itemize @bullet
1964 @item at91sam7x256 - has 256K flash YES enable it.
1965 @item str912 - has flash internal YES enable it.
1966 @item imx27 - uses boot flash on CS0 - it goes in the board file.
1967 @item pxa270 - again - CS0 flash - it goes in the board file.
1968 @end itemize
1969
1970 @anchor{translatingconfigurationfiles}
1971 @section Translating Configuration Files
1972 @cindex translation
1973 If you have a configuration file for another hardware debugger
1974 or toolset (Abatron, BDI2000, BDI3000, CCS,
1975 Lauterbach, SEGGER, Macraigor, etc.), translating
1976 it into OpenOCD syntax is often quite straightforward. The most tricky
1977 part of creating a configuration script is oftentimes the reset init
1978 sequence where e.g. PLLs, DRAM and the like is set up.
1979
1980 One trick that you can use when translating is to write small
1981 Tcl procedures to translate the syntax into OpenOCD syntax. This
1982 can avoid manual translation errors and make it easier to
1983 convert other scripts later on.
1984
1985 Example of transforming quirky arguments to a simple search and
1986 replace job:
1987
1988 @example
1989 # Lauterbach syntax(?)
1990 #
1991 # Data.Set c15:0x042f %long 0x40000015
1992 #
1993 # OpenOCD syntax when using procedure below.
1994 #
1995 # setc15 0x01 0x00050078
1996
1997 proc setc15 @{regs value@} @{
1998 global TARGETNAME
1999
2000 echo [format "set p15 0x%04x, 0x%08x" $regs $value]
2001
2002 arm mcr 15 [expr ($regs>>12)&0x7] \
2003 [expr ($regs>>0)&0xf] [expr ($regs>>4)&0xf] \
2004 [expr ($regs>>8)&0x7] $value
2005 @}
2006 @end example
2007
2008
2009
2010 @node Server Configuration
2011 @chapter Server Configuration
2012 @cindex initialization
2013 The commands here are commonly found in the openocd.cfg file and are
2014 used to specify what TCP/IP ports are used, and how GDB should be
2015 supported.
2016
2017 @anchor{configurationstage}
2018 @section Configuration Stage
2019 @cindex configuration stage
2020 @cindex config command
2021
2022 When the OpenOCD server process starts up, it enters a
2023 @emph{configuration stage} which is the only time that
2024 certain commands, @emph{configuration commands}, may be issued.
2025 Normally, configuration commands are only available
2026 inside startup scripts.
2027
2028 In this manual, the definition of a configuration command is
2029 presented as a @emph{Config Command}, not as a @emph{Command}
2030 which may be issued interactively.
2031 The runtime @command{help} command also highlights configuration
2032 commands, and those which may be issued at any time.
2033
2034 Those configuration commands include declaration of TAPs,
2035 flash banks,
2036 the interface used for JTAG communication,
2037 and other basic setup.
2038 The server must leave the configuration stage before it
2039 may access or activate TAPs.
2040 After it leaves this stage, configuration commands may no
2041 longer be issued.
2042
2043 @anchor{enteringtherunstage}
2044 @section Entering the Run Stage
2045
2046 The first thing OpenOCD does after leaving the configuration
2047 stage is to verify that it can talk to the scan chain
2048 (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2049 It will warn if it doesn't find TAPs it expects to find,
2050 or finds TAPs that aren't supposed to be there.
2051 You should see no errors at this point.
2052 If you see errors, resolve them by correcting the
2053 commands you used to configure the server.
2054 Common errors include using an initial JTAG speed that's too
2055 fast, and not providing the right IDCODE values for the TAPs
2056 on the scan chain.
2057
2058 Once OpenOCD has entered the run stage, a number of commands
2059 become available.
2060 A number of these relate to the debug targets you may have declared.
2061 For example, the @command{mww} command will not be available until
2062 a target has been successfully instantiated.
2063 If you want to use those commands, you may need to force
2064 entry to the run stage.
2065
2066 @deffn {Config Command} {init}
2067 This command terminates the configuration stage and
2068 enters the run stage. This helps when you need to have
2069 the startup scripts manage tasks such as resetting the target,
2070 programming flash, etc. To reset the CPU upon startup, add "init" and
2071 "reset" at the end of the config script or at the end of the OpenOCD
2072 command line using the @option{-c} command line switch.
2073
2074 If this command does not appear in any startup/configuration file
2075 OpenOCD executes the command for you after processing all
2076 configuration files and/or command line options.
2077
2078 @b{NOTE:} This command normally occurs at or near the end of your
2079 openocd.cfg file to force OpenOCD to ``initialize'' and make the
2080 targets ready. For example: If your openocd.cfg file needs to
2081 read/write memory on your target, @command{init} must occur before
2082 the memory read/write commands. This includes @command{nand probe}.
2083 @end deffn
2084
2085 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} {jtag_init}
2086 This is invoked at server startup to verify that it can talk
2087 to the scan chain (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2088
2089 The default implementation first tries @command{jtag arp_init},
2090 which uses only a lightweight JTAG reset before examining the
2091 scan chain.
2092 If that fails, it tries again, using a harder reset
2093 from the overridable procedure @command{init_reset}.
2094
2095 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
2096 they return.
2097 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
2098 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
2099 @end deffn
2100
2101 @anchor{tcpipports}
2102 @section TCP/IP Ports
2103 @cindex TCP port
2104 @cindex server
2105 @cindex port
2106 @cindex security
2107 The OpenOCD server accepts remote commands in several syntaxes.
2108 Each syntax uses a different TCP/IP port, which you may specify
2109 only during configuration (before those ports are opened).
2110
2111 For reasons including security, you may wish to prevent remote
2112 access using one or more of these ports.
2113 In such cases, just specify the relevant port number as "disabled".
2114 If you disable all access through TCP/IP, you will need to
2115 use the command line @option{-pipe} option.
2116
2117 @anchor{gdb_port}
2118 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_port} [number]
2119 @cindex GDB server
2120 Normally gdb listens to a TCP/IP port, but GDB can also
2121 communicate via pipes(stdin/out or named pipes). The name
2122 "gdb_port" stuck because it covers probably more than 90% of
2123 the normal use cases.
2124
2125 No arguments reports GDB port. "pipe" means listen to stdin
2126 output to stdout, an integer is base port number, "disabled"
2127 disables the gdb server.
2128
2129 When using "pipe", also use log_output to redirect the log
2130 output to a file so as not to flood the stdin/out pipes.
2131
2132 Any other string is interpreted as named pipe to listen to.
2133 Output pipe is the same name as input pipe, but with 'o' appended,
2134 e.g. /var/gdb, /var/gdbo.
2135
2136 The GDB port for the first target will be the base port, the
2137 second target will listen on gdb_port + 1, and so on.
2138 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2139 the port @var{number} defaults to 3333.
2140 When @var{number} is not a numeric value, incrementing it to compute
2141 the next port number does not work. In this case, specify the proper
2142 @var{number} for each target by using the option @code{-gdb-port} of the
2143 commands @command{target create} or @command{$target_name configure}.
2144 @xref{gdbportoverride,,option -gdb-port}.
2145
2146 Note: when using "gdb_port pipe", increasing the default remote timeout in
2147 gdb (with 'set remotetimeout') is recommended. An insufficient timeout may
2148 cause initialization to fail with "Unknown remote qXfer reply: OK".
2149 @end deffn
2150
2151 @deffn {Config Command} {tcl_port} [number]
2152 Specify or query the port used for a simplified RPC
2153 connection that can be used by clients to issue TCL commands and get the
2154 output from the Tcl engine.
2155 Intended as a machine interface.
2156 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2157 the port @var{number} defaults to 6666.
2158 When specified as "disabled", this service is not activated.
2159 @end deffn
2160
2161 @deffn {Config Command} {telnet_port} [number]
2162 Specify or query the
2163 port on which to listen for incoming telnet connections.
2164 This port is intended for interaction with one human through TCL commands.
2165 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2166 the port @var{number} defaults to 4444.
2167 When specified as "disabled", this service is not activated.
2168 @end deffn
2169
2170 @anchor{gdbconfiguration}
2171 @section GDB Configuration
2172 @cindex GDB
2173 @cindex GDB configuration
2174 You can reconfigure some GDB behaviors if needed.
2175 The ones listed here are static and global.
2176 @xref{targetconfiguration,,Target Configuration}, about configuring individual targets.
2177 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}, about configuring target-specific event handling.
2178
2179 @anchor{gdbbreakpointoverride}
2180 @deffn {Command} {gdb_breakpoint_override} [@option{hard}|@option{soft}|@option{disable}]
2181 Force breakpoint type for gdb @command{break} commands.
2182 This option supports GDB GUIs which don't
2183 distinguish hard versus soft breakpoints, if the default OpenOCD and
2184 GDB behaviour is not sufficient. GDB normally uses hardware
2185 breakpoints if the memory map has been set up for flash regions.
2186 @end deffn
2187
2188 @anchor{gdbflashprogram}
2189 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_flash_program} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2190 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to program the flash memory when a
2191 vFlash packet is received.
2192 The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2193 @end deffn
2194
2195 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_memory_map} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2196 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the memory configuration to GDB when
2197 requested. GDB will then know when to set hardware breakpoints, and program flash
2198 using the GDB load command. @command{gdb_flash_program enable} must also be enabled
2199 for flash programming to work.
2200 Default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2201 @xref{gdbflashprogram,,gdb_flash_program}.
2202 @end deffn
2203
2204 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_report_data_abort} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2205 Specifies whether data aborts cause an error to be reported
2206 by GDB memory read packets.
2207 The default behaviour is @option{disable};
2208 use @option{enable} see these errors reported.
2209 @end deffn
2210
2211 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_report_register_access_error} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2212 Specifies whether register accesses requested by GDB register read/write
2213 packets report errors or not.
2214 The default behaviour is @option{disable};
2215 use @option{enable} see these errors reported.
2216 @end deffn
2217
2218 @deffn {Config Command} {gdb_target_description} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2219 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the target descriptions to gdb via qXfer:features:read packet.
2220 The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2221 @end deffn
2222
2223 @deffn {Command} {gdb_save_tdesc}
2224 Saves the target description file to the local file system.
2225
2226 The file name is @i{target_name}.xml.
2227 @end deffn
2228
2229 @anchor{eventpolling}
2230 @section Event Polling
2231
2232 Hardware debuggers are parts of asynchronous systems,
2233 where significant events can happen at any time.
2234 The OpenOCD server needs to detect some of these events,
2235 so it can report them to through TCL command line
2236 or to GDB.
2237
2238 Examples of such events include:
2239
2240 @itemize
2241 @item One of the targets can stop running ... maybe it triggers
2242 a code breakpoint or data watchpoint, or halts itself.
2243 @item Messages may be sent over ``debug message'' channels ... many
2244 targets support such messages sent over JTAG,
2245 for receipt by the person debugging or tools.
2246 @item Loss of power ... some adapters can detect these events.
2247 @item Resets not issued through JTAG ... such reset sources
2248 can include button presses or other system hardware, sometimes
2249 including the target itself (perhaps through a watchdog).
2250 @item Debug instrumentation sometimes supports event triggering
2251 such as ``trace buffer full'' (so it can quickly be emptied)
2252 or other signals (to correlate with code behavior).
2253 @end itemize
2254
2255 None of those events are signaled through standard JTAG signals.
2256 However, most conventions for JTAG connectors include voltage
2257 level and system reset (SRST) signal detection.
2258 Some connectors also include instrumentation signals, which
2259 can imply events when those signals are inputs.
2260
2261 In general, OpenOCD needs to periodically check for those events,
2262 either by looking at the status of signals on the JTAG connector
2263 or by sending synchronous ``tell me your status'' JTAG requests
2264 to the various active targets.
2265 There is a command to manage and monitor that polling,
2266 which is normally done in the background.
2267
2268 @deffn {Command} {poll} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2269 Poll the current target for its current state.
2270 (Also, @pxref{targetcurstate,,target curstate}.)
2271 If that target is in debug mode, architecture
2272 specific information about the current state is printed.
2273 An optional parameter
2274 allows background polling to be enabled and disabled.
2275
2276 You could use this from the TCL command shell, or
2277 from GDB using @command{monitor poll} command.
2278 Leave background polling enabled while you're using GDB.
2279 @example
2280 > poll
2281 background polling: on
2282 target state: halted
2283 target halted in ARM state due to debug-request, \
2284 current mode: Supervisor
2285 cpsr: 0x800000d3 pc: 0x11081bfc
2286 MMU: disabled, D-Cache: disabled, I-Cache: enabled
2287 >
2288 @end example
2289 @end deffn
2290
2291 @node Debug Adapter Configuration
2292 @chapter Debug Adapter Configuration
2293 @cindex config file, interface
2294 @cindex interface config file
2295
2296 Correctly installing OpenOCD includes making your operating system give
2297 OpenOCD access to debug adapters. Once that has been done, Tcl commands
2298 are used to select which one is used, and to configure how it is used.
2299
2300 @quotation Note
2301 Because OpenOCD started out with a focus purely on JTAG, you may find
2302 places where it wrongly presumes JTAG is the only transport protocol
2303 in use. Be aware that recent versions of OpenOCD are removing that
2304 limitation. JTAG remains more functional than most other transports.
2305 Other transports do not support boundary scan operations, or may be
2306 specific to a given chip vendor. Some might be usable only for
2307 programming flash memory, instead of also for debugging.
2308 @end quotation
2309
2310 Debug Adapters/Interfaces/Dongles are normally configured
2311 through commands in an interface configuration
2312 file which is sourced by your @file{openocd.cfg} file, or
2313 through a command line @option{-f interface/....cfg} option.
2314
2315 @example
2316 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
2317 @end example
2318
2319 These commands tell
2320 OpenOCD what type of JTAG adapter you have, and how to talk to it.
2321 A few cases are so simple that you only need to say what driver to use:
2322
2323 @example
2324 # jlink interface
2325 adapter driver jlink
2326 @end example
2327
2328 Most adapters need a bit more configuration than that.
2329
2330
2331 @section Adapter Configuration
2332
2333 The @command{adapter driver} command tells OpenOCD what type of debug adapter you are
2334 using. Depending on the type of adapter, you may need to use one or
2335 more additional commands to further identify or configure the adapter.
2336
2337 @deffn {Config Command} {adapter driver} name
2338 Use the adapter driver @var{name} to connect to the
2339 target.
2340 @end deffn
2341
2342 @deffn {Command} {adapter list}
2343 List the debug adapter drivers that have been built into
2344 the running copy of OpenOCD.
2345 @end deffn
2346 @deffn {Config Command} {adapter transports} transport_name+
2347 Specifies the transports supported by this debug adapter.
2348 The adapter driver builds-in similar knowledge; use this only
2349 when external configuration (such as jumpering) changes what
2350 the hardware can support.
2351 @end deffn
2352
2353
2354
2355 @deffn {Command} {adapter name}
2356 Returns the name of the debug adapter driver being used.
2357 @end deffn
2358
2359 @anchor{adapter_usb_location}
2360 @deffn {Config Command} {adapter usb location} [<bus>-<port>[.<port>]...]
2361 Displays or specifies the physical USB port of the adapter to use. The path
2362 roots at @var{bus} and walks down the physical ports, with each
2363 @var{port} option specifying a deeper level in the bus topology, the last
2364 @var{port} denoting where the target adapter is actually plugged.
2365 The USB bus topology can be queried with the command @emph{lsusb -t} or @emph{dmesg}.
2366
2367 This command is only available if your libusb1 is at least version 1.0.16.
2368 @end deffn
2369
2370 @deffn {Config Command} {adapter serial} serial_string
2371 Specifies the @var{serial_string} of the adapter to use.
2372 If this command is not specified, serial strings are not checked.
2373 Only the following adapter drivers use the serial string from this command:
2374 aice (aice_usb), arm-jtag-ew, cmsis_dap, ft232r, ftdi, hla (stlink, ti-icdi), jlink, kitprog, opendus,
2375 openjtag, osbdm, presto, rlink, st-link, usb_blaster (ublast2), usbprog, vsllink, xds110.
2376 @end deffn
2377
2378 @section Interface Drivers
2379
2380 Each of the interface drivers listed here must be explicitly
2381 enabled when OpenOCD is configured, in order to be made
2382 available at run time.
2383
2384 @deffn {Interface Driver} {amt_jtagaccel}
2385 Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
2386 connected to a PC's EPP mode parallel port.
2387 This defines some driver-specific commands:
2388
2389 @deffn {Config Command} {parport port} number
2390 Specifies either the address of the I/O port (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or
2391 the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2392 @end deffn
2393
2394 @deffn {Config Command} {rtck} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
2395 Displays status of RTCK option.
2396 Optionally sets that option first.
2397 @end deffn
2398 @end deffn
2399
2400 @deffn {Interface Driver} {arm-jtag-ew}
2401 Olimex ARM-JTAG-EW USB adapter
2402 This has one driver-specific command:
2403
2404 @deffn {Command} {armjtagew_info}
2405 Logs some status
2406 @end deffn
2407 @end deffn
2408
2409 @deffn {Interface Driver} {at91rm9200}
2410 Supports bitbanged JTAG from the local system,
2411 presuming that system is an Atmel AT91rm9200
2412 and a specific set of GPIOs is used.
2413 @c command: at91rm9200_device NAME
2414 @c chooses among list of bit configs ... only one option
2415 @end deffn
2416
2417 @deffn {Interface Driver} {cmsis-dap}
2418 ARM CMSIS-DAP compliant based adapter v1 (USB HID based)
2419 or v2 (USB bulk).
2420
2421 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2422 The vendor ID and product ID of the CMSIS-DAP device. If not specified
2423 the driver will attempt to auto detect the CMSIS-DAP device.
2424 Currently, up to eight [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2425 @example
2426 cmsis_dap_vid_pid 0xc251 0xf001 0x0d28 0x0204
2427 @end example
2428 @end deffn
2429
2430 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_backend} [@option{auto}|@option{usb_bulk}|@option{hid}]
2431 Specifies how to communicate with the adapter:
2432
2433 @itemize @minus
2434 @item @option{hid} Use HID generic reports - CMSIS-DAP v1
2435 @item @option{usb_bulk} Use USB bulk - CMSIS-DAP v2
2436 @item @option{auto} First try USB bulk CMSIS-DAP v2, if not found try HID CMSIS-DAP v1.
2437 This is the default if @command{cmsis_dap_backend} is not specified.
2438 @end itemize
2439 @end deffn
2440
2441 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_usb interface} [number]
2442 Specifies the @var{number} of the USB interface to use in v2 mode (USB bulk).
2443 In most cases need not to be specified and interfaces are searched by
2444 interface string or for user class interface.
2445 @end deffn
2446
2447 @deffn {Command} {cmsis-dap info}
2448 Display various device information, like hardware version, firmware version, current bus status.
2449 @end deffn
2450
2451 @deffn {Command} {cmsis-dap cmd} number number ...
2452 Execute an arbitrary CMSIS-DAP command. Use for adapter testing or for handling
2453 of an adapter vendor specific command from a Tcl script.
2454
2455 Take given numbers as bytes, assemble a CMSIS-DAP protocol command packet
2456 from them and send it to the adapter. The first 4 bytes of the adapter response
2457 are logged.
2458 See @url{https://arm-software.github.io/CMSIS_5/DAP/html/group__DAP__Commands__gr.html}
2459 @end deffn
2460 @end deffn
2461
2462 @deffn {Interface Driver} {dummy}
2463 A dummy software-only driver for debugging.
2464 @end deffn
2465
2466 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ep93xx}
2467 Cirrus Logic EP93xx based single-board computer bit-banging (in development)
2468 @end deffn
2469
2470 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ftdi}
2471 This driver is for adapters using the MPSSE (Multi-Protocol Synchronous Serial
2472 Engine) mode built into many FTDI chips, such as the FT2232, FT4232 and FT232H.
2473
2474 The driver is using libusb-1.0 in asynchronous mode to talk to the FTDI device,
2475 bypassing intermediate libraries like libftdi.
2476
2477 Support for new FTDI based adapters can be added completely through
2478 configuration files, without the need to patch and rebuild OpenOCD.
2479
2480 The driver uses a signal abstraction to enable Tcl configuration files to
2481 define outputs for one or several FTDI GPIO. These outputs can then be
2482 controlled using the @command{ftdi set_signal} command. Special signal names
2483 are reserved for nTRST, nSRST and LED (for blink) so that they, if defined,
2484 will be used for their customary purpose. Inputs can be read using the
2485 @command{ftdi get_signal} command.
2486
2487 To support SWD, a signal named SWD_EN must be defined. It is set to 1 when the
2488 SWD protocol is selected. When set, the adapter should route the SWDIO pin to
2489 the data input. An SWDIO_OE signal, if defined, will be set to 1 or 0 as
2490 required by the protocol, to tell the adapter to drive the data output onto
2491 the SWDIO pin or keep the SWDIO pin Hi-Z, respectively.
2492
2493 Depending on the type of buffer attached to the FTDI GPIO, the outputs have to
2494 be controlled differently. In order to support tristateable signals such as
2495 nSRST, both a data GPIO and an output-enable GPIO can be specified for each
2496 signal. The following output buffer configurations are supported:
2497
2498 @itemize @minus
2499 @item Push-pull with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line
2500 @item Open drain with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2501 @item Tristate with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line and another
2502 FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2503 @item Unbuffered, using the FTDI GPIO as a tristate output directly by
2504 switching data and direction as necessary
2505 @end itemize
2506
2507 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2508 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2509
2510 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2511 The vendor ID and product ID of the adapter. Up to eight
2512 [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2513 @example
2514 ftdi vid_pid 0x0403 0xcff8 0x15ba 0x0003
2515 @end example
2516 @end deffn
2517
2518 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi device_desc} description
2519 Provides the USB device description (the @emph{iProduct string})
2520 of the adapter. If not specified, the device description is ignored
2521 during device selection.
2522 @end deffn
2523
2524 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi channel} channel
2525 Selects the channel of the FTDI device to use for MPSSE operations. Most
2526 adapters use the default, channel 0, but there are exceptions.
2527 @end deffn
2528
2529 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi layout_init} data direction
2530 Specifies the initial values of the FTDI GPIO data and direction registers.
2531 Each value is a 16-bit number corresponding to the concatenation of the high
2532 and low FTDI GPIO registers. The values should be selected based on the
2533 schematics of the adapter, such that all signals are set to safe levels with
2534 minimal impact on the target system. Avoid floating inputs, conflicting outputs
2535 and initially asserted reset signals.
2536 @end deffn
2537
2538 @deffn {Command} {ftdi layout_signal} name [@option{-data}|@option{-ndata} data_mask] [@option{-input}|@option{-ninput} input_mask] [@option{-oe}|@option{-noe} oe_mask] [@option{-alias}|@option{-nalias} name]
2539 Creates a signal with the specified @var{name}, controlled by one or more FTDI
2540 GPIO pins via a range of possible buffer connections. The masks are FTDI GPIO
2541 register bitmasks to tell the driver the connection and type of the output
2542 buffer driving the respective signal. @var{data_mask} is the bitmask for the
2543 pin(s) connected to the data input of the output buffer. @option{-ndata} is
2544 used with inverting data inputs and @option{-data} with non-inverting inputs.
2545 The @option{-oe} (or @option{-noe}) option tells where the output-enable (or
2546 not-output-enable) input to the output buffer is connected. The options
2547 @option{-input} and @option{-ninput} specify the bitmask for pins to be read
2548 with the method @command{ftdi get_signal}.
2549
2550 Both @var{data_mask} and @var{oe_mask} need not be specified. For example, a
2551 simple open-collector transistor driver would be specified with @option{-oe}
2552 only. In that case the signal can only be set to drive low or to Hi-Z and the
2553 driver will complain if the signal is set to drive high. Which means that if
2554 it's a reset signal, @command{reset_config} must be specified as
2555 @option{srst_open_drain}, not @option{srst_push_pull}.
2556
2557 A special case is provided when @option{-data} and @option{-oe} is set to the
2558 same bitmask. Then the FTDI pin is considered being connected straight to the
2559 target without any buffer. The FTDI pin is then switched between output and
2560 input as necessary to provide the full set of low, high and Hi-Z
2561 characteristics. In all other cases, the pins specified in a signal definition
2562 are always driven by the FTDI.
2563
2564 If @option{-alias} or @option{-nalias} is used, the signal is created
2565 identical (or with data inverted) to an already specified signal
2566 @var{name}.
2567 @end deffn
2568
2569 @deffn {Command} {ftdi set_signal} name @option{0}|@option{1}|@option{z}
2570 Set a previously defined signal to the specified level.
2571 @itemize @minus
2572 @item @option{0}, drive low
2573 @item @option{1}, drive high
2574 @item @option{z}, set to high-impedance
2575 @end itemize
2576 @end deffn
2577
2578 @deffn {Command} {ftdi get_signal} name
2579 Get the value of a previously defined signal.
2580 @end deffn
2581
2582 @deffn {Command} {ftdi tdo_sample_edge} @option{rising}|@option{falling}
2583 Configure TCK edge at which the adapter samples the value of the TDO signal
2584
2585 Due to signal propagation delays, sampling TDO on rising TCK can become quite
2586 peculiar at high JTAG clock speeds. However, FTDI chips offer a possibility to sample
2587 TDO on falling edge of TCK. With some board/adapter configurations, this may increase
2588 stability at higher JTAG clocks.
2589 @itemize @minus
2590 @item @option{rising}, sample TDO on rising edge of TCK - this is the default
2591 @item @option{falling}, sample TDO on falling edge of TCK
2592 @end itemize
2593 @end deffn
2594
2595 For example adapter definitions, see the configuration files shipped in the
2596 @file{interface/ftdi} directory.
2597
2598 @end deffn
2599
2600 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ft232r}
2601 This driver is implementing synchronous bitbang mode of an FTDI FT232R,
2602 FT230X, FT231X and similar USB UART bridge ICs by reusing RS232 signals as GPIO.
2603 It currently doesn't support using CBUS pins as GPIO.
2604
2605 List of connections (default physical pin numbers for FT232R in 28-pin SSOP package):
2606 @itemize @minus
2607 @item RXD(5) - TDI
2608 @item TXD(1) - TCK
2609 @item RTS(3) - TDO
2610 @item CTS(11) - TMS
2611 @item DTR(2) - TRST
2612 @item DCD(10) - SRST
2613 @end itemize
2614
2615 User can change default pinout by supplying configuration
2616 commands with GPIO numbers or RS232 signal names.
2617 GPIO numbers correspond to bit numbers in FTDI GPIO register.
2618 They differ from physical pin numbers.
2619 For details see actual FTDI chip datasheets.
2620 Every JTAG line must be configured to unique GPIO number
2621 different than any other JTAG line, even those lines
2622 that are sometimes not used like TRST or SRST.
2623
2624 FT232R
2625 @itemize @minus
2626 @item bit 7 - RI
2627 @item bit 6 - DCD
2628 @item bit 5 - DSR
2629 @item bit 4 - DTR
2630 @item bit 3 - CTS
2631 @item bit 2 - RTS
2632 @item bit 1 - RXD
2633 @item bit 0 - TXD
2634 @end itemize
2635
2636 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2637 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2638
2639 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r vid_pid} @var{vid} @var{pid}
2640 The vendor ID and product ID of the adapter. If not specified, default
2641 0x0403:0x6001 is used.
2642 @end deffn
2643
2644 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r jtag_nums} @var{tck} @var{tms} @var{tdi} @var{tdo}
2645 Set four JTAG GPIO numbers at once.
2646 If not specified, default 0 3 1 2 or TXD CTS RXD RTS is used.
2647 @end deffn
2648
2649 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r tck_num} @var{tck}
2650 Set TCK GPIO number. If not specified, default 0 or TXD is used.
2651 @end deffn
2652
2653 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r tms_num} @var{tms}
2654 Set TMS GPIO number. If not specified, default 3 or CTS is used.
2655 @end deffn
2656
2657 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r tdi_num} @var{tdi}
2658 Set TDI GPIO number. If not specified, default 1 or RXD is used.
2659 @end deffn
2660
2661 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r tdo_num} @var{tdo}
2662 Set TDO GPIO number. If not specified, default 2 or RTS is used.
2663 @end deffn
2664
2665 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r trst_num} @var{trst}
2666 Set TRST GPIO number. If not specified, default 4 or DTR is used.
2667 @end deffn
2668
2669 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r srst_num} @var{srst}
2670 Set SRST GPIO number. If not specified, default 6 or DCD is used.
2671 @end deffn
2672
2673 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r restore_serial} @var{word}
2674 Restore serial port after JTAG. This USB bitmode control word
2675 (16-bit) will be sent before quit. Lower byte should
2676 set GPIO direction register to a "sane" state:
2677 0x15 for TXD RTS DTR as outputs (1), others as inputs (0). Higher
2678 byte is usually 0 to disable bitbang mode.
2679 When kernel driver reattaches, serial port should continue to work.
2680 Value 0xFFFF disables sending control word and serial port,
2681 then kernel driver will not reattach.
2682 If not specified, default 0xFFFF is used.
2683 @end deffn
2684
2685 @end deffn
2686
2687 @deffn {Interface Driver} {remote_bitbang}
2688 Drive JTAG from a remote process. This sets up a UNIX or TCP socket connection
2689 with a remote process and sends ASCII encoded bitbang requests to that process
2690 instead of directly driving JTAG.
2691
2692 The remote_bitbang driver is useful for debugging software running on
2693 processors which are being simulated.
2694
2695 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang port} number
2696 Specifies the TCP port of the remote process to connect to or 0 to use UNIX
2697 sockets instead of TCP.
2698 @end deffn
2699
2700 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang host} hostname
2701 Specifies the hostname of the remote process to connect to using TCP, or the
2702 name of the UNIX socket to use if remote_bitbang port is 0.
2703 @end deffn
2704
2705 For example, to connect remotely via TCP to the host foobar you might have
2706 something like:
2707
2708 @example
2709 adapter driver remote_bitbang
2710 remote_bitbang port 3335
2711 remote_bitbang host foobar
2712 @end example
2713
2714 To connect to another process running locally via UNIX sockets with socket
2715 named mysocket:
2716
2717 @example
2718 adapter driver remote_bitbang
2719 remote_bitbang port 0
2720 remote_bitbang host mysocket
2721 @end example
2722 @end deffn
2723
2724 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usb_blaster}
2725 USB JTAG/USB-Blaster compatibles over one of the userspace libraries
2726 for FTDI chips. These interfaces have several commands, used to
2727 configure the driver before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2728
2729 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster vid_pid} vid pid
2730 The vendor ID and product ID of the FTDI FT245 device. If not specified,
2731 default values are used.
2732 Currently, only one @var{vid}, @var{pid} pair may be given, e.g. for
2733 Altera USB-Blaster (default):
2734 @example
2735 usb_blaster vid_pid 0x09FB 0x6001
2736 @end example
2737 The following VID/PID is for Kolja Waschk's USB JTAG:
2738 @example
2739 usb_blaster vid_pid 0x16C0 0x06AD
2740 @end example
2741 @end deffn
2742
2743 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster pin} (@option{pin6}|@option{pin8}) (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{s}|@option{t})
2744 Sets the state or function of the unused GPIO pins on USB-Blasters
2745 (pins 6 and 8 on the female JTAG header). These pins can be used as
2746 SRST and/or TRST provided the appropriate connections are made on the
2747 target board.
2748
2749 For example, to use pin 6 as SRST:
2750 @example
2751 usb_blaster pin pin6 s
2752 reset_config srst_only
2753 @end example
2754 @end deffn
2755
2756 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster lowlevel_driver} (@option{ftdi}|@option{ublast2})
2757 Chooses the low level access method for the adapter. If not specified,
2758 @option{ftdi} is selected unless it wasn't enabled during the
2759 configure stage. USB-Blaster II needs @option{ublast2}.
2760 @end deffn
2761
2762 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster firmware} @var{path}
2763 This command specifies @var{path} to access USB-Blaster II firmware
2764 image. To be used with USB-Blaster II only.
2765 @end deffn
2766
2767 @end deffn
2768
2769 @deffn {Interface Driver} {gw16012}
2770 Gateworks GW16012 JTAG programmer.
2771 This has one driver-specific command:
2772
2773 @deffn {Config Command} {parport port} [port_number]
2774 Display either the address of the I/O port
2775 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2776 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
2777 This is a write-once setting.
2778 @end deffn
2779 @end deffn
2780
2781 @deffn {Interface Driver} {jlink}
2782 SEGGER J-Link family of USB adapters. It currently supports JTAG and SWD
2783 transports.
2784
2785 @quotation Compatibility Note
2786 SEGGER released many firmware versions for the many hardware versions they
2787 produced. OpenOCD was extensively tested and intended to run on all of them,
2788 but some combinations were reported as incompatible. As a general
2789 recommendation, it is advisable to use the latest firmware version
2790 available for each hardware version. However the current V8 is a moving
2791 target, and SEGGER firmware versions released after the OpenOCD was
2792 released may not be compatible. In such cases it is recommended to
2793 revert to the last known functional version. For 0.5.0, this is from
2794 "Feb 8 2012 14:30:39", packed with 4.42c. For 0.6.0, the last known
2795 version is from "May 3 2012 18:36:22", packed with 4.46f.
2796 @end quotation
2797
2798 @deffn {Command} {jlink hwstatus}
2799 Display various hardware related information, for example target voltage and pin
2800 states.
2801 @end deffn
2802 @deffn {Command} {jlink freemem}
2803 Display free device internal memory.
2804 @end deffn
2805 @deffn {Command} {jlink jtag} [@option{2}|@option{3}]
2806 Set the JTAG command version to be used. Without argument, show the actual JTAG
2807 command version.
2808 @end deffn
2809 @deffn {Command} {jlink config}
2810 Display the device configuration.
2811 @end deffn
2812 @deffn {Command} {jlink config targetpower} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2813 Set the target power state on JTAG-pin 19. Without argument, show the target
2814 power state.
2815 @end deffn
2816 @deffn {Command} {jlink config mac} [@option{ff:ff:ff:ff:ff:ff}]
2817 Set the MAC address of the device. Without argument, show the MAC address.
2818 @end deffn
2819 @deffn {Command} {jlink config ip} [@option{A.B.C.D}(@option{/E}|@option{F.G.H.I})]
2820 Set the IP configuration of the device, where A.B.C.D is the IP address, E the
2821 bit of the subnet mask and F.G.H.I the subnet mask. Without arguments, show the
2822 IP configuration.
2823 @end deffn
2824 @deffn {Command} {jlink config usb} [@option{0} to @option{3}]
2825 Set the USB address of the device. This will also change the USB Product ID
2826 (PID) of the device. Without argument, show the USB address.
2827 @end deffn
2828 @deffn {Command} {jlink config reset}
2829 Reset the current configuration.
2830 @end deffn
2831 @deffn {Command} {jlink config write}
2832 Write the current configuration to the internal persistent storage.
2833 @end deffn
2834 @deffn {Command} {jlink emucom write} <channel> <data>
2835 Write data to an EMUCOM channel. The data needs to be encoded as hexadecimal
2836 pairs.
2837
2838 The following example shows how to write the three bytes 0xaa, 0x0b and 0x23 to
2839 the EMUCOM channel 0x10:
2840 @example
2841 > jlink emucom write 0x10 aa0b23
2842 @end example
2843 @end deffn
2844 @deffn {Command} {jlink emucom read} <channel> <length>
2845 Read data from an EMUCOM channel. The read data is encoded as hexadecimal
2846 pairs.
2847
2848 The following example shows how to read 4 bytes from the EMUCOM channel 0x0:
2849 @example
2850 > jlink emucom read 0x0 4
2851 77a90000
2852 @end example
2853 @end deffn
2854 @deffn {Config Command} {jlink usb} <@option{0} to @option{3}>
2855 Set the USB address of the interface, in case more than one adapter is connected
2856 to the host. If not specified, USB addresses are not considered. Device
2857 selection via USB address is not always unambiguous. It is recommended to use
2858 the serial number instead, if possible.
2859
2860 As a configuration command, it can be used only before 'init'.
2861 @end deffn
2862 @end deffn
2863
2864 @deffn {Interface Driver} {kitprog}
2865 This driver is for Cypress Semiconductor's KitProg adapters. The KitProg is an
2866 SWD-only adapter that is designed to be used with Cypress's PSoC and PRoC device
2867 families, but it is possible to use it with some other devices. If you are using
2868 this adapter with a PSoC or a PRoC, you may need to add
2869 @command{kitprog_init_acquire_psoc} or @command{kitprog acquire_psoc} to your
2870 configuration script.
2871
2872 Note that this driver is for the proprietary KitProg protocol, not the CMSIS-DAP
2873 mode introduced in firmware 2.14. If the KitProg is in CMSIS-DAP mode, it cannot
2874 be used with this driver, and must either be used with the cmsis-dap driver or
2875 switched back to KitProg mode. See the Cypress KitProg User Guide for
2876 instructions on how to switch KitProg modes.
2877
2878 Known limitations:
2879 @itemize @bullet
2880 @item The frequency of SWCLK cannot be configured, and varies between 1.6 MHz
2881 and 2.7 MHz.
2882 @item For firmware versions below 2.14, "JTAG to SWD" sequences are replaced by
2883 "SWD line reset" in the driver. This is for two reasons. First, the KitProg does
2884 not support sending arbitrary SWD sequences, and only firmware 2.14 and later
2885 implement both "JTAG to SWD" and "SWD line reset" in firmware. Earlier firmware
2886 versions only implement "SWD line reset". Second, due to a firmware quirk, an
2887 SWD sequence must be sent after every target reset in order to re-establish
2888 communications with the target.
2889 @item Due in part to the limitation above, KitProg devices with firmware below
2890 version 2.14 will need to use @command{kitprog_init_acquire_psoc} in order to
2891 communicate with PSoC 5LP devices. This is because, assuming debug is not
2892 disabled on the PSoC, the PSoC 5LP needs its JTAG interface switched to SWD
2893 mode before communication can begin, but prior to firmware 2.14, "JTAG to SWD"
2894 could only be sent with an acquisition sequence.
2895 @end itemize
2896
2897 @deffn {Config Command} {kitprog_init_acquire_psoc}
2898 Indicate that a PSoC acquisition sequence needs to be run during adapter init.
2899 Please be aware that the acquisition sequence hard-resets the target.
2900 @end deffn
2901
2902 @deffn {Command} {kitprog acquire_psoc}
2903 Run a PSoC acquisition sequence immediately. Typically, this should not be used
2904 outside of the target-specific configuration scripts since it hard-resets the
2905 target as a side-effect.
2906 This is necessary for "reset halt" on some PSoC 4 series devices.
2907 @end deffn
2908
2909 @deffn {Command} {kitprog info}
2910 Display various adapter information, such as the hardware version, firmware
2911 version, and target voltage.
2912 @end deffn
2913 @end deffn
2914
2915 @deffn {Interface Driver} {parport}
2916 Supports PC parallel port bit-banging cables:
2917 Wigglers, PLD download cable, and more.
2918 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2919 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2920
2921 @deffn {Config Command} {parport cable} name
2922 Set the layout of the parallel port cable used to connect to the target.
2923 This is a write-once setting.
2924 Currently valid cable @var{name} values include:
2925
2926 @itemize @minus
2927 @item @b{altium} Altium Universal JTAG cable.
2928 @item @b{arm-jtag} Same as original wiggler except SRST and
2929 TRST connections reversed and TRST is also inverted.
2930 @item @b{chameleon} The Amontec Chameleon's CPLD when operated
2931 in configuration mode. This is only used to
2932 program the Chameleon itself, not a connected target.
2933 @item @b{dlc5} The Xilinx Parallel cable III.
2934 @item @b{flashlink} The ST Parallel cable.
2935 @item @b{lattice} Lattice ispDOWNLOAD Cable
2936 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler} The Wiggler configuration that comes with
2937 some versions of
2938 Amontec's Chameleon Programmer. The new version available from
2939 the website uses the original Wiggler layout ('@var{wiggler}')
2940 @item @b{triton} The parallel port adapter found on the
2941 ``Karo Triton 1 Development Board''.
2942 This is also the layout used by the HollyGates design
2943 (see @uref{http://www.lartmaker.nl/projects/jtag/}).
2944 @item @b{wiggler} The original Wiggler layout, also supported by
2945 several clones, such as the Olimex ARM-JTAG
2946 @item @b{wiggler2} Same as original wiggler except an led is fitted on D5.
2947 @item @b{wiggler_ntrst_inverted} Same as original wiggler except TRST is inverted.
2948 @end itemize
2949 @end deffn
2950
2951 @deffn {Config Command} {parport port} [port_number]
2952 Display either the address of the I/O port
2953 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2954 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
2955 This is a write-once setting.
2956
2957 When using PPDEV to access the parallel port, use the number of the parallel port:
2958 @option{parport port 0} (the default). If @option{parport port 0x378} is specified
2959 you may encounter a problem.
2960 @end deffn
2961
2962 @deffn {Config Command} {parport toggling_time} [nanoseconds]
2963 Displays how many nanoseconds the hardware needs to toggle TCK;
2964 the parport driver uses this value to obey the
2965 @command{adapter speed} configuration.
2966 When the optional @var{nanoseconds} parameter is given,
2967 that setting is changed before displaying the current value.
2968
2969 The default setting should work reasonably well on commodity PC hardware.
2970 However, you may want to calibrate for your specific hardware.
2971 @quotation Tip
2972 To measure the toggling time with a logic analyzer or a digital storage
2973 oscilloscope, follow the procedure below:
2974 @example
2975 > parport toggling_time 1000
2976 > adapter speed 500
2977 @end example
2978 This sets the maximum JTAG clock speed of the hardware, but
2979 the actual speed probably deviates from the requested 500 kHz.
2980 Now, measure the time between the two closest spaced TCK transitions.
2981 You can use @command{runtest 1000} or something similar to generate a
2982 large set of samples.
2983 Update the setting to match your measurement:
2984 @example
2985 > parport toggling_time <measured nanoseconds>
2986 @end example
2987 Now the clock speed will be a better match for @command{adapter speed}
2988 command given in OpenOCD scripts and event handlers.
2989
2990 You can do something similar with many digital multimeters, but note
2991 that you'll probably need to run the clock continuously for several
2992 seconds before it decides what clock rate to show. Adjust the
2993 toggling time up or down until the measured clock rate is a good
2994 match with the rate you specified in the @command{adapter speed} command;
2995 be conservative.
2996 @end quotation
2997 @end deffn
2998
2999 @deffn {Config Command} {parport write_on_exit} (@option{on}|@option{off})
3000 This will configure the parallel driver to write a known
3001 cable-specific value to the parallel interface on exiting OpenOCD.
3002 @end deffn
3003
3004 For example, the interface configuration file for a
3005 classic ``Wiggler'' cable on LPT2 might look something like this:
3006
3007 @example
3008 adapter driver parport
3009 parport port 0x278
3010 parport cable wiggler
3011 @end example
3012 @end deffn
3013
3014 @deffn {Interface Driver} {presto}
3015 ASIX PRESTO USB JTAG programmer.
3016 @end deffn
3017
3018 @deffn {Interface Driver} {rlink}
3019 Raisonance RLink USB adapter
3020 @end deffn
3021
3022 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usbprog}
3023 usbprog is a freely programmable USB adapter.
3024 @end deffn
3025
3026 @deffn {Interface Driver} {vsllink}
3027 vsllink is part of Versaloon which is a versatile USB programmer.
3028
3029 @quotation Note
3030 This defines quite a few driver-specific commands,
3031 which are not currently documented here.
3032 @end quotation
3033 @end deffn
3034
3035 @anchor{hla_interface}
3036 @deffn {Interface Driver} {hla}
3037 This is a driver that supports multiple High Level Adapters.
3038 This type of adapter does not expose some of the lower level api's
3039 that OpenOCD would normally use to access the target.
3040
3041 Currently supported adapters include the STMicroelectronics ST-LINK, TI ICDI
3042 and Nuvoton Nu-Link.
3043 ST-LINK firmware version >= V2.J21.S4 recommended due to issues with earlier
3044 versions of firmware where serial number is reset after first use. Suggest
3045 using ST firmware update utility to upgrade ST-LINK firmware even if current
3046 version reported is V2.J21.S4.
3047
3048 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_device_desc} description
3049 Currently Not Supported.
3050 @end deffn
3051
3052 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_layout} (@option{stlink}|@option{icdi}|@option{nulink})
3053 Specifies the adapter layout to use.
3054 @end deffn
3055
3056 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
3057 Pairs of vendor IDs and product IDs of the device.
3058 @end deffn
3059
3060 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_stlink_backend} (usb | tcp [port])
3061 @emph{ST-Link only:} Choose between 'exclusive' USB communication (the default backend) or
3062 'shared' mode using ST-Link TCP server (the default port is 7184).
3063
3064 @emph{Note:} ST-Link TCP server is a binary application provided by ST
3065 available from @url{https://www.st.com/en/development-tools/st-link-server.html,
3066 ST-LINK server software module}.
3067 @end deffn
3068
3069 @deffn {Command} {hla_command} command
3070 Execute a custom adapter-specific command. The @var{command} string is
3071 passed as is to the underlying adapter layout handler.
3072 @end deffn
3073 @end deffn
3074
3075 @anchor{st_link_dap_interface}
3076 @deffn {Interface Driver} {st-link}
3077 This is a driver that supports STMicroelectronics adapters ST-LINK/V2
3078 (from firmware V2J24) and STLINK-V3, thanks to a new API that provides
3079 directly access the arm ADIv5 DAP.
3080
3081 The new API provide access to multiple AP on the same DAP, but the
3082 maximum number of the AP port is limited by the specific firmware version
3083 (e.g. firmware V2J29 has 3 as maximum AP number, while V2J32 has 8).
3084 An error is returned for any AP number above the maximum allowed value.
3085
3086 @emph{Note:} Either these same adapters and their older versions are
3087 also supported by @ref{hla_interface, the hla interface driver}.
3088
3089 @deffn {Config Command} {st-link backend} (usb | tcp [port])
3090 Choose between 'exclusive' USB communication (the default backend) or
3091 'shared' mode using ST-Link TCP server (the default port is 7184).
3092
3093 @emph{Note:} ST-Link TCP server is a binary application provided by ST
3094 available from @url{https://www.st.com/en/development-tools/st-link-server.html,
3095 ST-LINK server software module}.
3096
3097 @emph{Note:} ST-Link TCP server does not support the SWIM transport.
3098 @end deffn
3099
3100 @deffn {Config Command} {st-link vid_pid} [vid pid]+
3101 Pairs of vendor IDs and product IDs of the device.
3102 @end deffn
3103
3104 @deffn {Command} {st-link cmd} rx_n (tx_byte)+
3105 Sends an arbitrary command composed by the sequence of bytes @var{tx_byte}
3106 and receives @var{rx_n} bytes.
3107
3108 For example, the command to read the target's supply voltage is one byte 0xf7 followed
3109 by 15 bytes zero. It returns 8 bytes, where the first 4 bytes represent the ADC sampling
3110 of the reference voltage 1.2V and the last 4 bytes represent the ADC sampling of half
3111 the target's supply voltage.
3112 @example
3113 > st-link cmd 8 0xf7 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
3114 0xf1 0x05 0x00 0x00 0x0b 0x08 0x00 0x00
3115 @end example
3116 The result can be converted to Volts (ignoring the most significant bytes, always zero)
3117 @example
3118 > set a [st-link cmd 8 0xf7 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0]
3119 > echo [expr 2*1.2*([lindex $a 4]+256*[lindex $a 5])/([lindex $a 0]+256*[lindex $a 1])]
3120 3.24891518738
3121 @end example
3122 @end deffn
3123 @end deffn
3124
3125 @deffn {Interface Driver} {opendous}
3126 opendous-jtag is a freely programmable USB adapter.
3127 @end deffn
3128
3129 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ulink}
3130 This is the Keil ULINK v1 JTAG debugger.
3131 @end deffn
3132
3133 @deffn {Interface Driver} {xds110}
3134 The XDS110 is included as the embedded debug probe on many Texas Instruments
3135 LaunchPad evaluation boards. The XDS110 is also available as a stand-alone USB
3136 debug probe with the added capability to supply power to the target board. The
3137 following commands are supported by the XDS110 driver:
3138
3139 @deffn {Config Command} {xds110 supply} voltage_in_millivolts
3140 Available only on the XDS110 stand-alone probe. Sets the voltage level of the
3141 XDS110 power supply. A value of 0 leaves the supply off. Otherwise, the supply
3142 can be set to any value in the range 1800 to 3600 millivolts.
3143 @end deffn
3144
3145 @deffn {Command} {xds110 info}
3146 Displays information about the connected XDS110 debug probe (e.g. firmware
3147 version).
3148 @end deffn
3149 @end deffn
3150
3151 @deffn {Interface Driver} {xlnx_pcie_xvc}
3152 This driver supports the Xilinx Virtual Cable (XVC) over PCI Express.
3153 It is commonly found in Xilinx based PCI Express designs. It allows debugging
3154 fabric based JTAG/SWD devices such as Cortex-M1/M3 microcontrollers. Access to this is
3155 exposed via extended capability registers in the PCI Express configuration space.
3156
3157 For more information see Xilinx PG245 (Section on From_PCIE_to_JTAG mode).
3158
3159 @deffn {Config Command} {xlnx_pcie_xvc config} device
3160 Specifies the PCI Express device via parameter @var{device} to use.
3161
3162 The correct value for @var{device} can be obtained by looking at the output
3163 of lscpi -D (first column) for the corresponding device.
3164
3165 The string will be of the format "DDDD:BB:SS.F" such as "0000:65:00.1".
3166
3167 @end deffn
3168 @end deffn
3169
3170 @deffn {Interface Driver} {bcm2835gpio}
3171 This SoC is present in Raspberry Pi which is a cheap single-board computer
3172 exposing some GPIOs on its expansion header.
3173
3174 The driver accesses memory-mapped GPIO peripheral registers directly
3175 for maximum performance, but the only possible race condition is for
3176 the pins' modes/muxing (which is highly unlikely), so it should be
3177 able to coexist nicely with both sysfs bitbanging and various
3178 peripherals' kernel drivers. The driver restores the previous
3179 configuration on exit.
3180
3181 GPIO numbers >= 32 can't be used for performance reasons.
3182
3183 See @file{interface/raspberrypi-native.cfg} for a sample config and
3184 pinout.
3185
3186 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio jtag_nums} @var{tck} @var{tms} @var{tdi} @var{tdo}
3187 Set JTAG transport GPIO numbers for TCK, TMS, TDI, and TDO (in that order).
3188 Must be specified to enable JTAG transport. These pins can also be specified
3189 individually.
3190 @end deffn
3191
3192 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio tck_num} @var{tck}
3193 Set TCK GPIO number. Must be specified to enable JTAG transport. Can also be
3194 specified using the configuration command @command{bcm2835gpio jtag_nums}.
3195 @end deffn
3196
3197 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio tms_num} @var{tms}
3198 Set TMS GPIO number. Must be specified to enable JTAG transport. Can also be
3199 specified using the configuration command @command{bcm2835gpio jtag_nums}.
3200 @end deffn
3201
3202 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio tdo_num} @var{tdo}
3203 Set TDO GPIO number. Must be specified to enable JTAG transport. Can also be
3204 specified using the configuration command @command{bcm2835gpio jtag_nums}.
3205 @end deffn
3206
3207 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio tdi_num} @var{tdi}
3208 Set TDI GPIO number. Must be specified to enable JTAG transport. Can also be
3209 specified using the configuration command @command{bcm2835gpio jtag_nums}.
3210 @end deffn
3211
3212 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio swd_nums} @var{swclk} @var{swdio}
3213 Set SWD transport GPIO numbers for SWCLK and SWDIO (in that order). Must be
3214 specified to enable SWD transport. These pins can also be specified individually.
3215 @end deffn
3216
3217 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio swclk_num} @var{swclk}
3218 Set SWCLK GPIO number. Must be specified to enable SWD transport. Can also be
3219 specified using the configuration command @command{bcm2835gpio swd_nums}.
3220 @end deffn
3221
3222 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio swdio_num} @var{swdio}
3223 Set SWDIO GPIO number. Must be specified to enable SWD transport. Can also be
3224 specified using the configuration command @command{bcm2835gpio swd_nums}.
3225 @end deffn
3226
3227 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio swdio_dir_num} @var{swdio} @var{dir}
3228 Set SWDIO direction control pin GPIO number. If specified, this pin can be used
3229 to control the direction of an external buffer on the SWDIO pin (set=output
3230 mode, clear=input mode). If not specified, this feature is disabled.
3231 @end deffn
3232
3233 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio srst_num} @var{srst}
3234 Set SRST GPIO number. Must be specified to enable SRST.
3235 @end deffn
3236
3237 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio trst_num} @var{trst}
3238 Set TRST GPIO number. Must be specified to enable TRST.
3239 @end deffn
3240
3241 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio speed_coeffs} @var{speed_coeff} @var{speed_offset}
3242 Set SPEED_COEFF and SPEED_OFFSET for delay calculations. If unspecified,
3243 speed_coeff defaults to 113714, and speed_offset defaults to 28.
3244 @end deffn
3245
3246 @deffn {Config Command} {bcm2835gpio peripheral_base} @var{base}
3247 Set the peripheral base register address to access GPIOs. For the RPi1, use
3248 0x20000000. For RPi2 and RPi3, use 0x3F000000. For RPi4, use 0xFE000000. A full
3249 list can be found in the
3250 @uref{https://www.raspberrypi.org/documentation/hardware/raspberrypi/peripheral_addresses.md, official guide}.
3251 @end deffn
3252
3253 @end deffn
3254
3255 @deffn {Interface Driver} {imx_gpio}
3256 i.MX SoC is present in many community boards. Wandboard is an example
3257 of the one which is most popular.
3258
3259 This driver is mostly the same as bcm2835gpio.
3260
3261 See @file{interface/imx-native.cfg} for a sample config and
3262 pinout.
3263
3264 @end deffn
3265
3266
3267 @deffn {Interface Driver} {linuxgpiod}
3268 Linux provides userspace access to GPIO through libgpiod since Linux kernel version v4.6.
3269 The driver emulates either JTAG and SWD transport through bitbanging.
3270
3271 See @file{interface/dln-2-gpiod.cfg} for a sample config.
3272 @end deffn
3273
3274
3275 @deffn {Interface Driver} {sysfsgpio}
3276 Linux legacy userspace access to GPIO through sysfs is deprecated from Linux kernel version v5.3.
3277 Prefer using @b{linuxgpiod}, instead.
3278
3279 See @file{interface/sysfsgpio-raspberrypi.cfg} for a sample config.
3280 @end deffn
3281
3282
3283 @deffn {Interface Driver} {openjtag}
3284 OpenJTAG compatible USB adapter.
3285 This defines some driver-specific commands:
3286
3287 @deffn {Config Command} {openjtag variant} variant
3288 Specifies the variant of the OpenJTAG adapter (see @uref{http://www.openjtag.org/}).
3289 Currently valid @var{variant} values include:
3290
3291 @itemize @minus
3292 @item @b{standard} Standard variant (default).
3293 @item @b{cy7c65215} Cypress CY7C65215 Dual Channel USB-Serial Bridge Controller
3294 (see @uref{http://www.cypress.com/?rID=82870}).
3295 @end itemize
3296 @end deffn
3297
3298 @deffn {Config Command} {openjtag device_desc} string
3299 The USB device description string of the adapter.
3300 This value is only used with the standard variant.
3301 @end deffn
3302 @end deffn
3303
3304
3305 @deffn {Interface Driver} {jtag_dpi}
3306 SystemVerilog Direct Programming Interface (DPI) compatible driver for
3307 JTAG devices in emulation. The driver acts as a client for the SystemVerilog
3308 DPI server interface.
3309
3310 @deffn {Config Command} {jtag_dpi set_port} port
3311 Specifies the TCP/IP port number of the SystemVerilog DPI server interface.
3312 @end deffn
3313
3314 @deffn {Config Command} {jtag_dpi set_address} address
3315 Specifies the TCP/IP address of the SystemVerilog DPI server interface.
3316 @end deffn
3317 @end deffn
3318
3319
3320 @deffn {Interface Driver} {buspirate}
3321
3322 This driver is for the Bus Pirate (see @url{http://dangerousprototypes.com/docs/Bus_Pirate}) and compatible devices.
3323 It uses a simple data protocol over a serial port connection.
3324
3325 Most hardware development boards have a UART, a real serial port, or a virtual USB serial device, so this driver
3326 allows you to start building your own JTAG adapter without the complexity of a custom USB connection.
3327
3328 @deffn {Config Command} {buspirate port} serial_port
3329 Specify the serial port's filename. For example:
3330 @example
3331 buspirate port /dev/ttyUSB0
3332 @end example
3333 @end deffn
3334
3335 @deffn {Config Command} {buspirate speed} (normal|fast)
3336 Set the communication speed to 115k (normal) or 1M (fast). For example:
3337 @example
3338 buspirate speed normal
3339 @end example
3340 @end deffn
3341
3342 @deffn {Config Command} {buspirate mode} (normal|open-drain)
3343 Set the Bus Pirate output mode.
3344 @itemize @minus
3345 @item In normal mode (push/pull), do not enable the pull-ups, and do not connect I/O header pin VPU to JTAG VREF.
3346 @item In open drain mode, you will then need to enable the pull-ups.
3347 @end itemize
3348 For example:
3349 @example
3350 buspirate mode normal
3351 @end example
3352 @end deffn
3353
3354 @deffn {Config Command} {buspirate pullup} (0|1)
3355 Whether to connect (1) or not (0) the I/O header pin VPU (JTAG VREF)
3356 to the pull-up/pull-down resistors on MOSI (JTAG TDI), CLK (JTAG TCK), MISO (JTAG TDO) and CS (JTAG TMS).
3357 For example:
3358 @example
3359 buspirate pullup 0
3360 @end example
3361 @end deffn
3362
3363 @deffn {Config Command} {buspirate vreg} (0|1)
3364 Whether to enable (1) or disable (0) the built-in voltage regulator,
3365 which can be used to supply power to a test circuit through
3366 I/O header pins +3V3 and +5V. For example:
3367 @example
3368 buspirate vreg 0
3369 @end example
3370 @end deffn
3371
3372 @deffn {Command} {buspirate led} (0|1)
3373 Turns the Bus Pirate's LED on (1) or off (0). For example:
3374 @end deffn
3375 @example
3376 buspirate led 1
3377 @end example
3378
3379 @end deffn
3380
3381
3382 @section Transport Configuration
3383 @cindex Transport
3384 As noted earlier, depending on the version of OpenOCD you use,
3385 and the debug adapter you are using,
3386 several transports may be available to
3387 communicate with debug targets (or perhaps to program flash memory).
3388 @deffn {Command} {transport list}
3389 displays the names of the transports supported by this
3390 version of OpenOCD.
3391 @end deffn
3392
3393 @deffn {Command} {transport select} @option{transport_name}
3394 Select which of the supported transports to use in this OpenOCD session.
3395
3396 When invoked with @option{transport_name}, attempts to select the named
3397 transport. The transport must be supported by the debug adapter
3398 hardware and by the version of OpenOCD you are using (including the
3399 adapter's driver).
3400
3401 If no transport has been selected and no @option{transport_name} is
3402 provided, @command{transport select} auto-selects the first transport
3403 supported by the debug adapter.
3404
3405 @command{transport select} always returns the name of the session's selected
3406 transport, if any.
3407 @end deffn
3408
3409 @subsection JTAG Transport
3410 @cindex JTAG
3411 JTAG is the original transport supported by OpenOCD, and most
3412 of the OpenOCD commands support it.
3413 JTAG transports expose a chain of one or more Test Access Points (TAPs),
3414 each of which must be explicitly declared.
3415 JTAG supports both debugging and boundary scan testing.
3416 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
3417
3418 JTAG transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
3419 jtag}. Unless your adapter uses either @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
3420 driver} (in which case the command is @command{transport select hla_jtag})
3421 or @ref{st_link_dap_interface,the st-link interface driver} (in which case
3422 the command is @command{transport select dapdirect_jtag}).
3423
3424 @subsection SWD Transport
3425 @cindex SWD
3426 @cindex Serial Wire Debug
3427 SWD (Serial Wire Debug) is an ARM-specific transport which exposes one
3428 Debug Access Point (DAP, which must be explicitly declared.
3429 (SWD uses fewer signal wires than JTAG.)
3430 SWD is debug-oriented, and does not support boundary scan testing.
3431 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
3432 (Some processors support both JTAG and SWD.)
3433
3434 SWD transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
3435 swd}. Unless your adapter uses either @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
3436 driver} (in which case the command is @command{transport select hla_swd})
3437 or @ref{st_link_dap_interface,the st-link interface driver} (in which case
3438 the command is @command{transport select dapdirect_swd}).
3439
3440 @deffn {Config Command} {swd newdap} ...
3441 Declares a single DAP which uses SWD transport.
3442 Parameters are currently the same as "jtag newtap" but this is
3443 expected to change.
3444 @end deffn
3445
3446 @cindex SWD multi-drop
3447 The newer SWD devices (SW-DP v2 or SWJ-DP v2) support the multi-drop extension
3448 of SWD protocol: two or more devices can be connected to one SWD adapter.
3449 SWD transport works in multi-drop mode if @ref{dap_create,DAP} is configured
3450 with both @code{-dp-id} and @code{-instance-id} parameters regardless how many
3451 DAPs are created.
3452
3453 Not all adapters and adapter drivers support SWD multi-drop. Only the following
3454 adapter drivers are SWD multi-drop capable:
3455 cmsis_dap (use an adapter with CMSIS-DAP version 2.0), ftdi, all bitbang based.
3456
3457 @subsection SPI Transport
3458 @cindex SPI
3459 @cindex Serial Peripheral Interface
3460 The Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI) is a general purpose transport
3461 which uses four wire signaling. Some processors use it as part of a
3462 solution for flash programming.
3463
3464 @anchor{swimtransport}
3465 @subsection SWIM Transport
3466 @cindex SWIM
3467 @cindex Single Wire Interface Module
3468 The Single Wire Interface Module (SWIM) is a low-pin-count debug protocol used
3469 by the STMicroelectronics MCU family STM8 and documented in the
3470 @uref{https://www.st.com/resource/en/user_manual/cd00173911.pdf, User Manual UM470}.
3471
3472 SWIM does not support boundary scan testing nor multiple cores.
3473
3474 The SWIM transport is selected with the command @command{transport select swim}.
3475
3476 The concept of TAPs does not fit in the protocol since SWIM does not implement
3477 a scan chain. Nevertheless, the current SW model of OpenOCD requires defining a
3478 virtual SWIM TAP through the command @command{swim newtap basename tap_type}.
3479 The TAP definition must precede the target definition command
3480 @command{target create target_name stm8 -chain-position basename.tap_type}.
3481
3482 @anchor{jtagspeed}
3483 @section JTAG Speed
3484 JTAG clock setup is part of system setup.
3485 It @emph{does not belong with interface setup} since any interface
3486 only knows a few of the constraints for the JTAG clock speed.
3487 Sometimes the JTAG speed is
3488 changed during the target initialization process: (1) slow at
3489 reset, (2) program the CPU clocks, (3) run fast.
3490 Both the "slow" and "fast" clock rates are functions of the
3491 oscillators used, the chip, the board design, and sometimes
3492 power management software that may be active.
3493
3494 The speed used during reset, and the scan chain verification which
3495 follows reset, can be adjusted using a @code{reset-start}
3496 target event handler.
3497 It can then be reconfigured to a faster speed by a
3498 @code{reset-init} target event handler after it reprograms those
3499 CPU clocks, or manually (if something else, such as a boot loader,
3500 sets up those clocks).
3501 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
3502 When the initial low JTAG speed is a chip characteristic, perhaps
3503 because of a required oscillator speed, provide such a handler
3504 in the target config file.
3505 When that speed is a function of a board-specific characteristic
3506 such as which speed oscillator is used, it belongs in the board
3507 config file instead.
3508 In both cases it's safest to also set the initial JTAG clock rate
3509 to that same slow speed, so that OpenOCD never starts up using a
3510 clock speed that's faster than the scan chain can support.
3511
3512 @example
3513 jtag_rclk 3000
3514 $_TARGET.cpu configure -event reset-start @{ jtag_rclk 3000 @}
3515 @end example
3516
3517 If your system supports adaptive clocking (RTCK), configuring
3518 JTAG to use that is probably the most robust approach.
3519 However, it introduces delays to synchronize clocks; so it
3520 may not be the fastest solution.
3521
3522 @b{NOTE:} Script writers should consider using @command{jtag_rclk}
3523 instead of @command{adapter speed}, but only for (ARM) cores and boards
3524 which support adaptive clocking.
3525
3526 @deffn {Command} {adapter speed} max_speed_kHz
3527 A non-zero speed is in KHZ. Hence: 3000 is 3mhz.
3528 JTAG interfaces usually support a limited number of
3529 speeds. The speed actually used won't be faster
3530 than the speed specified.
3531
3532 Chip data sheets generally include a top JTAG clock rate.
3533 The actual rate is often a function of a CPU core clock,
3534 and is normally less than that peak rate.
3535 For example, most ARM cores accept at most one sixth of the CPU clock.
3536
3537 Speed 0 (khz) selects RTCK method.
3538 @xref{faqrtck,,FAQ RTCK}.
3539 If your system uses RTCK, you won't need to change the
3540 JTAG clocking after setup.
3541 Not all interfaces, boards, or targets support ``rtck''.
3542 If the interface device can not
3543 support it, an error is returned when you try to use RTCK.
3544 @end deffn
3545
3546 @defun jtag_rclk fallback_speed_kHz
3547 @cindex adaptive clocking
3548 @cindex RTCK
3549 This Tcl proc (defined in @file{startup.tcl}) attempts to enable RTCK/RCLK.
3550 If that fails (maybe the interface, board, or target doesn't
3551 support it), falls back to the specified frequency.
3552 @example
3553 # Fall back to 3mhz if RTCK is not supported
3554 jtag_rclk 3000
3555 @end example
3556 @end defun
3557
3558 @node Reset Configuration
3559 @chapter Reset Configuration
3560 @cindex Reset Configuration
3561
3562 Every system configuration may require a different reset
3563 configuration. This can also be quite confusing.
3564 Resets also interact with @var{reset-init} event handlers,
3565 which do things like setting up clocks and DRAM, and
3566 JTAG clock rates. (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.)
3567 They can also interact with JTAG routers.
3568 Please see the various board files for examples.
3569
3570 @quotation Note
3571 To maintainers and integrators:
3572 Reset configuration touches several things at once.
3573 Normally the board configuration file
3574 should define it and assume that the JTAG adapter supports
3575 everything that's wired up to the board's JTAG connector.
3576
3577 However, the target configuration file could also make note
3578 of something the silicon vendor has done inside the chip,
3579 which will be true for most (or all) boards using that chip.
3580 And when the JTAG adapter doesn't support everything, the
3581 user configuration file will need to override parts of
3582 the reset configuration provided by other files.
3583 @end quotation
3584
3585 @section Types of Reset
3586
3587 There are many kinds of reset possible through JTAG, but
3588 they may not all work with a given board and adapter.
3589 That's part of why reset configuration can be error prone.
3590
3591 @itemize @bullet
3592 @item
3593 @emph{System Reset} ... the @emph{SRST} hardware signal
3594 resets all chips connected to the JTAG adapter, such as processors,
3595 power management chips, and I/O controllers. Normally resets triggered
3596 with this signal behave exactly like pressing a RESET button.
3597 @item
3598 @emph{JTAG TAP Reset} ... the @emph{TRST} hardware signal resets
3599 just the TAP controllers connected to the JTAG adapter.
3600 Such resets should not be visible to the rest of the system; resetting a
3601 device's TAP controller just puts that controller into a known state.
3602 @item
3603 @emph{Emulation Reset} ... many devices can be reset through JTAG
3604 commands. These resets are often distinguishable from system
3605 resets, either explicitly (a "reset reason" register says so)
3606 or implicitly (not all parts of the chip get reset).
3607 @item
3608 @emph{Other Resets} ... system-on-chip devices often support
3609 several other types of reset.
3610 You may need to arrange that a watchdog timer stops
3611 while debugging, preventing a watchdog reset.
3612 There may be individual module resets.
3613 @end itemize
3614
3615 In the best case, OpenOCD can hold SRST, then reset
3616 the TAPs via TRST and send commands through JTAG to halt the
3617 CPU at the reset vector before the 1st instruction is executed.
3618 Then when it finally releases the SRST signal, the system is
3619 halted under debugger control before any code has executed.
3620 This is the behavior required to support the @command{reset halt}
3621 and @command{reset init} commands; after @command{reset init} a
3622 board-specific script might do things like setting up DRAM.
3623 (@xref{resetcommand,,Reset Command}.)
3624
3625 @anchor{srstandtrstissues}
3626 @section SRST and TRST Issues
3627
3628 Because SRST and TRST are hardware signals, they can have a
3629 variety of system-specific constraints. Some of the most
3630 common issues are:
3631
3632 @itemize @bullet
3633
3634 @item @emph{Signal not available} ... Some boards don't wire
3635 SRST or TRST to the JTAG connector. Some JTAG adapters don't
3636 support such signals even if they are wired up.
3637 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{signals} options to say
3638 when either of those signals is not connected.
3639 When SRST is not available, your code might not be able to rely
3640 on controllers having been fully reset during code startup.
3641 Missing TRST is not a problem, since JTAG-level resets can
3642 be triggered using with TMS signaling.
3643
3644 @item @emph{Signals shorted} ... Sometimes a chip, board, or
3645 adapter will connect SRST to TRST, instead of keeping them separate.
3646 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{combination} options to say
3647 when those signals aren't properly independent.
3648
3649 @item @emph{Timing} ... Reset circuitry like a resistor/capacitor
3650 delay circuit, reset supervisor, or on-chip features can extend
3651 the effect of a JTAG adapter's reset for some time after the adapter
3652 stops issuing the reset. For example, there may be chip or board
3653 requirements that all reset pulses last for at least a
3654 certain amount of time; and reset buttons commonly have
3655 hardware debouncing.
3656 Use the @command{adapter srst delay} and @command{jtag_ntrst_delay}
3657 commands to say when extra delays are needed.
3658
3659 @item @emph{Drive type} ... Reset lines often have a pullup
3660 resistor, letting the JTAG interface treat them as open-drain
3661 signals. But that's not a requirement, so the adapter may need
3662 to use push/pull output drivers.
3663 Also, with weak pullups it may be advisable to drive
3664 signals to both levels (push/pull) to minimize rise times.
3665 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{trst_type} and
3666 @var{srst_type} parameters to say how to drive reset signals.
3667
3668 @item @emph{Special initialization} ... Targets sometimes need
3669 special JTAG initialization sequences to handle chip-specific
3670 issues (not limited to errata).
3671 For example, certain JTAG commands might need to be issued while
3672 the system as a whole is in a reset state (SRST active)
3673 but the JTAG scan chain is usable (TRST inactive).
3674 Many systems treat combined assertion of SRST and TRST as a
3675 trigger for a harder reset than SRST alone.
3676 Such custom reset handling is discussed later in this chapter.
3677 @end itemize
3678
3679 There can also be other issues.
3680 Some devices don't fully conform to the JTAG specifications.
3681 Trivial system-specific differences are common, such as
3682 SRST and TRST using slightly different names.
3683 There are also vendors who distribute key JTAG documentation for
3684 their chips only to developers who have signed a Non-Disclosure
3685 Agreement (NDA).
3686
3687 Sometimes there are chip-specific extensions like a requirement to use
3688 the normally-optional TRST signal (precluding use of JTAG adapters which
3689 don't pass TRST through), or needing extra steps to complete a TAP reset.
3690
3691 In short, SRST and especially TRST handling may be very finicky,
3692 needing to cope with both architecture and board specific constraints.
3693
3694 @section Commands for Handling Resets
3695
3696 @deffn {Command} {adapter srst pulse_width} milliseconds
3697 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
3698 after asserting nSRST (active-low system reset) before
3699 allowing it to be deasserted.
3700 @end deffn
3701
3702 @deffn {Command} {adapter srst delay} milliseconds
3703 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
3704 nSRST (active-low system reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
3705 When a board has a reset button connected to SRST line it will
3706 probably have hardware debouncing, implying you should use this.
3707 @end deffn
3708
3709 @deffn {Command} {jtag_ntrst_assert_width} milliseconds
3710 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
3711 after asserting nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before
3712 allowing it to be deasserted.
3713 @end deffn
3714
3715 @deffn {Command} {jtag_ntrst_delay} milliseconds
3716 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
3717 nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
3718 @end deffn
3719
3720 @anchor{reset_config}
3721 @deffn {Command} {reset_config} mode_flag ...
3722 This command displays or modifies the reset configuration
3723 of your combination of JTAG board and target in target
3724 configuration scripts.
3725
3726 Information earlier in this section describes the kind of problems
3727 the command is intended to address (@pxref{srstandtrstissues,,SRST and TRST Issues}).
3728 As a rule this command belongs only in board config files,
3729 describing issues like @emph{board doesn't connect TRST};
3730 or in user config files, addressing limitations derived
3731 from a particular combination of interface and board.
3732 (An unlikely example would be using a TRST-only adapter
3733 with a board that only wires up SRST.)
3734
3735 The @var{mode_flag} options can be specified in any order, but only one
3736 of each type -- @var{signals}, @var{combination}, @var{gates},
3737 @var{trst_type}, @var{srst_type} and @var{connect_type}
3738 -- may be specified at a time.
3739 If you don't provide a new value for a given type, its previous
3740 value (perhaps the default) is unchanged.
3741 For example, this means that you don't need to say anything at all about
3742 TRST just to declare that if the JTAG adapter should want to drive SRST,
3743 it must explicitly be driven high (@option{srst_push_pull}).
3744
3745 @itemize
3746 @item
3747 @var{signals} can specify which of the reset signals are connected.
3748 For example, If the JTAG interface provides SRST, but the board doesn't
3749 connect that signal properly, then OpenOCD can't use it.
3750 Possible values are @option{none} (the default), @option{trst_only},
3751 @option{srst_only} and @option{trst_and_srst}.
3752
3753 @quotation Tip
3754 If your board provides SRST and/or TRST through the JTAG connector,
3755 you must declare that so those signals can be used.
3756 @end quotation
3757
3758 @item
3759 The @var{combination} is an optional value specifying broken reset
3760 signal implementations.
3761 The default behaviour if no option given is @option{separate},
3762 indicating everything behaves normally.
3763 @option{srst_pulls_trst} states that the
3764 test logic is reset together with the reset of the system (e.g. NXP
3765 LPC2000, "broken" board layout), @option{trst_pulls_srst} says that
3766 the system is reset together with the test logic (only hypothetical, I
3767 haven't seen hardware with such a bug, and can be worked around).
3768 @option{combined} implies both @option{srst_pulls_trst} and
3769 @option{trst_pulls_srst}.
3770
3771 @item
3772 The @var{gates} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
3773 JTAG may be unavailable during reset.
3774 @option{srst_gates_jtag} (default)
3775 indicates that asserting SRST gates the
3776 JTAG clock. This means that no communication can happen on JTAG
3777 while SRST is asserted.
3778 Its converse is @option{srst_nogate}, indicating that JTAG commands
3779 can safely be issued while SRST is active.
3780
3781 @item
3782 The @var{connect_type} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
3783 SRST is asserted while connecting to the target. @option{srst_nogate}
3784 is required to use this option.
3785 @option{connect_deassert_srst} (default)
3786 indicates that SRST will not be asserted while connecting to the target.
3787 Its converse is @option{connect_assert_srst}, indicating that SRST will
3788 be asserted before any target connection.
3789 Only some targets support this feature, STM32 and STR9 are examples.
3790 This feature is useful if you are unable to connect to your target due
3791 to incorrect options byte config or illegal program execution.
3792 @end itemize
3793
3794 The optional @var{trst_type} and @var{srst_type} parameters allow the
3795 driver mode of each reset line to be specified. These values only affect
3796 JTAG interfaces with support for different driver modes, like the Amontec
3797 JTAGkey and JTAG Accelerator. Also, they are necessarily ignored if the
3798 relevant signal (TRST or SRST) is not connected.
3799
3800 @itemize
3801 @item
3802 Possible @var{trst_type} driver modes for the test reset signal (TRST)
3803 are the default @option{trst_push_pull}, and @option{trst_open_drain}.
3804 Most boards connect this signal to a pulldown, so the JTAG TAPs
3805 never leave reset unless they are hooked up to a JTAG adapter.
3806
3807 @item
3808 Possible @var{srst_type} driver modes for the system reset signal (SRST)
3809 are the default @option{srst_open_drain}, and @option{srst_push_pull}.
3810 Most boards connect this signal to a pullup, and allow the
3811 signal to be pulled low by various events including system
3812 power-up and pressing a reset button.
3813 @end itemize
3814 @end deffn
3815
3816 @section Custom Reset Handling
3817 @cindex events
3818
3819 OpenOCD has several ways to help support the various reset
3820 mechanisms provided by chip and board vendors.
3821 The commands shown in the previous section give standard parameters.
3822 There are also @emph{event handlers} associated with TAPs or Targets.
3823 Those handlers are Tcl procedures you can provide, which are invoked
3824 at particular points in the reset sequence.
3825
3826 @emph{When SRST is not an option} you must set
3827 up a @code{reset-assert} event handler for your target.
3828 For example, some JTAG adapters don't include the SRST signal;
3829 and some boards have multiple targets, and you won't always
3830 want to reset everything at once.
3831
3832 After configuring those mechanisms, you might still
3833 find your board doesn't start up or reset correctly.
3834 For example, maybe it needs a slightly different sequence
3835 of SRST and/or TRST manipulations, because of quirks that
3836 the @command{reset_config} mechanism doesn't address;
3837 or asserting both might trigger a stronger reset, which
3838 needs special attention.
3839
3840 Experiment with lower level operations, such as
3841 @command{adapter assert}, @command{adapter deassert}
3842 and the @command{jtag arp_*} operations shown here,
3843 to find a sequence of operations that works.
3844 @xref{JTAG Commands}.
3845 When you find a working sequence, it can be used to override
3846 @command{jtag_init}, which fires during OpenOCD startup
3847 (@pxref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage});
3848 or @command{init_reset}, which fires during reset processing.
3849
3850 You might also want to provide some project-specific reset
3851 schemes. For example, on a multi-target board the standard
3852 @command{reset} command would reset all targets, but you
3853 may need the ability to reset only one target at time and
3854 thus want to avoid using the board-wide SRST signal.
3855
3856 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} {init_reset} mode
3857 This is invoked near the beginning of the @command{reset} command,
3858 usually to provide as much of a cold (power-up) reset as practical.
3859 By default it is also invoked from @command{jtag_init} if
3860 the scan chain does not respond to pure JTAG operations.
3861 The @var{mode} parameter is the parameter given to the
3862 low level reset command (@option{halt},
3863 @option{init}, or @option{run}), @option{setup},
3864 or potentially some other value.
3865
3866 The default implementation just invokes @command{jtag arp_init-reset}.
3867 Replacements will normally build on low level JTAG
3868 operations such as @command{adapter assert} and @command{adapter deassert}.
3869 Operations here must not address individual TAPs
3870 (or their associated targets)
3871 until the JTAG scan chain has first been verified to work.
3872
3873 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
3874 they return.
3875 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
3876 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
3877 @end deffn
3878
3879 @deffn {Command} {jtag arp_init}
3880 This validates the scan chain using just the four
3881 standard JTAG signals (TMS, TCK, TDI, TDO).
3882 It starts by issuing a JTAG-only reset.
3883 Then it performs checks to verify that the scan chain configuration
3884 matches the TAPs it can observe.
3885 Those checks include checking IDCODE values for each active TAP,
3886 and verifying the length of their instruction registers using
3887 TAP @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} values.
3888 If these tests all pass, TAP @code{setup} events are
3889 issued to all TAPs with handlers for that event.
3890 @end deffn
3891
3892 @deffn {Command} {jtag arp_init-reset}
3893 This uses TRST and SRST to try resetting
3894 everything on the JTAG scan chain
3895 (and anything else connected to SRST).
3896 It then invokes the logic of @command{jtag arp_init}.
3897 @end deffn
3898
3899
3900 @node TAP Declaration
3901 @chapter TAP Declaration
3902 @cindex TAP declaration
3903 @cindex TAP configuration
3904
3905 @emph{Test Access Ports} (TAPs) are the core of JTAG.
3906 TAPs serve many roles, including:
3907
3908 @itemize @bullet
3909 @item @b{Debug Target} A CPU TAP can be used as a GDB debug target.
3910 @item @b{Flash Programming} Some chips program the flash directly via JTAG.
3911 Others do it indirectly, making a CPU do it.
3912 @item @b{Program Download} Using the same CPU support GDB uses,
3913 you can initialize a DRAM controller, download code to DRAM, and then
3914 start running that code.
3915 @item @b{Boundary Scan} Most chips support boundary scan, which
3916 helps test for board assembly problems like solder bridges
3917 and missing connections.
3918 @end itemize
3919
3920 OpenOCD must know about the active TAPs on your board(s).
3921 Setting up the TAPs is the core task of your configuration files.
3922 Once those TAPs are set up, you can pass their names to code
3923 which sets up CPUs and exports them as GDB targets,
3924 probes flash memory, performs low-level JTAG operations, and more.
3925
3926 @section Scan Chains
3927 @cindex scan chain
3928
3929 TAPs are part of a hardware @dfn{scan chain},
3930 which is a daisy chain of TAPs.
3931 They also need to be added to
3932 OpenOCD's software mirror of that hardware list,
3933 giving each member a name and associating other data with it.
3934 Simple scan chains, with a single TAP, are common in
3935 systems with a single microcontroller or microprocessor.
3936 More complex chips may have several TAPs internally.
3937 Very complex scan chains might have a dozen or more TAPs:
3938 several in one chip, more in the next, and connecting
3939 to other boards with their own chips and TAPs.
3940
3941 You can display the list with the @command{scan_chain} command.
3942 (Don't confuse this with the list displayed by the @command{targets}
3943 command, presented in the next chapter.
3944 That only displays TAPs for CPUs which are configured as
3945 debugging targets.)
3946 Here's what the scan chain might look like for a chip more than one TAP:
3947
3948 @verbatim
3949 TapName Enabled IdCode Expected IrLen IrCap IrMask
3950 -- ------------------ ------- ---------- ---------- ----- ----- ------
3951 0 omap5912.dsp Y 0x03df1d81 0x03df1d81 38 0x01 0x03
3952 1 omap5912.arm Y 0x0692602f 0x0692602f 4 0x01 0x0f
3953 2 omap5912.unknown Y 0x00000000 0x00000000 8 0x01 0x03
3954 @end verbatim
3955
3956 OpenOCD can detect some of that information, but not all
3957 of it. @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
3958 Unfortunately, those TAPs can't always be autoconfigured,
3959 because not all devices provide good support for that.
3960 JTAG doesn't require supporting IDCODE instructions, and
3961 chips with JTAG routers may not link TAPs into the chain
3962 until they are told to do so.
3963
3964 The configuration mechanism currently supported by OpenOCD
3965 requires explicit configuration of all TAP devices using
3966 @command{jtag newtap} commands, as detailed later in this chapter.
3967 A command like this would declare one tap and name it @code{chip1.cpu}:
3968
3969 @example
3970 jtag newtap chip1 cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id 0x3ba00477
3971 @end example
3972
3973 Each target configuration file lists the TAPs provided
3974 by a given chip.
3975 Board configuration files combine all the targets on a board,
3976 and so forth.
3977 Note that @emph{the order in which TAPs are declared is very important.}
3978 That declaration order must match the order in the JTAG scan chain,
3979 both inside a single chip and between them.
3980 @xref{faqtaporder,,FAQ TAP Order}.
3981
3982 For example, the STMicroelectronics STR912 chip has
3983 three separate TAPs@footnote{See the ST
3984 document titled: @emph{STR91xFAxxx, Section 3.15 Jtag Interface, Page:
3985 28/102, Figure 3: JTAG chaining inside the STR91xFA}.
3986 @url{http://eu.st.com/stonline/products/literature/ds/13495.pdf}}.
3987 To configure those taps, @file{target/str912.cfg}
3988 includes commands something like this:
3989
3990 @example
3991 jtag newtap str912 flash ... params ...
3992 jtag newtap str912 cpu ... params ...
3993 jtag newtap str912 bs ... params ...
3994 @end example
3995
3996 Actual config files typically use a variable such as @code{$_CHIPNAME}
3997 instead of literals like @option{str912}, to support more than one chip
3998 of each type. @xref{Config File Guidelines}.
3999
4000 @deffn {Command} {jtag names}
4001 Returns the names of all current TAPs in the scan chain.
4002 Use @command{jtag cget} or @command{jtag tapisenabled}
4003 to examine attributes and state of each TAP.
4004 @example
4005 foreach t [jtag names] @{
4006 puts [format "TAP: %s\n" $t]
4007 @}
4008 @end example
4009 @end deffn
4010
4011 @deffn {Command} {scan_chain}
4012 Displays the TAPs in the scan chain configuration,
4013 and their status.
4014 The set of TAPs listed by this command is fixed by
4015 exiting the OpenOCD configuration stage,
4016 but systems with a JTAG router can
4017 enable or disable TAPs dynamically.
4018 @end deffn
4019
4020 @c FIXME! "jtag cget" should be able to return all TAP
4021 @c attributes, like "$target_name cget" does for targets.
4022
4023 @c Probably want "jtag eventlist", and a "tap-reset" event
4024 @c (on entry to RESET state).
4025
4026 @section TAP Names
4027 @cindex dotted name
4028
4029 When TAP objects are declared with @command{jtag newtap},
4030 a @dfn{dotted.name} is created for the TAP, combining the
4031 name of a module (usually a chip) and a label for the TAP.
4032 For example: @code{xilinx.tap}, @code{str912.flash},
4033 @code{omap3530.jrc}, @code{dm6446.dsp}, or @code{stm32.cpu}.
4034 Many other commands use that dotted.name to manipulate or
4035 refer to the TAP. For example, CPU configuration uses the
4036 name, as does declaration of NAND or NOR flash banks.
4037
4038 The components of a dotted name should follow ``C'' symbol
4039 name rules: start with an alphabetic character, then numbers
4040 and underscores are OK; while others (including dots!) are not.
4041
4042 @section TAP Declaration Commands
4043
4044 @deffn {Config Command} {jtag newtap} chipname tapname configparams...
4045 Declares a new TAP with the dotted name @var{chipname}.@var{tapname},
4046 and configured according to the various @var{configparams}.
4047
4048 The @var{chipname} is a symbolic name for the chip.
4049 Conventionally target config files use @code{$_CHIPNAME},
4050 defaulting to the model name given by the chip vendor but
4051 overridable.
4052
4053 @cindex TAP naming convention
4054 The @var{tapname} reflects the role of that TAP,
4055 and should follow this convention:
4056
4057 @itemize @bullet
4058 @item @code{bs} -- For boundary scan if this is a separate TAP;
4059 @item @code{cpu} -- The main CPU of the chip, alternatively
4060 @code{arm} and @code{dsp} on chips with both ARM and DSP CPUs,
4061 @code{arm1} and @code{arm2} on chips with two ARMs, and so forth;
4062 @item @code{etb} -- For an embedded trace buffer (example: an ARM ETB11);
4063 @item @code{flash} -- If the chip has a flash TAP, like the str912;
4064 @item @code{jrc} -- For JTAG route controller (example: the ICEPick modules
4065 on many Texas Instruments chips, like the OMAP3530 on Beagleboards);
4066 @item @code{tap} -- Should be used only for FPGA- or CPLD-like devices
4067 with a single TAP;
4068 @item @code{unknownN} -- If you have no idea what the TAP is for (N is a number);
4069 @item @emph{when in doubt} -- Use the chip maker's name in their data sheet.
4070 For example, the Freescale i.MX31 has a SDMA (Smart DMA) with
4071 a JTAG TAP; that TAP should be named @code{sdma}.
4072 @end itemize
4073
4074 Every TAP requires at least the following @var{configparams}:
4075
4076 @itemize @bullet
4077 @item @code{-irlen} @var{NUMBER}
4078 @*The length in bits of the
4079 instruction register, such as 4 or 5 bits.
4080 @end itemize
4081
4082 A TAP may also provide optional @var{configparams}:
4083
4084 @itemize @bullet
4085 @item @code{-disable} (or @code{-enable})
4086 @*Use the @code{-disable} parameter to flag a TAP which is not
4087 linked into the scan chain after a reset using either TRST
4088 or the JTAG state machine's @sc{reset} state.
4089 You may use @code{-enable} to highlight the default state
4090 (the TAP is linked in).
4091 @xref{enablinganddisablingtaps,,Enabling and Disabling TAPs}.
4092 @item @code{-expected-id} @var{NUMBER}
4093 @*A non-zero @var{number} represents a 32-bit IDCODE
4094 which you expect to find when the scan chain is examined.
4095 These codes are not required by all JTAG devices.
4096 @emph{Repeat the option} as many times as required if more than one
4097 ID code could appear (for example, multiple versions).
4098 Specify @var{number} as zero to suppress warnings about IDCODE
4099 values that were found but not included in the list.
4100
4101 Provide this value if at all possible, since it lets OpenOCD
4102 tell when the scan chain it sees isn't right. These values
4103 are provided in vendors' chip documentation, usually a technical
4104 reference manual. Sometimes you may need to probe the JTAG
4105 hardware to find these values.
4106 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
4107 @item @code{-ignore-version}
4108 @*Specify this to ignore the JTAG version field in the @code{-expected-id}
4109 option. When vendors put out multiple versions of a chip, or use the same
4110 JTAG-level ID for several largely-compatible chips, it may be more practical
4111 to ignore the version field than to update config files to handle all of
4112 the various chip IDs. The version field is defined as bit 28-31 of the IDCODE.
4113 @item @code{-ircapture} @var{NUMBER}
4114 @*The bit pattern loaded by the TAP into the JTAG shift register
4115 on entry to the @sc{ircapture} state, such as 0x01.
4116 JTAG requires the two LSBs of this value to be 01.
4117 By default, @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} are set
4118 up to verify that two-bit value. You may provide
4119 additional bits if you know them, or indicate that
4120 a TAP doesn't conform to the JTAG specification.
4121 @item @code{-irmask} @var{NUMBER}
4122 @*A mask used with @code{-ircapture}
4123 to verify that instruction scans work correctly.
4124 Such scans are not used by OpenOCD except to verify that
4125 there seems to be no problems with JTAG scan chain operations.
4126 @item @code{-ignore-syspwrupack}
4127 @*Specify this to ignore the CSYSPWRUPACK bit in the ARM DAP DP CTRL/STAT
4128 register during initial examination and when checking the sticky error bit.
4129 This bit is normally checked after setting the CSYSPWRUPREQ bit, but some
4130 devices do not set the ack bit until sometime later.
4131 @end itemize
4132 @end deffn
4133
4134 @section Other TAP commands
4135
4136 @deffn {Command} {jtag cget} dotted.name @option{-idcode}
4137 Get the value of the IDCODE found in hardware.
4138 @end deffn
4139
4140 @deffn {Command} {jtag cget} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name
4141 @deffnx {Command} {jtag configure} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name handler
4142 At this writing this TAP attribute
4143 mechanism is limited and used mostly for event handling.
4144 (It is not a direct analogue of the @code{cget}/@code{configure}
4145 mechanism for debugger targets.)
4146 See the next section for information about the available events.
4147
4148 The @code{configure} subcommand assigns an event handler,
4149 a TCL string which is evaluated when the event is triggered.
4150 The @code{cget} subcommand returns that handler.
4151 @end deffn
4152
4153 @section TAP Events
4154 @cindex events
4155 @cindex TAP events
4156
4157 OpenOCD includes two event mechanisms.
4158 The one presented here applies to all JTAG TAPs.
4159 The other applies to debugger targets,
4160 which are associated with certain TAPs.
4161
4162 The TAP events currently defined are:
4163
4164 @itemize @bullet
4165 @item @b{post-reset}
4166 @* The TAP has just completed a JTAG reset.
4167 The tap may still be in the JTAG @sc{reset} state.
4168 Handlers for these events might perform initialization sequences
4169 such as issuing TCK cycles, TMS sequences to ensure
4170 exit from the ARM SWD mode, and more.
4171
4172 Because the scan chain has not yet been verified, handlers for these events
4173 @emph{should not issue commands which scan the JTAG IR or DR registers}
4174 of any particular target.
4175 @b{NOTE:} As this is written (September 2009), nothing prevents such access.
4176 @item @b{setup}
4177 @* The scan chain has been reset and verified.
4178 This handler may enable TAPs as needed.
4179 @item @b{tap-disable}
4180 @* The TAP needs to be disabled. This handler should
4181 implement @command{jtag tapdisable}
4182 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
4183 @item @b{tap-enable}
4184 @* The TAP needs to be enabled. This handler should
4185 implement @command{jtag tapenable}
4186 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
4187 @end itemize
4188
4189 If you need some action after each JTAG reset which isn't actually
4190 specific to any TAP (since you can't yet trust the scan chain's
4191 contents to be accurate), you might:
4192
4193 @example
4194 jtag configure CHIP.jrc -event post-reset @{
4195 echo "JTAG Reset done"
4196 ... non-scan jtag operations to be done after reset
4197 @}
4198 @end example
4199
4200
4201 @anchor{enablinganddisablingtaps}
4202 @section Enabling and Disabling TAPs
4203 @cindex JTAG Route Controller
4204 @cindex jrc
4205
4206 In some systems, a @dfn{JTAG Route Controller} (JRC)
4207 is used to enable and/or disable specific JTAG TAPs.
4208 Many ARM-based chips from Texas Instruments include
4209 an ``ICEPick'' module, which is a JRC.
4210 Such chips include DaVinci and OMAP3 processors.
4211
4212 A given TAP may not be visible until the JRC has been
4213 told to link it into the scan chain; and if the JRC
4214 has been told to unlink that TAP, it will no longer
4215 be visible.
4216 Such routers address problems that JTAG ``bypass mode''
4217 ignores, such as:
4218
4219 @itemize
4220 @item The scan chain can only go as fast as its slowest TAP.
4221 @item Having many TAPs slows instruction scans, since all
4222 TAPs receive new instructions.
4223 @item TAPs in the scan chain must be powered up, which wastes
4224 power and prevents debugging some power management mechanisms.
4225 @end itemize
4226
4227 The IEEE 1149.1 JTAG standard has no concept of a ``disabled'' tap,
4228 as implied by the existence of JTAG routers.
4229 However, the upcoming IEEE 1149.7 framework (layered on top of JTAG)
4230 does include a kind of JTAG router functionality.
4231
4232 @c (a) currently the event handlers don't seem to be able to
4233 @c fail in a way that could lead to no-change-of-state.
4234
4235 In OpenOCD, tap enabling/disabling is invoked by the Tcl commands
4236 shown below, and is implemented using TAP event handlers.
4237 So for example, when defining a TAP for a CPU connected to
4238 a JTAG router, your @file{target.cfg} file
4239 should define TAP event handlers using
4240 code that looks something like this:
4241
4242 @example
4243 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-enable @{
4244 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
4245 @}
4246 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-disable @{
4247 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
4248 @}
4249 @end example
4250
4251 Then you might want that CPU's TAP enabled almost all the time:
4252
4253 @example
4254 jtag configure $CHIP.jrc -event setup "jtag tapenable $CHIP.cpu"
4255 @end example
4256
4257 Note how that particular setup event handler declaration
4258 uses quotes to evaluate @code{$CHIP} when the event is configured.
4259 Using brackets @{ @} would cause it to be evaluated later,
4260 at runtime, when it might have a different value.
4261
4262 @deffn {Command} {jtag tapdisable} dotted.name
4263 If necessary, disables the tap
4264 by sending it a @option{tap-disable} event.
4265 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4266 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4267 and "0" if it is disabled.
4268 @end deffn
4269
4270 @deffn {Command} {jtag tapenable} dotted.name
4271 If necessary, enables the tap
4272 by sending it a @option{tap-enable} event.
4273 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4274 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4275 and "0" if it is disabled.
4276 @end deffn
4277
4278 @deffn {Command} {jtag tapisenabled} dotted.name
4279 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4280 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4281 and "0" if it is disabled.
4282
4283 @quotation Note
4284 Humans will find the @command{scan_chain} command more helpful
4285 for querying the state of the JTAG taps.
4286 @end quotation
4287 @end deffn
4288
4289 @anchor{autoprobing}
4290 @section Autoprobing
4291 @cindex autoprobe
4292 @cindex JTAG autoprobe
4293
4294 TAP configuration is the first thing that needs to be done
4295 after interface and reset configuration. Sometimes it's
4296 hard finding out what TAPs exist, or how they are identified.
4297 Vendor documentation is not always easy to find and use.
4298
4299 To help you get past such problems, OpenOCD has a limited
4300 @emph{autoprobing} ability to look at the scan chain, doing
4301 a @dfn{blind interrogation} and then reporting the TAPs it finds.
4302 To use this mechanism, start the OpenOCD server with only data
4303 that configures your JTAG interface, and arranges to come up
4304 with a slow clock (many devices don't support fast JTAG clocks
4305 right when they come out of reset).
4306
4307 For example, your @file{openocd.cfg} file might have:
4308
4309 @example
4310 source [find interface/olimex-arm-usb-tiny-h.cfg]
4311 reset_config trst_and_srst
4312 jtag_rclk 8
4313 @end example
4314
4315 When you start the server without any TAPs configured, it will
4316 attempt to autoconfigure the TAPs. There are two parts to this:
4317
4318 @enumerate
4319 @item @emph{TAP discovery} ...
4320 After a JTAG reset (sometimes a system reset may be needed too),
4321 each TAP's data registers will hold the contents of either the
4322 IDCODE or BYPASS register.
4323 If JTAG communication is working, OpenOCD will see each TAP,
4324 and report what @option{-expected-id} to use with it.
4325 @item @emph{IR Length discovery} ...
4326 Unfortunately JTAG does not provide a reliable way to find out
4327 the value of the @option{-irlen} parameter to use with a TAP
4328 that is discovered.
4329 If OpenOCD can discover the length of a TAP's instruction
4330 register, it will report it.
4331 Otherwise you may need to consult vendor documentation, such
4332 as chip data sheets or BSDL files.
4333 @end enumerate
4334
4335 In many cases your board will have a simple scan chain with just
4336 a single device. Here's what OpenOCD reported with one board
4337 that's a bit more complex:
4338
4339 @example
4340 clock speed 8 kHz
4341 There are no enabled taps. AUTO PROBING MIGHT NOT WORK!!
4342 AUTO auto0.tap - use "jtag newtap auto0 tap -expected-id 0x2b900f0f ..."
4343 AUTO auto1.tap - use "jtag newtap auto1 tap -expected-id 0x07926001 ..."
4344 AUTO auto2.tap - use "jtag newtap auto2 tap -expected-id 0x0b73b02f ..."
4345 AUTO auto0.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
4346 AUTO auto1.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
4347 AUTO auto2.tap - use "... -irlen 6"
4348 no gdb ports allocated as no target has been specified
4349 @end example
4350
4351 Given that information, you should be able to either find some existing
4352 config files to use, or create your own. If you create your own, you
4353 would configure from the bottom up: first a @file{target.cfg} file
4354 with these TAPs, any targets associated with them, and any on-chip
4355 resources; then a @file{board.cfg} with off-chip resources, clocking,
4356 and so forth.
4357
4358 @anchor{dapdeclaration}
4359 @section DAP declaration (ARMv6-M, ARMv7 and ARMv8 targets)
4360 @cindex DAP declaration
4361
4362 Since OpenOCD version 0.11.0, the Debug Access Port (DAP) is
4363 no longer implicitly created together with the target. It must be
4364 explicitly declared using the @command{dap create} command. For all ARMv6-M, ARMv7
4365 and ARMv8 targets, the option "@option{-dap} @var{dap_name}" has to be used
4366 instead of "@option{-chain-position} @var{dotted.name}" when the target is created.
4367
4368 The @command{dap} command group supports the following sub-commands:
4369
4370 @anchor{dap_create}
4371 @deffn {Command} {dap create} dap_name @option{-chain-position} dotted.name configparams...
4372 Declare a DAP instance named @var{dap_name} linked to the JTAG tap
4373 @var{dotted.name}. This also creates a new command (@command{dap_name})
4374 which is used for various purposes including additional configuration.
4375 There can only be one DAP for each JTAG tap in the system.
4376
4377 A DAP may also provide optional @var{configparams}:
4378
4379 @itemize @bullet
4380 @item @code{-ignore-syspwrupack}
4381 @*Specify this to ignore the CSYSPWRUPACK bit in the ARM DAP DP CTRL/STAT
4382 register during initial examination and when checking the sticky error bit.
4383 This bit is normally checked after setting the CSYSPWRUPREQ bit, but some
4384 devices do not set the ack bit until sometime later.
4385
4386 @item @code{-dp-id} @var{number}
4387 @*Debug port identification number for SWD DPv2 multidrop.
4388 The @var{number} is written to bits 0..27 of DP TARGETSEL during DP selection.
4389 To find the id number of a single connected device read DP TARGETID:
4390 @code{device.dap dpreg 0x24}
4391 Use bits 0..27 of TARGETID.
4392
4393 @item @code{-instance-id} @var{number}
4394 @*Instance identification number for SWD DPv2 multidrop.
4395 The @var{number} is written to bits 28..31 of DP TARGETSEL during DP selection.
4396 To find the instance number of a single connected device read DP DLPIDR:
4397 @code{device.dap dpreg 0x34}
4398 The instance number is in bits 28..31 of DLPIDR value.
4399 @end itemize
4400 @end deffn
4401
4402 @deffn {Command} {dap names}
4403 This command returns a list of all registered DAP objects. It it useful mainly
4404 for TCL scripting.
4405 @end deffn
4406
4407 @deffn {Command} {dap info} [num]
4408 Displays the ROM table for MEM-AP @var{num},
4409 defaulting to the currently selected AP of the currently selected target.
4410 @end deffn
4411
4412 @deffn {Command} {dap init}
4413 Initialize all registered DAPs. This command is used internally
4414 during initialization. It can be issued at any time after the
4415 initialization, too.
4416 @end deffn
4417
4418 The following commands exist as subcommands of DAP instances:
4419
4420 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name info} [num]
4421 Displays the ROM table for MEM-AP @var{num},
4422 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4423 @end deffn
4424
4425 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name apid} [num]
4426 Displays ID register from AP @var{num}, defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4427 @end deffn
4428
4429 @anchor{DAP subcommand apreg}
4430 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name apreg} ap_num reg [value]
4431 Displays content of a register @var{reg} from AP @var{ap_num}
4432 or set a new value @var{value}.
4433 @var{reg} is byte address of a word register, 0, 4, 8 ... 0xfc.
4434 @end deffn
4435
4436 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name apsel} [num]
4437 Select AP @var{num}, defaulting to 0.
4438 @end deffn
4439
4440 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name dpreg} reg [value]
4441 Displays the content of DP register at address @var{reg}, or set it to a new
4442 value @var{value}.
4443
4444 In case of SWD, @var{reg} is a value in packed format
4445 @math{dpbanksel << 4 | addr} and assumes values 0, 4, 8 ... 0xfc.
4446 In case of JTAG it only assumes values 0, 4, 8 and 0xc.
4447
4448 @emph{Note:} Consider using @command{poll off} to avoid any disturbing
4449 background activity by OpenOCD while you are operating at such low-level.
4450 @end deffn
4451
4452 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name baseaddr} [num]
4453 Displays debug base address from MEM-AP @var{num},
4454 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4455 @end deffn
4456
4457 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name memaccess} [value]
4458 Displays the number of extra tck cycles in the JTAG idle to use for MEM-AP
4459 memory bus access [0-255], giving additional time to respond to reads.
4460 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
4461 @end deffn
4462
4463 @deffn {Command} {$dap_name apcsw} [value [mask]]
4464 Displays or changes CSW bit pattern for MEM-AP transfers.
4465
4466 At the begin of each memory access the CSW pattern is extended (bitwise or-ed)
4467 by @dfn{Size} and @dfn{AddrInc} bit-fields according to transfer requirements
4468 and the result is written to the real CSW register. All bits except dynamically
4469 updated fields @dfn{Size} and @dfn{AddrInc} can be changed by changing
4470 the CSW pattern. Refer to ARM ADI v5 manual chapter 7.6.4 and appendix A
4471 for details.
4472
4473 Use @var{value} only syntax if you want to set the new CSW pattern as a whole.
4474 The example sets HPROT1 bit (required by Cortex-M) and clears the rest of
4475 the pattern:
4476 @example
4477 kx.dap apcsw 0x2000000
4478 @end example
4479
4480 If @var{mask} is also used, the CSW pattern is changed only on bit positions
4481 where the mask bit is 1. The following example sets HPROT3 (cacheable)
4482 and leaves the rest of the pattern intact. It configures memory access through
4483 DCache on Cortex-M7.
4484 @example
4485 set CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE [expr 1 << 27]
4486 samv.dap apcsw $CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE $CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE
4487 @end example
4488
4489 Another example clears SPROT bit and leaves the rest of pattern intact:
4490 @example
4491 set CSW_SPROT [expr 1 << 30]
4492 samv.dap apcsw 0 $CSW_SPROT
4493 @end example
4494
4495 @emph{Note:} If you want to check the real value of CSW, not CSW pattern, use
4496 @code{xxx.dap apreg 0}. @xref{DAP subcommand apreg,,}.
4497
4498 @emph{Warning:} Some of the CSW bits are vital for working memory transfer.
4499 If you set a wrong CSW pattern and MEM-AP stopped working, use the following
4500 example with a proper dap name:
4501 @example
4502 xxx.dap apcsw default
4503 @end example
4504 @end deffn
4505
4506 @deffn {Config Command} {$dap_name ti_be_32_quirks} [@option{enable}]
4507 Set/get quirks mode for TI TMS450/TMS570 processors
4508 Disabled by default
4509 @end deffn
4510
4511
4512 @node CPU Configuration
4513 @chapter CPU Configuration
4514 @cindex GDB target
4515
4516 This chapter discusses how to set up GDB debug targets for CPUs.
4517 You can also access these targets without GDB
4518 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands},
4519 and @ref{targetstatehandling,,Target State handling}) and
4520 through various kinds of NAND and NOR flash commands.
4521 If you have multiple CPUs you can have multiple such targets.
4522
4523 We'll start by looking at how to examine the targets you have,
4524 then look at how to add one more target and how to configure it.
4525
4526 @section Target List
4527 @cindex target, current
4528 @cindex target, list
4529
4530 All targets that have been set up are part of a list,
4531 where each member has a name.
4532 That name should normally be the same as the TAP name.
4533 You can display the list with the @command{targets}
4534 (plural!) command.
4535 This display often has only one CPU; here's what it might
4536 look like with more than one:
4537 @verbatim
4538 TargetName Type Endian TapName State
4539 -- ------------------ ---------- ------ ------------------ ------------
4540 0* at91rm9200.cpu arm920t little at91rm9200.cpu running
4541 1 MyTarget cortex_m little mychip.foo tap-disabled
4542 @end verbatim
4543
4544 One member of that list is the @dfn{current target}, which
4545 is implicitly referenced by many commands.
4546 It's the one marked with a @code{*} near the target name.
4547 In particular, memory addresses often refer to the address
4548 space seen by that current target.
4549 Commands like @command{mdw} (memory display words)
4550 and @command{flash erase_address} (erase NOR flash blocks)
4551 are examples; and there are many more.
4552
4553 Several commands let you examine the list of targets:
4554
4555 @deffn {Command} {target current}
4556 Returns the name of the current target.
4557 @end deffn
4558
4559 @deffn {Command} {target names}
4560 Lists the names of all current targets in the list.
4561 @example
4562 foreach t [target names] @{
4563 puts [format "Target: %s\n" $t]
4564 @}
4565 @end example
4566 @end deffn
4567
4568 @c yep, "target list" would have been better.
4569 @c plus maybe "target setdefault".
4570
4571 @deffn {Command} {targets} [name]
4572 @emph{Note: the name of this command is plural. Other target
4573 command names are singular.}
4574
4575 With no parameter, this command displays a table of all known
4576 targets in a user friendly form.
4577
4578 With a parameter, this command sets the current target to
4579 the given target with the given @var{name}; this is
4580 only relevant on boards which have more than one target.
4581 @end deffn
4582
4583 @section Target CPU Types
4584 @cindex target type
4585 @cindex CPU type
4586
4587 Each target has a @dfn{CPU type}, as shown in the output of
4588 the @command{targets} command. You need to specify that type
4589 when calling @command{target create}.
4590 The CPU type indicates more than just the instruction set.
4591 It also indicates how that instruction set is implemented,
4592 what kind of debug support it integrates,
4593 whether it has an MMU (and if so, what kind),
4594 what core-specific commands may be available
4595 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands}),
4596 and more.
4597
4598 It's easy to see what target types are supported,
4599 since there's a command to list them.
4600
4601 @anchor{targettypes}
4602 @deffn {Command} {target types}
4603 Lists all supported target types.
4604 At this writing, the supported CPU types are:
4605
4606 @itemize @bullet
4607 @item @code{aarch64} -- this is an ARMv8-A core with an MMU.
4608 @item @code{arm11} -- this is a generation of ARMv6 cores.
4609 @item @code{arm720t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU.
4610 @item @code{arm7tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core.
4611 @item @code{arm920t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU.
4612 @item @code{arm926ejs} -- this is an ARMv5 core with an MMU.
4613 @item @code{arm946e} -- this is an ARMv5 core with an MMU.
4614 @item @code{arm966e} -- this is an ARMv5 core.
4615 @item @code{arm9tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core.
4616 @item @code{avr} -- implements Atmel's 8-bit AVR instruction set.
4617 (Support for this is preliminary and incomplete.)
4618 @item @code{avr32_ap7k} -- this an AVR32 core.
4619 @item @code{cortex_a} -- this is an ARMv7-A core with an MMU.
4620 @item @code{cortex_m} -- this is an ARMv7-M core, supporting only the
4621 compact Thumb2 instruction set. Supports also ARMv6-M and ARMv8-M cores
4622 @item @code{cortex_r4} -- this is an ARMv7-R core.
4623 @item @code{dragonite} -- resembles arm966e.
4624 @item @code{dsp563xx} -- implements Freescale's 24-bit DSP.
4625 (Support for this is still incomplete.)
4626 @item @code{dsp5680xx} -- implements Freescale's 5680x DSP.
4627 @item @code{esirisc} -- this is an EnSilica eSi-RISC core.
4628 The current implementation supports eSi-32xx cores.
4629 @item @code{fa526} -- resembles arm920 (w/o Thumb).
4630 @item @code{feroceon} -- resembles arm926.
4631 @item @code{hla_target} -- a Cortex-M alternative to work with HL adapters like ST-Link.
4632 @item @code{ls1_sap} -- this is the SAP on NXP LS102x CPUs,
4633 allowing access to physical memory addresses independently of CPU cores.
4634 @item @code{mem_ap} -- this is an ARM debug infrastructure Access Port without
4635 a CPU, through which bus read and write cycles can be generated; it may be
4636 useful for working with non-CPU hardware behind an AP or during development of
4637 support for new CPUs.
4638 It's possible to connect a GDB client to this target (the GDB port has to be
4639 specified, @xref{gdbportoverride,,option -gdb-port}.), and a fake ARM core will
4640 be emulated to comply to GDB remote protocol.
4641 @item @code{mips_m4k} -- a MIPS core.
4642 @item @code{mips_mips64} -- a MIPS64 core.
4643 @item @code{nds32_v2} -- this is an Andes NDS32 v2 core.
4644 @item @code{nds32_v3} -- this is an Andes NDS32 v3 core.
4645 @item @code{nds32_v3m} -- this is an Andes NDS32 v3m core.
4646 @item @code{or1k} -- this is an OpenRISC 1000 core.
4647 The current implementation supports three JTAG TAP cores:
4648 @itemize @minus
4649 @item @code{OpenCores TAP} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project@comma{}jtag})
4650 @item @code{Altera Virtual JTAG TAP} (See: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_virtualjtag.pdf})
4651 @item @code{Xilinx BSCAN_* virtual JTAG interface} (See: @url{http://www.xilinx.com/support/documentation/sw_manuals/xilinx14_2/spartan6_hdl.pdf})
4652 @end itemize
4653 And two debug interfaces cores:
4654 @itemize @minus
4655 @item @code{Advanced debug interface}
4656 @*(See: @url{http://opencores.org/project@comma{}adv_debug_sys})
4657 @item @code{SoC Debug Interface}
4658 @*(See: @url{http://opencores.org/project@comma{}dbg_interface})
4659 @end itemize
4660 @item @code{quark_d20xx} -- an Intel Quark D20xx core.
4661 @item @code{quark_x10xx} -- an Intel Quark X10xx core.
4662 @item @code{riscv} -- a RISC-V core.
4663 @item @code{stm8} -- implements an STM8 core.
4664 @item @code{testee} -- a dummy target for cases without a real CPU, e.g. CPLD.
4665 @item @code{xscale} -- this is actually an architecture,
4666 not a CPU type. It is based on the ARMv5 architecture.
4667 @end itemize
4668 @end deffn
4669
4670 To avoid being confused by the variety of ARM based cores, remember
4671 this key point: @emph{ARM is a technology licencing company}.
4672 (See: @url{http://www.arm.com}.)
4673 The CPU name used by OpenOCD will reflect the CPU design that was
4674 licensed, not a vendor brand which incorporates that design.
4675 Name prefixes like arm7, arm9, arm11, and cortex
4676 reflect design generations;
4677 while names like ARMv4, ARMv5, ARMv6, ARMv7 and ARMv8
4678 reflect an architecture version implemented by a CPU design.
4679
4680 @anchor{targetconfiguration}
4681 @section Target Configuration
4682
4683 Before creating a ``target'', you must have added its TAP to the scan chain.
4684 When you've added that TAP, you will have a @code{dotted.name}
4685 which is used to set up the CPU support.
4686 The chip-specific configuration file will normally configure its CPU(s)
4687 right after it adds all of the chip's TAPs to the scan chain.
4688
4689 Although you can set up a target in one step, it's often clearer if you
4690 use shorter commands and do it in two steps: create it, then configure
4691 optional parts.
4692 All operations on the target after it's created will use a new
4693 command, created as part of target creation.
4694
4695 The two main things to configure after target creation are
4696 a work area, which usually has target-specific defaults even
4697 if the board setup code overrides them later;
4698 and event handlers (@pxref{targetevents,,Target Events}), which tend
4699 to be much more board-specific.
4700 The key steps you use might look something like this
4701
4702 @example
4703 dap create mychip.dap -chain-position mychip.cpu
4704 target create MyTarget cortex_m -dap mychip.dap
4705 MyTarget configure -work-area-phys 0x08000 -work-area-size 8096
4706 MyTarget configure -event reset-deassert-pre @{ jtag_rclk 5 @}
4707 MyTarget configure -event reset-init @{ myboard_reinit @}
4708 @end example
4709
4710 You should specify a working area if you can; typically it uses some
4711 on-chip SRAM.
4712 Such a working area can speed up many things, including bulk
4713 writes to target memory;
4714 flash operations like checking to see if memory needs to be erased;
4715 GDB memory checksumming;
4716 and more.
4717
4718 @quotation Warning
4719 On more complex chips, the work area can become
4720 inaccessible when application code
4721 (such as an operating system)
4722 enables or disables the MMU.
4723 For example, the particular MMU context used to access the virtual
4724 address will probably matter ... and that context might not have
4725 easy access to other addresses needed.
4726 At this writing, OpenOCD doesn't have much MMU intelligence.
4727 @end quotation
4728
4729 It's often very useful to define a @code{reset-init} event handler.
4730 For systems that are normally used with a boot loader,
4731 common tasks include updating clocks and initializing memory
4732 controllers.
4733 That may be needed to let you write the boot loader into flash,
4734 in order to ``de-brick'' your board; or to load programs into
4735 external DDR memory without having run the boot loader.
4736
4737 @deffn {Config Command} {target create} target_name type configparams...
4738 This command creates a GDB debug target that refers to a specific JTAG tap.
4739 It enters that target into a list, and creates a new
4740 command (@command{@var{target_name}}) which is used for various
4741 purposes including additional configuration.
4742
4743 @itemize @bullet
4744 @item @var{target_name} ... is the name of the debug target.
4745 By convention this should be the same as the @emph{dotted.name}
4746 of the TAP associated with this target, which must be specified here
4747 using the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} configparam.
4748
4749 This name is also used to create the target object command,
4750 referred to here as @command{$target_name},
4751 and in other places the target needs to be identified.
4752 @item @var{type} ... specifies the target type. @xref{targettypes,,target types}.
4753 @item @var{configparams} ... all parameters accepted by
4754 @command{$target_name configure} are permitted.
4755 If the target is big-endian, set it here with @code{-endian big}.
4756
4757 You @emph{must} set the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} or
4758 @code{-dap @var{dap_name}} here.
4759 @end itemize
4760 @end deffn
4761
4762 @deffn {Command} {$target_name configure} configparams...
4763 The options accepted by this command may also be
4764 specified as parameters to @command{target create}.
4765 Their values can later be queried one at a time by
4766 using the @command{$target_name cget} command.
4767
4768 @emph{Warning:} changing some of these after setup is dangerous.
4769 For example, moving a target from one TAP to another;
4770 and changing its endianness.
4771
4772 @itemize @bullet
4773
4774 @item @code{-chain-position} @var{dotted.name} -- names the TAP
4775 used to access this target.
4776
4777 @item @code{-dap} @var{dap_name} -- names the DAP used to access
4778 this target. @xref{dapdeclaration,,DAP declaration}, on how to
4779 create and manage DAP instances.
4780
4781 @item @code{-endian} (@option{big}|@option{little}) -- specifies
4782 whether the CPU uses big or little endian conventions
4783
4784 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} @var{event_body} --
4785 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
4786 Note that this updates a list of named event handlers.
4787 Calling this twice with two different event names assigns
4788 two different handlers, but calling it twice with the
4789 same event name assigns only one handler.
4790
4791 Current target is temporarily overridden to the event issuing target
4792 before handler code starts and switched back after handler is done.
4793
4794 @item @code{-work-area-backup} (@option{0}|@option{1}) -- says
4795 whether the work area gets backed up; by default,
4796 @emph{it is not backed up.}
4797 When possible, use a working_area that doesn't need to be backed up,
4798 since performing a backup slows down operations.
4799 For example, the beginning of an SRAM block is likely to
4800 be used by most build systems, but the end is often unused.
4801
4802 @item @code{-work-area-size} @var{size} -- specify work are size,
4803 in bytes. The same size applies regardless of whether its physical
4804 or virtual address is being used.
4805
4806 @item @code{-work-area-phys} @var{address} -- set the work area
4807 base @var{address} to be used when no MMU is active.
4808
4809 @item @code{-work-area-virt} @var{address} -- set the work area
4810 base @var{address} to be used when an MMU is active.
4811 @emph{Do not specify a value for this except on targets with an MMU.}
4812 The value should normally correspond to a static mapping for the
4813 @code{-work-area-phys} address, set up by the current operating system.
4814
4815 @anchor{rtostype}
4816 @item @code{-rtos} @var{rtos_type} -- enable rtos support for target,
4817 @var{rtos_type} can be one of @option{auto}, @option{eCos},
4818 @option{ThreadX}, @option{FreeRTOS}, @option{linux}, @option{ChibiOS},
4819 @option{embKernel}, @option{mqx}, @option{uCOS-III}, @option{nuttx},
4820 @option{RIOT}, @option{Zephyr}
4821 @xref{gdbrtossupport,,RTOS Support}.
4822
4823 @item @code{-defer-examine} -- skip target examination at initial JTAG chain
4824 scan and after a reset. A manual call to arp_examine is required to
4825 access the target for debugging.
4826
4827 @item @code{-ap-num} @var{ap_number} -- set DAP access port for target,
4828 @var{ap_number} is the numeric index of the DAP AP the target is connected to.
4829 Use this option with systems where multiple, independent cores are connected
4830 to separate access ports of the same DAP.
4831
4832 @item @code{-cti} @var{cti_name} -- set Cross-Trigger Interface (CTI) connected
4833 to the target. Currently, only the @code{aarch64} target makes use of this option,
4834 where it is a mandatory configuration for the target run control.
4835 @xref{armcrosstrigger,,ARM Cross-Trigger Interface},
4836 for instruction on how to declare and control a CTI instance.
4837
4838 @anchor{gdbportoverride}
4839 @item @code{-gdb-port} @var{number} -- see command @command{gdb_port} for the
4840 possible values of the parameter @var{number}, which are not only numeric values.
4841 Use this option to override, for this target only, the global parameter set with
4842 command @command{gdb_port}.
4843 @xref{gdb_port,,command gdb_port}.
4844
4845 @item @code{-gdb-max-connections} @var{number} -- EXPERIMENTAL: set the maximum
4846 number of GDB connections that are allowed for the target. Default is 1.
4847 A negative value for @var{number} means unlimited connections.
4848 See @xref{gdbmeminspect,,Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector}.
4849 @end itemize
4850 @end deffn
4851
4852 @section Other $target_name Commands
4853 @cindex object command
4854
4855 The Tcl/Tk language has the concept of object commands,
4856 and OpenOCD adopts that same model for targets.
4857
4858 A good Tk example is a on screen button.
4859 Once a button is created a button
4860 has a name (a path in Tk terms) and that name is useable as a first
4861 class command. For example in Tk, one can create a button and later
4862 configure it like this:
4863
4864 @example
4865 # Create
4866 button .foobar -background red -command @{ foo @}
4867 # Modify
4868 .foobar configure -foreground blue
4869 # Query
4870 set x [.foobar cget -background]
4871 # Report
4872 puts [format "The button is %s" $x]
4873 @end example
4874
4875 In OpenOCD's terms, the ``target'' is an object just like a Tcl/Tk
4876 button, and its object commands are invoked the same way.
4877
4878 @example
4879 str912.cpu mww 0x1234 0x42
4880 omap3530.cpu mww 0x5555 123
4881 @end example
4882
4883 The commands supported by OpenOCD target objects are:
4884
4885 @deffn {Command} {$target_name arp_examine} @option{allow-defer}
4886 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name arp_halt}
4887 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name arp_poll}
4888 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name arp_reset}
4889 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name arp_waitstate}
4890 Internal OpenOCD scripts (most notably @file{startup.tcl})
4891 use these to deal with specific reset cases.
4892 They are not otherwise documented here.
4893 @end deffn
4894
4895 @deffn {Command} {$target_name array2mem} arrayname width address count
4896 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mem2array} arrayname width address count
4897 These provide an efficient script-oriented interface to memory.
4898 The @code{array2mem} primitive writes bytes, halfwords, words
4899 or double-words; while @code{mem2array} reads them.
4900 In both cases, the TCL side uses an array, and
4901 the target side uses raw memory.
4902
4903 The efficiency comes from enabling the use of
4904 bulk JTAG data transfer operations.
4905 The script orientation comes from working with data
4906 values that are packaged for use by TCL scripts;
4907 @command{mdw} type primitives only print data they retrieve,
4908 and neither store nor return those values.
4909
4910 @itemize
4911 @item @var{arrayname} ... is the name of an array variable
4912 @item @var{width} ... is 8/16/32/64 - indicating the memory access size
4913 @item @var{address} ... is the target memory address
4914 @item @var{count} ... is the number of elements to process
4915 @end itemize
4916 @end deffn
4917
4918 @deffn {Command} {$target_name cget} queryparm
4919 Each configuration parameter accepted by
4920 @command{$target_name configure}
4921 can be individually queried, to return its current value.
4922 The @var{queryparm} is a parameter name
4923 accepted by that command, such as @code{-work-area-phys}.
4924 There are a few special cases:
4925
4926 @itemize @bullet
4927 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} -- returns the handler for the
4928 event named @var{event_name}.
4929 This is a special case because setting a handler requires
4930 two parameters.
4931 @item @code{-type} -- returns the target type.
4932 This is a special case because this is set using
4933 @command{target create} and can't be changed
4934 using @command{$target_name configure}.
4935 @end itemize
4936
4937 For example, if you wanted to summarize information about
4938 all the targets you might use something like this:
4939
4940 @example
4941 foreach name [target names] @{
4942 set y [$name cget -endian]
4943 set z [$name cget -type]
4944 puts [format "Chip %d is %s, Endian: %s, type: %s" \
4945 $x $name $y $z]
4946 @}
4947 @end example
4948 @end deffn
4949
4950 @anchor{targetcurstate}
4951 @deffn {Command} {$target_name curstate}
4952 Displays the current target state:
4953 @code{debug-running},
4954 @code{halted},
4955 @code{reset},
4956 @code{running}, or @code{unknown}.
4957 (Also, @pxref{eventpolling,,Event Polling}.)
4958 @end deffn
4959
4960 @deffn {Command} {$target_name eventlist}
4961 Displays a table listing all event handlers
4962 currently associated with this target.
4963 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
4964 @end deffn
4965
4966 @deffn {Command} {$target_name invoke-event} event_name
4967 Invokes the handler for the event named @var{event_name}.
4968 (This is primarily intended for use by OpenOCD framework
4969 code, for example by the reset code in @file{startup.tcl}.)
4970 @end deffn
4971
4972 @deffn {Command} {$target_name mdd} [phys] addr [count]
4973 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mdw} [phys] addr [count]
4974 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mdh} [phys] addr [count]
4975 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mdb} [phys] addr [count]
4976 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
4977 64-bit doublewords (@command{mdd}),
4978 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
4979 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
4980 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
4981 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
4982 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
4983 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
4984 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
4985 (If you want to manipulate the data instead of displaying it,
4986 see the @code{mem2array} primitives.)
4987 @end deffn
4988
4989 @deffn {Command} {$target_name mwd} [phys] addr doubleword [count]
4990 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mww} [phys] addr word [count]
4991 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mwh} [phys] addr halfword [count]
4992 @deffnx {Command} {$target_name mwb} [phys] addr byte [count]
4993 Writes the specified @var{doubleword} (64 bits), @var{word} (32 bits),
4994 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) value,
4995 at the specified address @var{addr}.
4996 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
4997 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
4998 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
4999 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
5000 If @var{count} is specified, fills that many units of consecutive address.
5001 @end deffn
5002
5003 @anchor{targetevents}
5004 @section Target Events
5005 @cindex target events
5006 @cindex events
5007 At various times, certain things can happen, or you want them to happen.
5008 For example:
5009 @itemize @bullet
5010 @item What should happen when GDB connects? Should your target reset?
5011 @item When GDB tries to flash the target, do you need to enable the flash via a special command?
5012 @item Is using SRST appropriate (and possible) on your system?
5013 Or instead of that, do you need to issue JTAG commands to trigger reset?
5014 SRST usually resets everything on the scan chain, which can be inappropriate.
5015 @item During reset, do you need to write to certain memory locations
5016 to set up system clocks or
5017 to reconfigure the SDRAM?
5018 How about configuring the watchdog timer, or other peripherals,
5019 to stop running while you hold the core stopped for debugging?
5020 @end itemize
5021
5022 All of the above items can be addressed by target event handlers.
5023 These are set up by @command{$target_name configure -event} or
5024 @command{target create ... -event}.
5025
5026 The programmer's model matches the @code{-command} option used in Tcl/Tk
5027 buttons and events. The two examples below act the same, but one creates
5028 and invokes a small procedure while the other inlines it.
5029
5030 @example
5031 proc my_init_proc @{ @} @{
5032 echo "Disabling watchdog..."
5033 mww 0xfffffd44 0x00008000
5034 @}
5035 mychip.cpu configure -event reset-init my_init_proc
5036 mychip.cpu configure -event reset-init @{
5037 echo "Disabling watchdog..."
5038 mww 0xfffffd44 0x00008000
5039 @}
5040 @end example
5041
5042 The following target events are defined:
5043
5044 @itemize @bullet
5045 @item @b{debug-halted}
5046 @* The target has halted for debug reasons (i.e.: breakpoint)
5047 @item @b{debug-resumed}
5048 @* The target has resumed (i.e.: GDB said run)
5049 @item @b{early-halted}
5050 @* Occurs early in the halt process
5051 @item @b{examine-start}
5052 @* Before target examine is called.
5053 @item @b{examine-end}
5054 @* After target examine is called with no errors.
5055 @item @b{examine-fail}
5056 @* After target examine fails.
5057 @item @b{gdb-attach}
5058 @* When GDB connects. Issued before any GDB communication with the target
5059 starts. GDB expects the target is halted during attachment.
5060 @xref{gdbmeminspect,,GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector}, how to
5061 connect GDB to running target.
5062 The event can be also used to set up the target so it is possible to probe flash.
5063 Probing flash is necessary during GDB connect if you want to use
5064 @pxref{programmingusinggdb,,programming using GDB}.
5065 Another use of the flash memory map is for GDB to automatically choose
5066 hardware or software breakpoints depending on whether the breakpoint
5067 is in RAM or read only memory.
5068 Default is @code{halt}
5069 @item @b{gdb-detach}
5070 @* When GDB disconnects
5071 @item @b{gdb-end}
5072 @* When the target has halted and GDB is not doing anything (see early halt)
5073 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-start}
5074 @* Before the GDB flash process tries to erase the flash (default is
5075 @code{reset init})
5076 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-end}
5077 @* After the GDB flash process has finished erasing the flash
5078 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-start}
5079 @* Before GDB writes to the flash
5080 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-end}
5081 @* After GDB writes to the flash (default is @code{reset halt})
5082 @item @b{gdb-start}
5083 @* Before the target steps, GDB is trying to start/resume the target
5084 @item @b{halted}
5085 @* The target has halted
5086 @item @b{reset-assert-pre}
5087 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
5088 after @command{reset-start} was triggered
5089 but before either SRST alone is asserted on the scan chain,
5090 or @code{reset-assert} is triggered.
5091 @item @b{reset-assert}
5092 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
5093 after @command{reset-assert-pre} was triggered.
5094 When such a handler is present, cores which support this event will use
5095 it instead of asserting SRST.
5096 This support is essential for debugging with JTAG interfaces which
5097 don't include an SRST line (JTAG doesn't require SRST), and for
5098 selective reset on scan chains that have multiple targets.
5099 @item @b{reset-assert-post}
5100 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
5101 after @code{reset-assert} has been triggered.
5102 or the target asserted SRST on the entire scan chain.
5103 @item @b{reset-deassert-pre}
5104 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
5105 after @code{reset-assert-post} has been triggered.
5106 @item @b{reset-deassert-post}
5107 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
5108 after @code{reset-deassert-pre} has been triggered
5109 and (if the target is using it) after SRST has been
5110 released on the scan chain.
5111 @item @b{reset-end}
5112 @* Issued as the final step in @command{reset} processing.
5113 @item @b{reset-init}
5114 @* Used by @b{reset init} command for board-specific initialization.
5115 This event fires after @emph{reset-deassert-post}.
5116
5117 This is where you would configure PLLs and clocking, set up DRAM so
5118 you can download programs that don't fit in on-chip SRAM, set up pin
5119 multiplexing, and so on.
5120 (You may be able to switch to a fast JTAG clock rate here, after
5121 the target clocks are fully set up.)
5122 @item @b{reset-start}
5123 @* Issued as the first step in @command{reset} processing
5124 before @command{reset-assert-pre} is called.
5125
5126 This is the most robust place to use @command{jtag_rclk}
5127 or @command{adapter speed} to switch to a low JTAG clock rate,
5128 when reset disables PLLs needed to use a fast clock.
5129 @item @b{resume-start}
5130 @* Before any target is resumed
5131 @item @b{resume-end}
5132 @* After all targets have resumed
5133 @item @b{resumed}
5134 @* Target has resumed
5135 @item @b{step-start}
5136 @* Before a target is single-stepped
5137 @item @b{step-end}
5138 @* After single-step has completed
5139 @item @b{trace-config}
5140 @* After target hardware trace configuration was changed
5141 @end itemize
5142
5143 @quotation Note
5144 OpenOCD events are not supposed to be preempt by another event, but this
5145 is not enforced in current code. Only the target event @b{resumed} is
5146 executed with polling disabled; this avoids polling to trigger the event
5147 @b{halted}, reversing the logical order of execution of their handlers.
5148 Future versions of OpenOCD will prevent the event preemption and will
5149 disable the schedule of polling during the event execution. Do not rely
5150 on polling in any event handler; this means, don't expect the status of
5151 a core to change during the execution of the handler. The event handler
5152 will have to enable polling or use @command{$target_name arp_poll} to
5153 check if the core has changed status.
5154 @end quotation
5155
5156 @node Flash Commands
5157 @chapter Flash Commands
5158
5159 OpenOCD has different commands for NOR and NAND flash;
5160 the ``flash'' command works with NOR flash, while
5161 the ``nand'' command works with NAND flash.
5162 This partially reflects different hardware technologies:
5163 NOR flash usually supports direct CPU instruction and data bus access,
5164 while data from a NAND flash must be copied to memory before it can be
5165 used. (SPI flash must also be copied to memory before use.)
5166 However, the documentation also uses ``flash'' as a generic term;
5167 for example, ``Put flash configuration in board-specific files''.
5168
5169 Flash Steps:
5170 @enumerate
5171 @item Configure via the command @command{flash bank}
5172 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
5173 passing parameters as needed by the driver.
5174 @item Operate on the flash via @command{flash subcommand}
5175 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
5176 via a script in some automated way. Common tasks include writing a
5177 boot loader, operating system, or other data.
5178 @item GDB Flashing
5179 @* Flashing via GDB requires the flash be configured via ``flash
5180 bank'', and the GDB flash features be enabled.
5181 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
5182 @end enumerate
5183
5184 Many CPUs have the ability to ``boot'' from the first flash bank.
5185 This means that misprogramming that bank can ``brick'' a system,
5186 so that it can't boot.
5187 JTAG tools, like OpenOCD, are often then used to ``de-brick'' the
5188 board by (re)installing working boot firmware.
5189
5190 @anchor{norconfiguration}
5191 @section Flash Configuration Commands
5192 @cindex flash configuration
5193
5194 @deffn {Config Command} {flash bank} name driver base size chip_width bus_width target [driver_options]
5195 Configures a flash bank which provides persistent storage
5196 for addresses from @math{base} to @math{base + size - 1}.
5197 These banks will often be visible to GDB through the target's memory map.
5198 In some cases, configuring a flash bank will activate extra commands;
5199 see the driver-specific documentation.
5200
5201 @itemize @bullet
5202 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the flash bank
5203 in other flash commands. A number is also available.
5204 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the controller driver
5205 associated with the flash bank being declared.
5206 This is usually @code{cfi} for external flash, or else
5207 the name of a microcontroller with embedded flash memory.
5208 @xref{flashdriverlist,,Flash Driver List}.
5209 @item @var{base} ... Base address of the flash chip.
5210 @item @var{size} ... Size of the chip, in bytes.
5211 For some drivers, this value is detected from the hardware.
5212 @item @var{chip_width} ... Width of the flash chip, in bytes;
5213 ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
5214 @item @var{bus_width} ... Width of the data bus used to access the
5215 chip, in bytes; ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
5216 @item @var{target} ... Names the target used to issue
5217 commands to the flash controller.
5218 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
5219 @item @var{driver_options} ... drivers may support, or require,
5220 additional parameters. See the driver-specific documentation
5221 for more information.
5222 @end itemize
5223 @quotation Note
5224 This command is not available after OpenOCD initialization has completed.
5225 Use it in board specific configuration files, not interactively.
5226 @end quotation
5227 @end deffn
5228
5229 @comment less confusing would be: "flash list" (like "nand list")
5230 @deffn {Command} {flash banks}
5231 Prints a one-line summary of each device that was
5232 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
5233 Note that this is the @emph{plural} form;
5234 the @emph{singular} form is a very different command.
5235 @end deffn
5236
5237 @deffn {Command} {flash list}
5238 Retrieves a list of associative arrays for each device that was
5239 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
5240 This returned list can be manipulated easily from within scripts.
5241 @end deffn
5242
5243 @deffn {Command} {flash probe} num
5244 Identify the flash, or validate the parameters of the configured flash. Operation
5245 depends on the flash type.
5246 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5247 Most flash commands will implicitly @emph{autoprobe} the bank;
5248 flash drivers can distinguish between probing and autoprobing,
5249 but most don't bother.
5250 @end deffn
5251
5252 @section Preparing a Target before Flash Programming
5253
5254 The target device should be in well defined state before the flash programming
5255 begins.
5256
5257 @emph{Always issue} @command{reset init} before @ref{flashprogrammingcommands,,Flash Programming Commands}.
5258 Do not issue another @command{reset} or @command{reset halt} or @command{resume}
5259 until the programming session is finished.
5260
5261 If you use @ref{programmingusinggdb,,Programming using GDB},
5262 the target is prepared automatically in the event gdb-flash-erase-start
5263
5264 The jimtcl script @command{program} calls @command{reset init} explicitly.
5265
5266 @section Erasing, Reading, Writing to Flash
5267 @cindex flash erasing
5268 @cindex flash reading
5269 @cindex flash writing
5270 @cindex flash programming
5271 @anchor{flashprogrammingcommands}
5272
5273 One feature distinguishing NOR flash from NAND or serial flash technologies
5274 is that for read access, it acts exactly like any other addressable memory.
5275 This means you can use normal memory read commands like @command{mdw} or
5276 @command{dump_image} with it, with no special @command{flash} subcommands.
5277 @xref{memoryaccess,,Memory access}, and @ref{imageaccess,,Image access}.
5278
5279 Write access works differently. Flash memory normally needs to be erased
5280 before it's written. Erasing a sector turns all of its bits to ones, and
5281 writing can turn ones into zeroes. This is why there are special commands
5282 for interactive erasing and writing, and why GDB needs to know which parts
5283 of the address space hold NOR flash memory.
5284
5285 @quotation Note
5286 Most of these erase and write commands leverage the fact that NOR flash
5287 chips consume target address space. They implicitly refer to the current
5288 JTAG target, and map from an address in that target's address space
5289 back to a flash bank.
5290 @comment In May 2009, those mappings may fail if any bank associated
5291 @comment with that target doesn't successfully autoprobe ... bug worth fixing?
5292 A few commands use abstract addressing based on bank and sector numbers,
5293 and don't depend on searching the current target and its address space.
5294 Avoid confusing the two command models.
5295 @end quotation
5296
5297 Some flash chips implement software protection against accidental writes,
5298 since such buggy writes could in some cases ``brick'' a system.
5299 For such systems, erasing and writing may require sector protection to be
5300 disabled first.
5301 Examples include CFI flash such as ``Intel Advanced Bootblock flash'',
5302 and AT91SAM7 on-chip flash.
5303 @xref{flashprotect,,flash protect}.
5304
5305 @deffn {Command} {flash erase_sector} num first last
5306 Erase sectors in bank @var{num}, starting at sector @var{first}
5307 up to and including @var{last}.
5308 Sector numbering starts at 0.
5309 Providing a @var{last} sector of @option{last}
5310 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
5311 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5312 @end deffn
5313
5314 @deffn {Command} {flash erase_address} [@option{pad}] [@option{unlock}] address length
5315 Erase sectors starting at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
5316 Unless @option{pad} is specified, @math{address} must begin a
5317 flash sector, and @math{address + length - 1} must end a sector.
5318 Specifying @option{pad} erases extra data at the beginning and/or
5319 end of the specified region, as needed to erase only full sectors.
5320 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address}, and
5321 the specified length must stay within that bank.
5322 As a special case, when @var{length} is zero and @var{address} is
5323 the start of the bank, the whole flash is erased.
5324 If @option{unlock} is specified, then the flash is unprotected
5325 before erase starts.
5326 @end deffn
5327
5328 @deffn {Command} {flash filld} address double-word length
5329 @deffnx {Command} {flash fillw} address word length
5330 @deffnx {Command} {flash fillh} address halfword length
5331 @deffnx {Command} {flash fillb} address byte length
5332 Fills flash memory with the specified @var{double-word} (64 bits), @var{word} (32 bits),
5333 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) pattern,
5334 starting at @var{address} and continuing
5335 for @var{length} units (word/halfword/byte).
5336 No erasure is done before writing; when needed, that must be done
5337 before issuing this command.
5338 Writes are done in blocks of up to 1024 bytes, and each write is
5339 verified by reading back the data and comparing it to what was written.
5340 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address} of
5341 each block, and the specified length must stay within that bank.
5342 @end deffn
5343 @comment no current checks for errors if fill blocks touch multiple banks!
5344
5345 @deffn {Command} {flash mdw} addr [count]
5346 @deffnx {Command} {flash mdh} addr [count]
5347 @deffnx {Command} {flash mdb} addr [count]
5348 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
5349 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
5350 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
5351 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
5352 Reads from flash using the flash driver, therefore it enables reading
5353 from a bank not mapped in target address space.
5354 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address} of
5355 each block, and the specified length must stay within that bank.
5356 @end deffn
5357
5358 @deffn {Command} {flash write_bank} num filename [offset]
5359 Write the binary @file{filename} to flash bank @var{num},
5360 starting at @var{offset} bytes from the beginning of the bank. If @var{offset}
5361 is omitted, start at the beginning of the flash bank.
5362 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5363 @end deffn
5364
5365 @deffn {Command} {flash read_bank} num filename [offset [length]]
5366 Read @var{length} bytes from the flash bank @var{num} starting at @var{offset}
5367 and write the contents to the binary @file{filename}. If @var{offset} is
5368 omitted, start at the beginning of the flash bank. If @var{length} is omitted,
5369 read the remaining bytes from the flash bank.
5370 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5371 @end deffn
5372
5373 @deffn {Command} {flash verify_bank} num filename [offset]
5374 Compare the contents of the binary file @var{filename} with the contents of the
5375 flash bank @var{num} starting at @var{offset}. If @var{offset} is omitted,
5376 start at the beginning of the flash bank. Fail if the contents do not match.
5377 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5378 @end deffn
5379
5380 @deffn {Command} {flash write_image} [erase] [unlock] filename [offset] [type]
5381 Write the image @file{filename} to the current target's flash bank(s).
5382 Only loadable sections from the image are written.
5383 A relocation @var{offset} may be specified, in which case it is added
5384 to the base address for each section in the image.
5385 The file [@var{type}] can be specified
5386 explicitly as @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
5387 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19).
5388 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
5389 The relevant flash sectors will be erased prior to programming
5390 if the @option{erase} parameter is given. If @option{unlock} is
5391 provided, then the flash banks are unlocked before erase and
5392 program. The flash bank to use is inferred from the address of
5393 each image section.
5394
5395 @quotation Warning
5396 Be careful using the @option{erase} flag when the flash is holding
5397 data you want to preserve.
5398 Portions of the flash outside those described in the image's
5399 sections might be erased with no notice.
5400 @itemize
5401 @item
5402 When a section of the image being written does not fill out all the
5403 sectors it uses, the unwritten parts of those sectors are necessarily
5404 also erased, because sectors can't be partially erased.
5405 @item
5406 Data stored in sector "holes" between image sections are also affected.
5407 For example, "@command{flash write_image erase ...}" of an image with
5408 one byte at the beginning of a flash bank and one byte at the end
5409 erases the entire bank -- not just the two sectors being written.
5410 @end itemize
5411 Also, when flash protection is important, you must re-apply it after
5412 it has been removed by the @option{unlock} flag.
5413 @end quotation
5414
5415 @end deffn
5416
5417 @deffn {Command} {flash verify_image} filename [offset] [type]
5418 Verify the image @file{filename} to the current target's flash bank(s).
5419 Parameters follow the description of 'flash write_image'.
5420 In contrast to the 'verify_image' command, for banks with specific
5421 verify method, that one is used instead of the usual target's read
5422 memory methods. This is necessary for flash banks not readable by
5423 ordinary memory reads.
5424 This command gives only an overall good/bad result for each bank, not
5425 addresses of individual failed bytes as it's intended only as quick
5426 check for successful programming.
5427 @end deffn
5428
5429 @section Other Flash commands
5430 @cindex flash protection
5431
5432 @deffn {Command} {flash erase_check} num
5433 Check erase state of sectors in flash bank @var{num},
5434 and display that status.
5435 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5436 @end deffn
5437
5438 @deffn {Command} {flash info} num [sectors]
5439 Print info about flash bank @var{num}, a list of protection blocks
5440 and their status. Use @option{sectors} to show a list of sectors instead.
5441
5442 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5443 This command will first query the hardware, it does not print cached
5444 and possibly stale information.
5445 @end deffn
5446
5447 @anchor{flashprotect}
5448 @deffn {Command} {flash protect} num first last (@option{on}|@option{off})
5449 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) protection of flash blocks
5450 in flash bank @var{num}, starting at protection block @var{first}
5451 and continuing up to and including @var{last}.
5452 Providing a @var{last} block of @option{last}
5453 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
5454 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5455 The protection block is usually identical to a flash sector.
5456 Some devices may utilize a protection block distinct from flash sector.
5457 See @command{flash info} for a list of protection blocks.
5458 @end deffn
5459
5460 @deffn {Command} {flash padded_value} num value
5461 Sets the default value used for padding any image sections, This should
5462 normally match the flash bank erased value. If not specified by this
5463 command or the flash driver then it defaults to 0xff.
5464 @end deffn
5465
5466 @anchor{program}
5467 @deffn {Command} {program} filename [preverify] [verify] [reset] [exit] [offset]
5468 This is a helper script that simplifies using OpenOCD as a standalone
5469 programmer. The only required parameter is @option{filename}, the others are optional.
5470 @xref{Flash Programming}.
5471 @end deffn
5472
5473 @anchor{flashdriverlist}
5474 @section Flash Driver List
5475 As noted above, the @command{flash bank} command requires a driver name,
5476 and allows driver-specific options and behaviors.
5477 Some drivers also activate driver-specific commands.
5478
5479 @deffn {Flash Driver} {virtual}
5480 This is a special driver that maps a previously defined bank to another
5481 address. All bank settings will be copied from the master physical bank.
5482
5483 The @var{virtual} driver defines one mandatory parameters,
5484
5485 @itemize
5486 @item @var{master_bank} The bank that this virtual address refers to.
5487 @end itemize
5488
5489 So in the following example addresses 0xbfc00000 and 0x9fc00000 refer to
5490 the flash bank defined at address 0x1fc00000. Any command executed on
5491 the virtual banks is actually performed on the physical banks.
5492 @example
5493 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pic32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5494 flash bank vbank0 virtual 0xbfc00000 0 0 0 \
5495 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
5496 flash bank vbank1 virtual 0x9fc00000 0 0 0 \
5497 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
5498 @end example
5499 @end deffn
5500
5501 @subsection External Flash
5502
5503 @deffn {Flash Driver} {cfi}
5504 @cindex Common Flash Interface
5505 @cindex CFI
5506 The ``Common Flash Interface'' (CFI) is the main standard for
5507 external NOR flash chips, each of which connects to a
5508 specific external chip select on the CPU.
5509 Frequently the first such chip is used to boot the system.
5510 Your board's @code{reset-init} handler might need to
5511 configure additional chip selects using other commands (like: @command{mww} to
5512 configure a bus and its timings), or
5513 perhaps configure a GPIO pin that controls the ``write protect'' pin
5514 on the flash chip.
5515 The CFI driver can use a target-specific working area to significantly
5516 speed up operation.
5517
5518 The CFI driver can accept the following optional parameters, in any order:
5519
5520 @itemize
5521 @item @var{jedec_probe} ... is used to detect certain non-CFI flash ROMs,
5522 like AM29LV010 and similar types.
5523 @item @var{x16_as_x8} ... when a 16-bit flash is hooked up to an 8-bit bus.
5524 @item @var{bus_swap} ... when data bytes in a 16-bit flash needs to be swapped.
5525 @item @var{data_swap} ... when data bytes in a 16-bit flash needs to be
5526 swapped when writing data values (i.e. not CFI commands).
5527 @end itemize
5528
5529 To configure two adjacent banks of 16 MBytes each, both sixteen bits (two bytes)
5530 wide on a sixteen bit bus:
5531
5532 @example
5533 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
5534 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x01000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
5535 @end example
5536
5537 To configure one bank of 32 MBytes
5538 built from two sixteen bit (two byte) wide parts wired in parallel
5539 to create a thirty-two bit (four byte) bus with doubled throughput:
5540
5541 @example
5542 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x02000000 2 4 $_TARGETNAME
5543 @end example
5544
5545 @c "cfi part_id" disabled
5546 @end deffn
5547
5548 @deffn {Flash Driver} {jtagspi}
5549 @cindex Generic JTAG2SPI driver
5550 @cindex SPI
5551 @cindex jtagspi
5552 @cindex bscan_spi
5553 Several FPGAs and CPLDs can retrieve their configuration (bitstream) from a
5554 SPI flash connected to them. To access this flash from the host, the device
5555 is first programmed with a special proxy bitstream that
5556 exposes the SPI flash on the device's JTAG interface. The flash can then be
5557 accessed through JTAG.
5558
5559 Since signaling between JTAG and SPI is compatible, all that is required for
5560 a proxy bitstream is to connect TDI-MOSI, TDO-MISO, TCK-CLK and activate
5561 the flash chip select when the JTAG state machine is in SHIFT-DR. Such
5562 a bitstream for several Xilinx FPGAs can be found in
5563 @file{contrib/loaders/flash/fpga/xilinx_bscan_spi.py}. It requires
5564 @uref{https://github.com/m-labs/migen, migen} and a Xilinx toolchain to build.
5565
5566 This flash bank driver requires a target on a JTAG tap and will access that
5567 tap directly. Since no support from the target is needed, the target can be a
5568 "testee" dummy. Since the target does not expose the flash memory
5569 mapping, target commands that would otherwise be expected to access the flash
5570 will not work. These include all @command{*_image} and
5571 @command{$target_name m*} commands as well as @command{program}. Equivalent
5572 functionality is available through the @command{flash write_bank},
5573 @command{flash read_bank}, and @command{flash verify_bank} commands.
5574
5575 According to device size, 1- to 4-byte addresses are sent. However, some
5576 flash chips additionally have to be switched to 4-byte addresses by an extra
5577 command, see below.
5578
5579 @itemize
5580 @item @var{ir} ... is loaded into the JTAG IR to map the flash as the JTAG DR.
5581 For the bitstreams generated from @file{xilinx_bscan_spi.py} this is the
5582 @var{USER1} instruction.
5583 @end itemize
5584
5585 @example
5586 target create $_TARGETNAME testee -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.fpga
5587 set _XILINX_USER1 0x02
5588 flash bank $_FLASHNAME spi 0x0 0 0 0 \
5589 $_TARGETNAME $_XILINX_USER1
5590 @end example
5591
5592 @deffn Command {jtagspi set} bank_id name total_size page_size read_cmd unused pprg_cmd mass_erase_cmd sector_size sector_erase_cmd
5593 Sets flash parameters: @var{name} human readable string, @var{total_size}
5594 size in bytes, @var{page_size} is write page size. @var{read_cmd} and @var{pprg_cmd}
5595 are commands for read and page program, respectively. @var{mass_erase_cmd},
5596 @var{sector_size} and @var{sector_erase_cmd} are optional.
5597 @example
5598 jtagspi set 0 w25q128 0x1000000 0x100 0x03 0 0x02 0xC7 0x10000 0xD8
5599 @end example
5600 @end deffn
5601
5602 @deffn Command {jtagspi cmd} bank_id resp_num cmd_byte ...
5603 Sends command @var{cmd_byte} and at most 20 following bytes and reads
5604 @var{resp_num} bytes afterwards. E.g. for 'Enter 4-byte address mode'
5605 @example
5606 jtagspi cmd 0 0 0xB7
5607 @end example
5608 @end deffn
5609
5610 @deffn Command {jtagspi always_4byte} bank_id [ on | off ]
5611 Some devices use 4-byte addresses for all commands except the legacy 0x03 read
5612 regardless of device size. This command controls the corresponding hack.
5613 @end deffn
5614 @end deffn
5615
5616 @deffn {Flash Driver} {xcf}
5617 @cindex Xilinx Platform flash driver
5618 @cindex xcf
5619 Xilinx FPGAs can be configured from specialized flash ICs named Platform Flash.
5620 It is (almost) regular NOR flash with erase sectors, program pages, etc. The
5621 only difference is special registers controlling its FPGA specific behavior.
5622 They must be properly configured for successful FPGA loading using
5623 additional @var{xcf} driver command:
5624
5625 @deffn {Command} {xcf ccb} <bank_id>
5626 command accepts additional parameters:
5627 @itemize
5628 @item @var{external|internal} ... selects clock source.
5629 @item @var{serial|parallel} ... selects serial or parallel data bus mode.
5630 @item @var{slave|master} ... selects slave of master mode for flash device.
5631 @item @var{40|20} ... selects clock frequency in MHz for internal clock
5632 in master mode.
5633 @end itemize
5634 @example
5635 xcf ccb 0 external parallel slave 40
5636 @end example
5637 All of them must be specified even if clock frequency is pointless
5638 in slave mode. If only bank id specified than command prints current
5639 CCB register value. Note: there is no need to write this register
5640 every time you erase/program data sectors because it stores in
5641 dedicated sector.
5642 @end deffn
5643
5644 @deffn {Command} {xcf configure} <bank_id>
5645 Initiates FPGA loading procedure. Useful if your board has no "configure"
5646 button.
5647 @example
5648 xcf configure 0
5649 @end example
5650 @end deffn
5651
5652 Additional driver notes:
5653 @itemize
5654 @item Only single revision supported.
5655 @item Driver automatically detects need of bit reverse, but
5656 only "bin" (raw binary, do not confuse it with "bit") and "mcs"
5657 (Intel hex) file types supported.
5658 @item For additional info check xapp972.pdf and ug380.pdf.
5659 @end itemize
5660 @end deffn
5661
5662 @deffn {Flash Driver} {lpcspifi}
5663 @cindex NXP SPI Flash Interface
5664 @cindex SPIFI
5665 @cindex lpcspifi
5666 NXP's LPC43xx and LPC18xx families include a proprietary SPI
5667 Flash Interface (SPIFI) peripheral that can drive and provide
5668 memory mapped access to external SPI flash devices.
5669
5670 The lpcspifi driver initializes this interface and provides
5671 program and erase functionality for these serial flash devices.
5672 Use of this driver @b{requires} a working area of at least 1kB
5673 to be configured on the target device; more than this will
5674 significantly reduce flash programming times.
5675
5676 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter. All
5677 other parameters are ignored, and the flash size and layout
5678 are configured by the driver.
5679
5680 @example
5681 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpcspifi 0x14000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5682 @end example
5683
5684 @end deffn
5685
5686 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stmsmi}
5687 @cindex STMicroelectronics Serial Memory Interface
5688 @cindex SMI
5689 @cindex stmsmi
5690 Some devices from STMicroelectronics (e.g. STR75x MCU family,
5691 SPEAr MPU family) include a proprietary
5692 ``Serial Memory Interface'' (SMI) controller able to drive external
5693 SPI flash devices.
5694 Depending on specific device and board configuration, up to 4 external
5695 flash devices can be connected.
5696
5697 SMI makes the flash content directly accessible in the CPU address
5698 space; each external device is mapped in a memory bank.
5699 CPU can directly read data, execute code and boot from SMI banks.
5700 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display
5701 the flash content.
5702
5703 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter in order
5704 to identify the memory bank.
5705 All other parameters are ignored. Additional information, like
5706 flash size, are detected automatically.
5707
5708 @example
5709 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmsmi 0xf8000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5710 @end example
5711
5712 @end deffn
5713
5714 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stmqspi}
5715 @cindex STMicroelectronics QuadSPI/OctoSPI Interface
5716 @cindex QuadSPI
5717 @cindex OctoSPI
5718 @cindex stmqspi
5719 Some devices from STMicroelectronics include a proprietary ``QuadSPI Interface''
5720 (e.g. STM32F4, STM32F7, STM32L4) or ``OctoSPI Interface'' (e.g. STM32L4+)
5721 controller able to drive one or even two (dual mode) external SPI flash devices.
5722 The OctoSPI is a superset of QuadSPI, its presence is detected automatically.
5723 Currently only the regular command mode is supported, whereas the HyperFlash
5724 mode is not.
5725
5726 QuadSPI/OctoSPI makes the flash contents directly accessible in the CPU address
5727 space; in case of dual mode both devices must be of the same type and are
5728 mapped in the same memory bank (even and odd addresses interleaved).
5729 CPU can directly read data, execute code (but not boot) from QuadSPI bank.
5730
5731 The 'flash bank' command only requires the @var{base} parameter and the extra
5732 parameter @var{io_base} in order to identify the memory bank. Both are fixed
5733 by hardware, see datasheet or RM. All other parameters are ignored.
5734
5735 The controller must be initialized after each reset and properly configured
5736 for memory-mapped read operation for the particular flash chip(s), for the full
5737 list of available register settings cf. the controller's RM. This setup is quite
5738 board specific (that's why booting from this memory is not possible). The
5739 flash driver infers all parameters from current controller register values when
5740 'flash probe @var{bank_id}' is executed.
5741
5742 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display the flash content,
5743 but only after proper controller initialization as described above. However,
5744 due to a silicon bug in some devices, attempting to access the very last word
5745 should be avoided.
5746
5747 It is possible to use two (even different) flash chips alternatingly, if individual
5748 bank chip selects are available. For some package variants, this is not the case
5749 due to limited pin count. To switch from one to another, adjust FSEL bit accordingly
5750 and re-issue 'flash probe bank_id'. Note that the bank base address will @emph{not}
5751 change, so the address spaces of both devices will overlap. In dual flash mode
5752 both chips must be identical regarding size and most other properties.
5753
5754 Block or sector protection internal to the flash chip is not handled by this
5755 driver at all, but can be dealt with manually by the 'cmd' command, see below.
5756 The sector protection via 'flash protect' command etc. is completely internal to
5757 openocd, intended only to prevent accidental erase or overwrite and it does not
5758 persist across openocd invocations.
5759
5760 OpenOCD contains a hardcoded list of flash devices with their properties,
5761 these are auto-detected. If a device is not included in this list, SFDP discovery
5762 is attempted. If this fails or gives inappropriate results, manual setting is
5763 required (see 'set' command).
5764
5765 @example
5766 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmqspi 0x90000000 0 0 0 \
5767 $_TARGETNAME 0xA0001000
5768 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmqspi 0x70000000 0 0 0 \
5769 $_TARGETNAME 0xA0001400
5770 @end example
5771
5772 There are three specific commands
5773 @deffn {Command} {stmqspi mass_erase} bank_id
5774 Clears sector protections and performs a mass erase. Works only if there is no
5775 chip specific write protection engaged.
5776 @end deffn
5777
5778 @deffn {Command} {stmqspi set} bank_id name total_size page_size read_cmd fread_cmd pprg_cmd mass_erase_cmd sector_size sector_erase_cmd
5779 Set flash parameters: @var{name} human readable string, @var{total_size} size
5780 in bytes, @var{page_size} is write page size. @var{read_cmd}, @var{fread_cmd} and @var{pprg_cmd}
5781 are commands for reading and page programming. @var{fread_cmd} is used in DPI and QPI modes,
5782 @var{read_cmd} in normal SPI (single line) mode. @var{mass_erase_cmd}, @var{sector_size}
5783 and @var{sector_erase_cmd} are optional.
5784
5785 This command is required if chip id is not hardcoded yet and e.g. for EEPROMs or FRAMs
5786 which don't support an id command.
5787
5788 In dual mode parameters of both chips are set identically. The parameters refer to
5789 a single chip, so the whole bank gets twice the specified capacity etc.
5790 @end deffn
5791
5792 @deffn {Command} {stmqspi cmd} bank_id resp_num cmd_byte ...
5793 If @var{resp_num} is zero, sends command @var{cmd_byte} and following data
5794 bytes. In dual mode command byte is sent to @emph{both} chips but data bytes are
5795 sent @emph{alternatingly} to chip 1 and 2, first to flash 1, second to flash 2, etc.,
5796 i.e. the total number of bytes (including cmd_byte) must be odd.
5797
5798 If @var{resp_num} is not zero, cmd and at most four following data bytes are
5799 sent, in dual mode @emph{simultaneously} to both chips. Then @var{resp_num} bytes
5800 are read interleaved from both chips starting with chip 1. In this case
5801 @var{resp_num} must be even.
5802
5803 Note the hardware dictated subtle difference of those two cases in dual-flash mode.
5804
5805 To check basic communication settings, issue
5806 @example
5807 stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x04; stmqspi cmd bank_id 1 0x05
5808 stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x06; stmqspi cmd bank_id 1 0x05
5809 @end example
5810 for single flash mode or
5811 @example
5812 stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x04; stmqspi cmd bank_id 2 0x05
5813 stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x06; stmqspi cmd bank_id 2 0x05
5814 @end example
5815 for dual flash mode. This should return the status register contents.
5816
5817 In 8-line mode, @var{cmd_byte} is sent twice - first time as given, second time
5818 complemented. Additionally, in 8-line mode only, some commands (e.g. Read Status)
5819 need a dummy address, e.g.
5820 @example
5821 stmqspi cmd bank_id 1 0x05 0x00 0x00 0x00 0x00
5822 @end example
5823 should return the status register contents.
5824
5825 @end deffn
5826
5827 @end deffn
5828
5829 @deffn {Flash Driver} {mrvlqspi}
5830 This driver supports QSPI flash controller of Marvell's Wireless
5831 Microcontroller platform.
5832
5833 The flash size is autodetected based on the table of known JEDEC IDs
5834 hardcoded in the OpenOCD sources.
5835
5836 @example
5837 flash bank $_FLASHNAME mrvlqspi 0x0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0x46010000
5838 @end example
5839
5840 @end deffn
5841
5842 @deffn {Flash Driver} {ath79}
5843 @cindex Atheros ath79 SPI driver
5844 @cindex ath79
5845 Members of ATH79 SoC family from Atheros include a SPI interface with 3
5846 chip selects.
5847 On reset a SPI flash connected to the first chip select (CS0) is made
5848 directly read-accessible in the CPU address space (up to 16MBytes)
5849 and is usually used to store the bootloader and operating system.
5850 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display
5851 the flash content while it is in memory-mapped mode (only the first
5852 4MBytes are accessible without additional configuration on reset).
5853
5854 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter in order
5855 to identify the memory bank. The actual value for the base address
5856 is not otherwise used by the driver. However the mapping is passed
5857 to gdb. Thus for the memory mapped flash (chipselect CS0) the base
5858 address should be the actual memory mapped base address. For unmapped
5859 chipselects (CS1 and CS2) care should be taken to use a base address
5860 that does not overlap with real memory regions.
5861 Additional information, like flash size, are detected automatically.
5862 An optional additional parameter sets the chipselect for the bank,
5863 with the default CS0.
5864 CS1 and CS2 require additional GPIO setup before they can be used
5865 since the alternate function must be enabled on the GPIO pin
5866 CS1/CS2 is routed to on the given SoC.
5867
5868 @example
5869 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ath79 0xbf000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5870
5871 # When using multiple chipselects the base should be different
5872 # for each, otherwise the write_image command is not able to
5873 # distinguish the banks.
5874 flash bank flash0 ath79 0xbf000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs0
5875 flash bank flash1 ath79 0x10000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs1
5876 flash bank flash2 ath79 0x20000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs2
5877 @end example
5878
5879 @end deffn
5880
5881 @deffn {Flash Driver} {fespi}
5882 @cindex Freedom E SPI
5883 @cindex fespi
5884
5885 SiFive's Freedom E SPI controller, used in HiFive and other boards.
5886
5887 @example
5888 flash bank $_FLASHNAME fespi 0x20000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5889 @end example
5890 @end deffn
5891
5892 @subsection Internal Flash (Microcontrollers)
5893
5894 @deffn {Flash Driver} {aduc702x}
5895 The ADUC702x analog microcontrollers from Analog Devices
5896 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
5897 The aduc702x flash driver works with models ADUC7019 through ADUC7028.
5898 The setup command only requires the @var{target} argument
5899 since all devices in this family have the same memory layout.
5900
5901 @example
5902 flash bank $_FLASHNAME aduc702x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5903 @end example
5904 @end deffn
5905
5906 @deffn {Flash Driver} {ambiqmicro}
5907 @cindex ambiqmicro
5908 @cindex apollo
5909 All members of the Apollo microcontroller family from
5910 Ambiq Micro include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5911 The host connects over USB to an FTDI interface that communicates
5912 with the target using SWD.
5913
5914 The @var{ambiqmicro} driver reads the Chip Information Register detect
5915 the device class of the MCU.
5916 The Flash and SRAM sizes directly follow device class, and are used
5917 to set up the flash banks.
5918 If this fails, the driver will use default values set to the minimum
5919 sizes of an Apollo chip.
5920
5921 All Apollo chips have two flash banks of the same size.
5922 In all cases the first flash bank starts at location 0,
5923 and the second bank starts after the first.
5924
5925 @example
5926 # Flash bank 0
5927 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ambiqmicro 0 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5928 # Flash bank 1 - same size as bank0, starts after bank 0.
5929 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ambiqmicro 0x00040000 0x00040000 0 0 \
5930 $_TARGETNAME
5931 @end example
5932
5933 Flash is programmed using custom entry points into the bootloader.
5934 This is the only way to program the flash as no flash control registers
5935 are available to the user.
5936
5937 The @var{ambiqmicro} driver adds some additional commands:
5938
5939 @deffn {Command} {ambiqmicro mass_erase} <bank>
5940 Erase entire bank.
5941 @end deffn
5942 @deffn {Command} {ambiqmicro page_erase} <bank> <first> <last>
5943 Erase device pages.
5944 @end deffn
5945 @deffn {Command} {ambiqmicro program_otp} <bank> <offset> <count>
5946 Program OTP is a one time operation to create write protected flash.
5947 The user writes sectors to SRAM starting at 0x10000010.
5948 Program OTP will write these sectors from SRAM to flash, and write protect
5949 the flash.
5950 @end deffn
5951 @end deffn
5952
5953 @anchor{at91samd}
5954 @deffn {Flash Driver} {at91samd}
5955 @cindex at91samd
5956 All members of the ATSAM D2x, D1x, D0x, ATSAMR, ATSAML and ATSAMC microcontroller
5957 families from Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M0+ core.
5958
5959 Do not use for ATSAM D51 and E5x: use @xref{atsame5}.
5960
5961 The devices have one flash bank:
5962
5963 @example
5964 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91samd 0x00000000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
5965 @end example
5966
5967 @deffn {Command} {at91samd chip-erase}
5968 Issues a complete Flash erase via the Device Service Unit (DSU). This can be
5969 used to erase a chip back to its factory state and does not require the
5970 processor to be halted.
5971 @end deffn
5972
5973 @deffn {Command} {at91samd set-security}
5974 Secures the Flash via the Set Security Bit (SSB) command. This prevents access
5975 to the Flash and can only be undone by using the chip-erase command which
5976 erases the Flash contents and turns off the security bit. Warning: at this
5977 time, openocd will not be able to communicate with a secured chip and it is
5978 therefore not possible to chip-erase it without using another tool.
5979
5980 @example
5981 at91samd set-security enable
5982 @end example
5983 @end deffn
5984
5985 @deffn {Command} {at91samd eeprom}
5986 Shows or sets the EEPROM emulation size configuration, stored in the User Row
5987 of the Flash. When setting, the EEPROM size must be specified in bytes and it
5988 must be one of the permitted sizes according to the datasheet. Settings are
5989 written immediately but only take effect on MCU reset. EEPROM emulation
5990 requires additional firmware support and the minimum EEPROM size may not be
5991 the same as the minimum that the hardware supports. Set the EEPROM size to 0
5992 in order to disable this feature.
5993
5994 @example
5995 at91samd eeprom
5996 at91samd eeprom 1024
5997 @end example
5998 @end deffn
5999
6000 @deffn {Command} {at91samd bootloader}
6001 Shows or sets the bootloader size configuration, stored in the User Row of the
6002 Flash. This is called the BOOTPROT region. When setting, the bootloader size
6003 must be specified in bytes and it must be one of the permitted sizes according
6004 to the datasheet. Settings are written immediately but only take effect on
6005 MCU reset. Setting the bootloader size to 0 disables bootloader protection.
6006
6007 @example
6008 at91samd bootloader
6009 at91samd bootloader 16384
6010 @end example
6011 @end deffn
6012
6013 @deffn {Command} {at91samd dsu_reset_deassert}
6014 This command releases internal reset held by DSU
6015 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
6016 Command is used internally in event reset-deassert-post.
6017 @end deffn
6018
6019 @deffn {Command} {at91samd nvmuserrow}
6020 Writes or reads the entire 64 bit wide NVM user row register which is located at
6021 0x804000. This register includes various fuses lock-bits and factory calibration
6022 data. Reading the register is done by invoking this command without any
6023 arguments. Writing is possible by giving 1 or 2 hex values. The first argument
6024 is the register value to be written and the second one is an optional changemask.
6025 Every bit which value in changemask is 0 will stay unchanged. The lock- and
6026 reserved-bits are masked out and cannot be changed.
6027
6028 @example
6029 # Read user row
6030 >at91samd nvmuserrow
6031 NVMUSERROW: 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788
6032 # Write 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788 to user row
6033 >at91samd nvmuserrow 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788
6034 # Write 0x12300 to user row but leave other bits and low
6035 # byte unchanged
6036 >at91samd nvmuserrow 0x12345 0xFFF00
6037 @end example
6038 @end deffn
6039
6040 @end deffn
6041
6042 @anchor{at91sam3}
6043 @deffn {Flash Driver} {at91sam3}
6044 @cindex at91sam3
6045 All members of the AT91SAM3 microcontroller family from
6046 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M3 core. The driver
6047 currently (6/22/09) recognizes the AT91SAM3U[1/2/4][C/E] chips. Note
6048 that the driver was orginaly developed and tested using the
6049 AT91SAM3U4E, using a SAM3U-EK eval board. Support for other chips in
6050 the family was cribbed from the data sheet. @emph{Note to future
6051 readers/updaters: Please remove this worrisome comment after other
6052 chips are confirmed.}
6053
6054 The AT91SAM3U4[E/C] (256K) chips have two flash banks; most other chips
6055 have one flash bank. In all cases the flash banks are at
6056 the following fixed locations:
6057
6058 @example
6059 # Flash bank 0 - all chips
6060 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00080000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
6061 # Flash bank 1 - only 256K chips
6062 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00100000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
6063 @end example
6064
6065 Internally, the AT91SAM3 flash memory is organized as follows.
6066 Unlike the AT91SAM7 chips, these are not used as parameters
6067 to the @command{flash bank} command:
6068
6069 @itemize
6070 @item @emph{N-Banks:} 256K chips have 2 banks, others have 1 bank.
6071 @item @emph{Bank Size:} 128K/64K Per flash bank
6072 @item @emph{Sectors:} 16 or 8 per bank
6073 @item @emph{SectorSize:} 8K Per Sector
6074 @item @emph{PageSize:} 256 bytes per page. Note that OpenOCD operates on 'sector' sizes, not page sizes.
6075 @end itemize
6076
6077 The AT91SAM3 driver adds some additional commands:
6078
6079 @deffn {Command} {at91sam3 gpnvm}
6080 @deffnx {Command} {at91sam3 gpnvm clear} number
6081 @deffnx {Command} {at91sam3 gpnvm set} number
6082 @deffnx {Command} {at91sam3 gpnvm show} [@option{all}|number]
6083 With no parameters, @command{show} or @command{show all},
6084 shows the status of all GPNVM bits.
6085 With @command{show} @var{number}, displays that bit.
6086
6087 With @command{set} @var{number} or @command{clear} @var{number},
6088 modifies that GPNVM bit.
6089 @end deffn
6090
6091 @deffn {Command} {at91sam3 info}
6092 This command attempts to display information about the AT91SAM3
6093 chip. @emph{First} it read the @code{CHIPID_CIDR} [address 0x400e0740, see
6094 Section 28.2.1, page 505 of the AT91SAM3U 29/may/2009 datasheet,
6095 document id: doc6430A] and decodes the values. @emph{Second} it reads the
6096 various clock configuration registers and attempts to display how it
6097 believes the chip is configured. By default, the SLOWCLK is assumed to
6098 be 32768 Hz, see the command @command{at91sam3 slowclk}.
6099 @end deffn
6100
6101 @deffn {Command} {at91sam3 slowclk} [value]
6102 This command shows/sets the slow clock frequency used in the
6103 @command{at91sam3 info} command calculations above.
6104 @end deffn
6105 @end deffn
6106
6107 @deffn {Flash Driver} {at91sam4}
6108 @cindex at91sam4
6109 All members of the AT91SAM4 microcontroller family from
6110 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
6111 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
6112 @end deffn
6113
6114 @deffn {Flash Driver} {at91sam4l}
6115 @cindex at91sam4l
6116 All members of the AT91SAM4L microcontroller family from
6117 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
6118 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
6119
6120 The AT91SAM4L driver adds some additional commands:
6121 @deffn {Command} {at91sam4l smap_reset_deassert}
6122 This command releases internal reset held by SMAP
6123 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
6124 Command is used internally in event reset-deassert-post.
6125 @end deffn
6126 @end deffn
6127
6128 @anchor{atsame5}
6129 @deffn {Flash Driver} {atsame5}
6130 @cindex atsame5
6131 All members of the SAM E54, E53, E51 and D51 microcontroller
6132 families from Microchip (former Atmel) include internal flash
6133 and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
6134
6135 The devices have two ECC flash banks with a swapping feature.
6136 This driver handles both banks together as it were one.
6137 Bank swapping is not supported yet.
6138
6139 @example
6140 flash bank $_FLASHNAME atsame5 0x00000000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
6141 @end example
6142
6143 @deffn {Command} {atsame5 bootloader}
6144 Shows or sets the bootloader size configuration, stored in the User Page of the
6145 Flash. This is called the BOOTPROT region. When setting, the bootloader size
6146 must be specified in bytes. The nearest bigger protection size is used.
6147 Settings are written immediately but only take effect on MCU reset.
6148 Setting the bootloader size to 0 disables bootloader protection.
6149
6150 @example
6151 atsame5 bootloader
6152 atsame5 bootloader 16384
6153 @end example
6154 @end deffn
6155
6156 @deffn {Command} {atsame5 chip-erase}
6157 Issues a complete Flash erase via the Device Service Unit (DSU). This can be
6158 used to erase a chip back to its factory state and does not require the
6159 processor to be halted.
6160 @end deffn
6161
6162 @deffn {Command} {atsame5 dsu_reset_deassert}
6163 This command releases internal reset held by DSU
6164 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
6165 Command is used internally in event reset-deassert-post.
6166 @end deffn
6167
6168 @deffn {Command} {atsame5 userpage}
6169 Writes or reads the first 64 bits of NVM User Page which is located at
6170 0x804000. This field includes various fuses.
6171 Reading is done by invoking this command without any arguments.
6172 Writing is possible by giving 1 or 2 hex values. The first argument
6173 is the value to be written and the second one is an optional bit mask
6174 (a zero bit in the mask means the bit stays unchanged).
6175 The reserved fields are always masked out and cannot be changed.
6176
6177 @example
6178 # Read
6179 >atsame5 userpage
6180 USER PAGE: 0xAEECFF80FE9A9239
6181 # Write
6182 >atsame5 userpage 0xAEECFF80FE9A9239
6183 # Write 2 to SEESBLK and 4 to SEEPSZ fields but leave other
6184 # bits unchanged (setup SmartEEPROM of virtual size 8192
6185 # bytes)
6186 >atsame5 userpage 0x4200000000 0x7f00000000
6187 @end example
6188 @end deffn
6189
6190 @end deffn
6191
6192 @deffn {Flash Driver} {atsamv}
6193 @cindex atsamv
6194 All members of the ATSAMV7x, ATSAMS70, and ATSAME70 families from
6195 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M7 core.
6196 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
6197
6198 @example
6199 flash bank $_FLASHNAME atsamv 0x00400000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6200 @end example
6201
6202 @deffn {Command} {atsamv gpnvm} [@option{show} [@option{all}|number]]
6203 @deffnx {Command} {atsamv gpnvm} (@option{clr}|@option{set}) number
6204 With no parameters, @option{show} or @option{show all},
6205 shows the status of all GPNVM bits.
6206 With @option{show} @var{number}, displays that bit.
6207
6208 With @option{set} @var{number} or @option{clear} @var{number},
6209 modifies that GPNVM bit.
6210 @end deffn
6211
6212 @end deffn
6213
6214 @deffn {Flash Driver} {at91sam7}
6215 All members of the AT91SAM7 microcontroller family from Atmel include
6216 internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores. The driver automatically
6217 recognizes a number of these chips using the chip identification
6218 register, and autoconfigures itself.
6219
6220 @example
6221 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam7 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6222 @end example
6223
6224 For chips which are not recognized by the controller driver, you must
6225 provide additional parameters in the following order:
6226
6227 @itemize
6228 @item @var{chip_model} ... label used with @command{flash info}
6229 @item @var{banks}
6230 @item @var{sectors_per_bank}
6231 @item @var{pages_per_sector}
6232 @item @var{pages_size}
6233 @item @var{num_nvm_bits}
6234 @item @var{freq_khz} ... required if an external clock is provided,
6235 optional (but recommended) when the oscillator frequency is known
6236 @end itemize
6237
6238 It is recommended that you provide zeroes for all of those values
6239 except the clock frequency, so that everything except that frequency
6240 will be autoconfigured.
6241 Knowing the frequency helps ensure correct timings for flash access.
6242
6243 The flash controller handles erases automatically on a page (128/256 byte)
6244 basis, so explicit erase commands are not necessary for flash programming.
6245 However, there is an ``EraseAll`` command that can erase an entire flash
6246 plane (of up to 256KB), and it will be used automatically when you issue
6247 @command{flash erase_sector} or @command{flash erase_address} commands.
6248
6249 @deffn {Command} {at91sam7 gpnvm} bitnum (@option{set}|@option{clear})
6250 Set or clear a ``General Purpose Non-Volatile Memory'' (GPNVM)
6251 bit for the processor. Each processor has a number of such bits,
6252 used for controlling features such as brownout detection (so they
6253 are not truly general purpose).
6254 @quotation Note
6255 This assumes that the first flash bank (number 0) is associated with
6256 the appropriate at91sam7 target.
6257 @end quotation
6258 @end deffn
6259 @end deffn
6260
6261 @deffn {Flash Driver} {avr}
6262 The AVR 8-bit microcontrollers from Atmel integrate flash memory.
6263 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete.}
6264 @comment - defines mass_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
6265 @end deffn
6266
6267 @deffn {Flash Driver} {bluenrg-x}
6268 STMicroelectronics BlueNRG-1, BlueNRG-2 and BlueNRG-LP Bluetooth low energy wireless system-on-chip. They include ARM Cortex-M0/M0+ core and internal flash memory.
6269 The driver automatically recognizes these chips using
6270 the chip identification registers, and autoconfigures itself.
6271
6272 @example
6273 flash bank $_FLASHNAME bluenrg-x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6274 @end example
6275
6276 Note that when users ask to erase all the sectors of the flash, a mass erase command is used which is faster than erasing
6277 each single sector one by one.
6278
6279 @example
6280 flash erase_sector 0 0 last # It will perform a mass erase
6281 @end example
6282
6283 Triggering a mass erase is also useful when users want to disable readout protection.
6284 @end deffn
6285
6286 @deffn {Flash Driver} {cc26xx}
6287 All versions of the SimpleLink CC13xx and CC26xx microcontrollers from Texas
6288 Instruments include internal flash. The cc26xx flash driver supports both the
6289 CC13xx and CC26xx family of devices. The driver automatically recognizes the
6290 specific version's flash parameters and autoconfigures itself. The flash bank
6291 starts at address 0.
6292
6293 @example
6294 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cc26xx 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6295 @end example
6296 @end deffn
6297
6298 @deffn {Flash Driver} {cc3220sf}
6299 The CC3220SF version of the SimpleLink CC32xx microcontrollers from Texas
6300 Instruments includes 1MB of internal flash. The cc3220sf flash driver only
6301 supports the internal flash. The serial flash on SimpleLink boards is
6302 programmed via the bootloader over a UART connection. Security features of
6303 the CC3220SF may erase the internal flash during power on reset. Refer to
6304 documentation at @url{www.ti.com/cc3220sf} for details on security features
6305 and programming the serial flash.
6306
6307 @example
6308 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cc3220sf 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6309 @end example
6310 @end deffn
6311
6312 @deffn {Flash Driver} {efm32}
6313 All members of the EFM32 microcontroller family from Energy Micro include
6314 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores. The driver automatically recognizes
6315 a number of these chips using the chip identification register, and
6316 autoconfigures itself.
6317 @example
6318 flash bank $_FLASHNAME efm32 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6319 @end example
6320 A special feature of efm32 controllers is that it is possible to completely disable the
6321 debug interface by writing the correct values to the 'Debug Lock Word'. OpenOCD supports
6322 this via the following command:
6323 @example
6324 efm32 debuglock num
6325 @end example
6326 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6327 Note that in order for this command to take effect, the target needs to be reset.
6328 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete. Unprotecting flash pages is not
6329 supported.}
6330 @end deffn
6331
6332 @deffn {Flash Driver} {esirisc}
6333 Members of the eSi-RISC family may optionally include internal flash programmed
6334 via the eSi-TSMC Flash interface. Additional parameters are required to
6335 configure the driver: @option{cfg_address} is the base address of the
6336 configuration register interface, @option{clock_hz} is the expected clock
6337 frequency, and @option{wait_states} is the number of configured read wait states.
6338
6339 @example
6340 flash bank $_FLASHNAME esirisc base_address size_bytes 0 0 \
6341 $_TARGETNAME cfg_address clock_hz wait_states
6342 @end example
6343
6344 @deffn {Command} {esirisc flash mass_erase} bank_id
6345 Erase all pages in data memory for the bank identified by @option{bank_id}.
6346 @end deffn
6347
6348 @deffn {Command} {esirisc flash ref_erase} bank_id
6349 Erase the reference cell for the bank identified by @option{bank_id}. @emph{This
6350 is an uncommon operation.}
6351 @end deffn
6352 @end deffn
6353
6354 @deffn {Flash Driver} {fm3}
6355 All members of the FM3 microcontroller family from Fujitsu
6356 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6357 The @var{fm3} driver uses the @var{target} parameter to select the
6358 correct bank config, it can currently be one of the following:
6359 @code{mb9bfxx1.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx2.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx3.cpu},
6360 @code{mb9bfxx4.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx5.cpu} or @code{mb9bfxx6.cpu}.
6361
6362 @example
6363 flash bank $_FLASHNAME fm3 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6364 @end example
6365 @end deffn
6366
6367 @deffn {Flash Driver} {fm4}
6368 All members of the FM4 microcontroller family from Spansion (formerly Fujitsu)
6369 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M4 cores.
6370 The @var{fm4} driver uses a @var{family} parameter to select the
6371 correct bank config, it can currently be one of the following:
6372 @code{MB9BFx64}, @code{MB9BFx65}, @code{MB9BFx66}, @code{MB9BFx67}, @code{MB9BFx68},
6373 @code{S6E2Cx8}, @code{S6E2Cx9}, @code{S6E2CxA} or @code{S6E2Dx},
6374 with @code{x} treated as wildcard and otherwise case (and any trailing
6375 characters) ignored.
6376
6377 @example
6378 flash bank $@{_FLASHNAME@}0 fm4 0x00000000 0 0 0 \
6379 $_TARGETNAME S6E2CCAJ0A
6380 flash bank $@{_FLASHNAME@}1 fm4 0x00100000 0 0 0 \
6381 $_TARGETNAME S6E2CCAJ0A
6382 @end example
6383 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete. Protection is not supported,
6384 nor is Chip Erase (only Sector Erase is implemented).}
6385 @end deffn
6386
6387 @deffn {Flash Driver} {kinetis}
6388 @cindex kinetis
6389 Kx, KLx, KVx and KE1x members of the Kinetis microcontroller family
6390 from NXP (former Freescale) include
6391 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0+ or M4 cores. The driver automatically
6392 recognizes flash size and a number of flash banks (1-4) using the chip
6393 identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6394 Use kinetis_ke driver for KE0x and KEAx devices.
6395
6396 The @var{kinetis} driver defines option:
6397 @itemize
6398 @item -sim-base @var{addr} ... base of System Integration Module where chip identification resides. Driver tries two known locations if option is omitted.
6399 @end itemize
6400
6401 @example
6402 flash bank $_FLASHNAME kinetis 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6403 @end example
6404
6405 @deffn {Config Command} {kinetis create_banks}
6406 Configuration command enables automatic creation of additional flash banks
6407 based on real flash layout of device. Banks are created during device probe.
6408 Use 'flash probe 0' to force probe.
6409 @end deffn
6410
6411 @deffn {Command} {kinetis fcf_source} [protection|write]
6412 Select what source is used when writing to a Flash Configuration Field.
6413 @option{protection} mode builds FCF content from protection bits previously
6414 set by 'flash protect' command.
6415 This mode is default. MCU is protected from unwanted locking by immediate
6416 writing FCF after erase of relevant sector.
6417 @option{write} mode enables direct write to FCF.
6418 Protection cannot be set by 'flash protect' command. FCF is written along
6419 with the rest of a flash image.
6420 @emph{BEWARE: Incorrect flash configuration may permanently lock the device!}
6421 @end deffn
6422
6423 @deffn {Command} {kinetis fopt} [num]
6424 Set value to write to FOPT byte of Flash Configuration Field.
6425 Used in kinetis 'fcf_source protection' mode only.
6426 @end deffn
6427
6428 @deffn {Command} {kinetis mdm check_security}
6429 Checks status of device security lock. Used internally in examine-end
6430 and examine-fail event.
6431 @end deffn
6432
6433 @deffn {Command} {kinetis mdm halt}
6434 Issues a halt via the MDM-AP. This command can be used to break a watchdog reset
6435 loop when connecting to an unsecured target.
6436 @end deffn
6437
6438 @deffn {Command} {kinetis mdm mass_erase}
6439 Issues a complete flash erase via the MDM-AP. This can be used to erase a chip
6440 back to its factory state, removing security. It does not require the processor
6441 to be halted, however the target will remain in a halted state after this
6442 command completes.
6443 @end deffn
6444
6445 @deffn {Command} {kinetis nvm_partition}
6446 For FlexNVM devices only (KxxDX and KxxFX).
6447 Command shows or sets data flash or EEPROM backup size in kilobytes,
6448 sets two EEPROM blocks sizes in bytes and enables/disables loading
6449 of EEPROM contents to FlexRAM during reset.
6450
6451 For details see device reference manual, Flash Memory Module,
6452 Program Partition command.
6453
6454 Setting is possible only once after mass_erase.
6455 Reset the device after partition setting.
6456
6457 Show partition size:
6458 @example
6459 kinetis nvm_partition info
6460 @end example
6461
6462 Set 32 KB data flash, rest of FlexNVM is EEPROM backup. EEPROM has two blocks
6463 of 512 and 1536 bytes and its contents is loaded to FlexRAM during reset:
6464 @example
6465 kinetis nvm_partition dataflash 32 512 1536 on
6466 @end example
6467
6468 Set 16 KB EEPROM backup, rest of FlexNVM is a data flash. EEPROM has two blocks
6469 of 1024 bytes and its contents is not loaded to FlexRAM during reset:
6470 @example
6471 kinetis nvm_partition eebkp 16 1024 1024 off
6472 @end example
6473 @end deffn
6474
6475 @deffn {Command} {kinetis mdm reset}
6476 Issues a reset via the MDM-AP. This causes the MCU to output a low pulse on the
6477 RESET pin, which can be used to reset other hardware on board.
6478 @end deffn
6479
6480 @deffn {Command} {kinetis disable_wdog}
6481 For Kx devices only (KLx has different COP watchdog, it is not supported).
6482 Command disables watchdog timer.
6483 @end deffn
6484 @end deffn
6485
6486 @deffn {Flash Driver} {kinetis_ke}
6487 @cindex kinetis_ke
6488 KE0x and KEAx members of the Kinetis microcontroller family from NXP include
6489 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0+. The driver automatically recognizes
6490 the KE0x sub-family using the chip identification register, and
6491 autoconfigures itself.
6492 Use kinetis (not kinetis_ke) driver for KE1x devices.
6493
6494 @example
6495 flash bank $_FLASHNAME kinetis_ke 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6496 @end example
6497
6498 @deffn {Command} {kinetis_ke mdm check_security}
6499 Checks status of device security lock. Used internally in examine-end event.
6500 @end deffn
6501
6502 @deffn {Command} {kinetis_ke mdm mass_erase}
6503 Issues a complete Flash erase via the MDM-AP.
6504 This can be used to erase a chip back to its factory state.
6505 Command removes security lock from a device (use of SRST highly recommended).
6506 It does not require the processor to be halted.
6507 @end deffn
6508
6509 @deffn {Command} {kinetis_ke disable_wdog}
6510 Command disables watchdog timer.
6511 @end deffn
6512 @end deffn
6513
6514 @deffn {Flash Driver} {lpc2000}
6515 This is the driver to support internal flash of all members of the
6516 LPC11(x)00 and LPC1300 microcontroller families and most members of
6517 the LPC800, LPC1500, LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4000, LPC54100,
6518 LPC8Nxx and NHS31xx microcontroller families from NXP.
6519
6520 @quotation Note
6521 There are LPC2000 devices which are not supported by the @var{lpc2000}
6522 driver:
6523 The LPC2888 is supported by the @var{lpc288x} driver.
6524 The LPC29xx family is supported by the @var{lpc2900} driver.
6525 @end quotation
6526
6527 The @var{lpc2000} driver defines two mandatory and two optional parameters,
6528 which must appear in the following order:
6529
6530 @itemize
6531 @item @var{variant} ... required, may be
6532 @option{lpc2000_v1} (older LPC21xx and LPC22xx)
6533 @option{lpc2000_v2} (LPC213x, LPC214x, LPC210[123], LPC23xx and LPC24xx)
6534 @option{lpc1700} (LPC175x and LPC176x and LPC177x/8x)
6535 @option{lpc4300} - available also as @option{lpc1800} alias (LPC18x[2357] and
6536 LPC43x[2357])
6537 @option{lpc800} (LPC8xx)
6538 @option{lpc1100} (LPC11(x)xx and LPC13xx)
6539 @option{lpc1500} (LPC15xx)
6540 @option{lpc54100} (LPC541xx)
6541 @option{lpc4000} (LPC40xx)
6542 or @option{auto} - automatically detects flash variant and size for LPC11(x)00,
6543 LPC8xx, LPC13xx, LPC17xx, LPC40xx, LPC8Nxx and NHS31xx
6544 @item @var{clock_kHz} ... the frequency, in kiloHertz,
6545 at which the core is running
6546 @item @option{calc_checksum} ... optional (but you probably want to provide this!),
6547 telling the driver to calculate a valid checksum for the exception vector table.
6548 @quotation Note
6549 If you don't provide @option{calc_checksum} when you're writing the vector
6550 table, the boot ROM will almost certainly ignore your flash image.
6551 However, if you do provide it,
6552 with most tool chains @command{verify_image} will fail.
6553 @end quotation
6554 @item @option{iap_entry} ... optional telling the driver to use a different
6555 ROM IAP entry point.
6556 @end itemize
6557
6558 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
6559
6560 @example
6561 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000 0x0 0x7d000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME \
6562 lpc2000_v2 14765 calc_checksum
6563 @end example
6564
6565 @deffn {Command} {lpc2000 part_id} bank
6566 Displays the four byte part identifier associated with
6567 the specified flash @var{bank}.
6568 @end deffn
6569 @end deffn
6570
6571 @deffn {Flash Driver} {lpc288x}
6572 The LPC2888 microcontroller from NXP needs slightly different flash
6573 support from its lpc2000 siblings.
6574 The @var{lpc288x} driver defines one mandatory parameter,
6575 the programming clock rate in Hz.
6576 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
6577
6578 @example
6579 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc288x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 12000000
6580 @end example
6581 @end deffn
6582
6583 @deffn {Flash Driver} {lpc2900}
6584 This driver supports the LPC29xx ARM968E based microcontroller family
6585 from NXP.
6586
6587 The predefined parameters @var{base}, @var{size}, @var{chip_width} and
6588 @var{bus_width} of the @code{flash bank} command are ignored. Flash size and
6589 sector layout are auto-configured by the driver.
6590 The driver has one additional mandatory parameter: The CPU clock rate
6591 (in kHz) at the time the flash operations will take place. Most of the time this
6592 will not be the crystal frequency, but a higher PLL frequency. The
6593 @code{reset-init} event handler in the board script is usually the place where
6594 you start the PLL.
6595
6596 The driver rejects flashless devices (currently the LPC2930).
6597
6598 The EEPROM in LPC2900 devices is not mapped directly into the address space.
6599 It must be handled much more like NAND flash memory, and will therefore be
6600 handled by a separate @code{lpc2900_eeprom} driver (not yet available).
6601
6602 Sector protection in terms of the LPC2900 is handled transparently. Every time a
6603 sector needs to be erased or programmed, it is automatically unprotected.
6604 What is shown as protection status in the @code{flash info} command, is
6605 actually the LPC2900 @emph{sector security}. This is a mechanism to prevent a
6606 sector from ever being erased or programmed again. As this is an irreversible
6607 mechanism, it is handled by a special command (@code{lpc2900 secure_sector}),
6608 and not by the standard @code{flash protect} command.
6609
6610 Example for a 125 MHz clock frequency:
6611 @example
6612 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2900 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 125000
6613 @end example
6614
6615 Some @code{lpc2900}-specific commands are defined. In the following command list,
6616 the @var{bank} parameter is the bank number as obtained by the
6617 @code{flash banks} command.
6618
6619 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 signature} bank
6620 Calculates a 128-bit hash value, the @emph{signature}, from the whole flash
6621 content. This is a hardware feature of the flash block, hence the calculation is
6622 very fast. You may use this to verify the content of a programmed device against
6623 a known signature.
6624 Example:
6625 @example
6626 lpc2900 signature 0
6627 signature: 0x5f40cdc8:0xc64e592e:0x10490f89:0x32a0f317
6628 @end example
6629 @end deffn
6630
6631 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 read_custom} bank filename
6632 Reads the 912 bytes of customer information from the flash index sector, and
6633 saves it to a file in binary format.
6634 Example:
6635 @example
6636 lpc2900 read_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin
6637 @end example
6638 @end deffn
6639
6640 The index sector of the flash is a @emph{write-only} sector. It cannot be
6641 erased! In order to guard against unintentional write access, all following
6642 commands need to be preceded by a successful call to the @code{password}
6643 command:
6644
6645 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 password} bank password
6646 You need to use this command right before each of the following commands:
6647 @code{lpc2900 write_custom}, @code{lpc2900 secure_sector},
6648 @code{lpc2900 secure_jtag}.
6649
6650 The password string is fixed to "I_know_what_I_am_doing".
6651 Example:
6652 @example
6653 lpc2900 password 0 I_know_what_I_am_doing
6654 Potentially dangerous operation allowed in next command!
6655 @end example
6656 @end deffn
6657
6658 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 write_custom} bank filename type
6659 Writes the content of the file into the customer info space of the flash index
6660 sector. The filetype can be specified with the @var{type} field. Possible values
6661 for @var{type} are: @var{bin} (binary), @var{ihex} (Intel hex format),
6662 @var{elf} (ELF binary) or @var{s19} (Motorola S-records). The file must
6663 contain a single section, and the contained data length must be exactly
6664 912 bytes.
6665 @quotation Attention
6666 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
6667 @end quotation
6668 Example:
6669 @example
6670 lpc2900 write_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin bin
6671 @end example
6672 @end deffn
6673
6674 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 secure_sector} bank first last
6675 Secures the sector range from @var{first} to @var{last} (including) against
6676 further program and erase operations. The sector security will be effective
6677 after the next power cycle.
6678 @quotation Attention
6679 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
6680 @end quotation
6681 Secured sectors appear as @emph{protected} in the @code{flash info} command.
6682 Example:
6683 @example
6684 lpc2900 secure_sector 0 1 1
6685 flash info 0
6686 #0 : lpc2900 at 0x20000000, size 0x000c0000, (...)
6687 # 0: 0x00000000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
6688 # 1: 0x00002000 (0x2000 8kB) protected
6689 # 2: 0x00004000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
6690 @end example
6691 @end deffn
6692
6693 @deffn {Command} {lpc2900 secure_jtag} bank
6694 Irreversibly disable the JTAG port. The new JTAG security setting will be
6695 effective after the next power cycle.
6696 @quotation Attention
6697 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
6698 @end quotation
6699 Examples:
6700 @example
6701 lpc2900 secure_jtag 0
6702 @end example
6703 @end deffn
6704 @end deffn
6705
6706 @deffn {Flash Driver} {mdr}
6707 This drivers handles the integrated NOR flash on Milandr Cortex-M
6708 based controllers. A known limitation is that the Info memory can't be
6709 read or verified as it's not memory mapped.
6710
6711 @example
6712 flash bank <name> mdr <base> <size> \
6713 0 0 <target#> @var{type} @var{page_count} @var{sec_count}
6714 @end example
6715
6716 @itemize @bullet
6717 @item @var{type} - 0 for main memory, 1 for info memory
6718 @item @var{page_count} - total number of pages
6719 @item @var{sec_count} - number of sector per page count
6720 @end itemize
6721
6722 Example usage:
6723 @example
6724 if @{ [info exists IMEMORY] && [string equal $IMEMORY true] @} @{
6725 flash bank $@{_CHIPNAME@}_info.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x01000 \
6726 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 1 1 4
6727 @} else @{
6728 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x20000 \
6729 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0 32 4
6730 @}
6731 @end example
6732 @end deffn
6733
6734 @deffn {Flash Driver} {msp432}
6735 All versions of the SimpleLink MSP432 microcontrollers from Texas
6736 Instruments include internal flash. The msp432 flash driver automatically
6737 recognizes the specific version's flash parameters and autoconfigures itself.
6738 Main program flash starts at address 0. The information flash region on
6739 MSP432P4 versions starts at address 0x200000.
6740
6741 @example
6742 flash bank $_FLASHNAME msp432 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6743 @end example
6744
6745 @deffn {Command} {msp432 mass_erase} bank_id [main|all]
6746 Performs a complete erase of flash. By default, @command{mass_erase} will erase
6747 only the main program flash.
6748
6749 On MSP432P4 versions, using @command{mass_erase all} will erase both the
6750 main program and information flash regions. To also erase the BSL in information
6751 flash, the user must first use the @command{bsl} command.
6752 @end deffn
6753
6754 @deffn {Command} {msp432 bsl} bank_id [unlock|lock]
6755 On MSP432P4 versions, @command{bsl} unlocks and locks the bootstrap loader (BSL)
6756 region in information flash so that flash commands can erase or write the BSL.
6757 Leave the BSL locked to prevent accidentally corrupting the bootstrap loader.
6758
6759 To erase and program the BSL:
6760 @example
6761 msp432 bsl unlock
6762 flash erase_address 0x202000 0x2000
6763 flash write_image bsl.bin 0x202000
6764 msp432 bsl lock
6765 @end example
6766 @end deffn
6767 @end deffn
6768
6769 @deffn {Flash Driver} {niietcm4}
6770 This drivers handles the integrated NOR flash on NIIET Cortex-M4
6771 based controllers. Flash size and sector layout are auto-configured by the driver.
6772 Main flash memory is called "Bootflash" and has main region and info region.
6773 Info region is NOT memory mapped by default,
6774 but it can replace first part of main region if needed.
6775 Full erase, single and block writes are supported for both main and info regions.
6776 There is additional not memory mapped flash called "Userflash", which
6777 also have division into regions: main and info.
6778 Purpose of userflash - to store system and user settings.
6779 Driver has special commands to perform operations with this memory.
6780
6781 @example
6782 flash bank $_FLASHNAME niietcm4 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6783 @end example
6784
6785 Some niietcm4-specific commands are defined:
6786
6787 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_read_byte} bank ('main'|'info') address
6788 Read byte from main or info userflash region.
6789 @end deffn
6790
6791 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_write_byte} bank ('main'|'info') address value
6792 Write byte to main or info userflash region.
6793 @end deffn
6794
6795 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_full_erase} bank
6796 Erase all userflash including info region.
6797 @end deffn
6798
6799 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_erase} bank ('main'|'info') first_sector last_sector
6800 Erase sectors of main or info userflash region, starting at sector first up to and including last.
6801 @end deffn
6802
6803 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_protect_check} bank ('main'|'info')
6804 Check sectors protect.
6805 @end deffn
6806
6807 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 uflash_protect} bank ('main'|'info') first_sector last_sector ('on'|'off')
6808 Protect sectors of main or info userflash region, starting at sector first up to and including last.
6809 @end deffn
6810
6811 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 bflash_info_remap} bank ('on'|'off')
6812 Enable remapping bootflash info region to 0x00000000 (or 0x40000000 if external memory boot used).
6813 @end deffn
6814
6815 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 extmem_cfg} bank ('gpioa'|'gpiob'|'gpioc'|'gpiod'|'gpioe'|'gpiof'|'gpiog'|'gpioh') pin_num ('func1'|'func3')
6816 Configure external memory interface for boot.
6817 @end deffn
6818
6819 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 service_mode_erase} bank
6820 Perform emergency erase of all flash (bootflash and userflash).
6821 @end deffn
6822
6823 @deffn {Command} {niietcm4 driver_info} bank
6824 Show information about flash driver.
6825 @end deffn
6826
6827 @end deffn
6828
6829 @deffn {Flash Driver} {npcx}
6830 All versions of the NPCX microcontroller families from Nuvoton include internal
6831 flash. The NPCX flash driver supports the NPCX family of devices. The driver
6832 automatically recognizes the specific version's flash parameters and
6833 autoconfigures itself. The flash bank starts at address 0x64000000.
6834
6835 @example
6836 flash bank $_FLASHNAME npcx 0x64000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6837 @end example
6838 @end deffn
6839
6840 @deffn {Flash Driver} {nrf5}
6841 All members of the nRF51 microcontroller families from Nordic Semiconductor
6842 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0 core. nRF52 family powered
6843 by ARM Cortex-M4 or M4F core is supported too. nRF52832 is fully supported
6844 including BPROT flash protection scheme. nRF52833 and nRF52840 devices are
6845 supported with the exception of security extensions (flash access control list
6846 - ACL).
6847
6848 @example
6849 flash bank $_FLASHNAME nrf5 0 0x00000000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6850 @end example
6851
6852 Some nrf5-specific commands are defined:
6853
6854 @deffn {Command} {nrf5 mass_erase}
6855 Erases the contents of the code memory and user information
6856 configuration registers as well. It must be noted that this command
6857 works only for chips that do not have factory pre-programmed region 0
6858 code.
6859 @end deffn
6860
6861 @deffn {Command} {nrf5 info}
6862 Decodes and shows information from FICR and UICR registers.
6863 @end deffn
6864
6865 @end deffn
6866
6867 @deffn {Flash Driver} {ocl}
6868 This driver is an implementation of the ``on chip flash loader''
6869 protocol proposed by Pavel Chromy.
6870
6871 It is a minimalistic command-response protocol intended to be used
6872 over a DCC when communicating with an internal or external flash
6873 loader running from RAM. An example implementation for AT91SAM7x is
6874 available in @file{contrib/loaders/flash/at91sam7x/}.
6875
6876 @example
6877 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ocl 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6878 @end example
6879 @end deffn
6880
6881 @deffn {Flash Driver} {pic32mx}
6882 The PIC32MX microcontrollers are based on the MIPS 4K cores,
6883 and integrate flash memory.
6884
6885 @example
6886 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6887 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1d000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6888 @end example
6889
6890 @comment numerous *disabled* commands are defined:
6891 @comment - chip_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
6892 @comment - lock, unlock ... pointless given protect on/off (yes?)
6893 @comment - pgm_word ... shouldn't bank be deduced from address??
6894 Some pic32mx-specific commands are defined:
6895 @deffn {Command} {pic32mx pgm_word} address value bank
6896 Programs the specified 32-bit @var{value} at the given @var{address}
6897 in the specified chip @var{bank}.
6898 @end deffn
6899 @deffn {Command} {pic32mx unlock} bank
6900 Unlock and erase specified chip @var{bank}.
6901 This will remove any Code Protection.
6902 @end deffn
6903 @end deffn
6904
6905 @deffn {Flash Driver} {psoc4}
6906 All members of the PSoC 41xx/42xx microcontroller family from Cypress
6907 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0 cores.
6908 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6909 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6910
6911 Note: Erased internal flash reads as 00.
6912 System ROM of PSoC 4 does not implement erase of a flash sector.
6913
6914 @example
6915 flash bank $_FLASHNAME psoc4 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6916 @end example
6917
6918 psoc4-specific commands
6919 @deffn {Command} {psoc4 flash_autoerase} num (on|off)
6920 Enables or disables autoerase mode for a flash bank.
6921
6922 If flash_autoerase is off, use mass_erase before flash programming.
6923 Flash erase command fails if region to erase is not whole flash memory.
6924
6925 If flash_autoerase is on, a sector is both erased and programmed in one
6926 system ROM call. Flash erase command is ignored.
6927 This mode is suitable for gdb load.
6928
6929 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6930 @end deffn
6931
6932 @deffn {Command} {psoc4 mass_erase} num
6933 Erases the contents of the flash memory, protection and security lock.
6934
6935 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6936 @end deffn
6937 @end deffn
6938
6939 @deffn {Flash Driver} {psoc5lp}
6940 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
6941 include internal program flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6942 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself,
6943 apart from the base address.
6944
6945 @example
6946 flash bank $_FLASHNAME psoc5lp 0x00000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6947 @end example
6948
6949 @b{Note:} PSoC 5LP chips can be configured to have ECC enabled or disabled.
6950 @quotation Attention
6951 If flash operations are performed in ECC-disabled mode, they will also affect
6952 the ECC flash region. Erasing a 16k flash sector in the 0x00000000 area will
6953 then also erase the corresponding 2k data bytes in the 0x48000000 area.
6954 Writing to the ECC data bytes in ECC-disabled mode is not implemented.
6955 @end quotation
6956
6957 Commands defined in the @var{psoc5lp} driver:
6958
6959 @deffn {Command} {psoc5lp mass_erase}
6960 Erases all flash data and ECC/configuration bytes, all flash protection rows,
6961 and all row latches in all flash arrays on the device.
6962 @end deffn
6963 @end deffn
6964
6965 @deffn {Flash Driver} {psoc5lp_eeprom}
6966 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
6967 include internal EEPROM and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6968 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself,
6969 apart from the base address.
6970
6971 @example
6972 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.eeprom psoc5lp_eeprom 0x40008000 0 0 0 \
6973 $_TARGETNAME
6974 @end example
6975 @end deffn
6976
6977 @deffn {Flash Driver} {psoc5lp_nvl}
6978 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
6979 include internal Nonvolatile Latches and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6980 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself.
6981
6982 @example
6983 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.nvl psoc5lp_nvl 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6984 @end example
6985
6986 PSoC 5LP chips have multiple NV Latches:
6987
6988 @itemize
6989 @item Device Configuration NV Latch - 4 bytes
6990 @item Write Once (WO) NV Latch - 4 bytes
6991 @end itemize
6992
6993 @b{Note:} This driver only implements the Device Configuration NVL.
6994
6995 The @var{psoc5lp} driver reads the ECC mode from Device Configuration NVL.
6996 @quotation Attention
6997 Switching ECC mode via write to Device Configuration NVL will require a reset
6998 after successful write.
6999 @end quotation
7000 @end deffn
7001
7002 @deffn {Flash Driver} {psoc6}
7003 Supports PSoC6 (CY8C6xxx) family of Cypress microcontrollers.
7004 PSoC6 is a dual-core device with CM0+ and CM4 cores. Both cores share
7005 the same Flash/RAM/MMIO address space.
7006
7007 Flash in PSoC6 is split into three regions:
7008 @itemize @bullet
7009 @item Main Flash - this is the main storage for user application.
7010 Total size varies among devices, sector size: 256 kBytes, row size:
7011 512 bytes. Supports erase operation on individual rows.
7012 @item Work Flash - intended to be used as storage for user data
7013 (e.g. EEPROM emulation). Total size: 32 KBytes, sector size: 32 KBytes,
7014 row size: 512 bytes.
7015 @item Supervisory Flash - special region which contains device-specific
7016 service data. This region does not support erase operation. Only few rows can
7017 be programmed by the user, most of the rows are read only. Programming
7018 operation will erase row automatically.
7019 @end itemize
7020
7021 All three flash regions are supported by the driver. Flash geometry is detected
7022 automatically by parsing data in SPCIF_GEOMETRY register.
7023
7024 PSoC6 is equipped with NOR Flash so erased Flash reads as 0x00.
7025
7026 @example
7027 flash bank main_flash_cm0 psoc6 0x10000000 0 0 0 \
7028 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
7029 flash bank work_flash_cm0 psoc6 0x14000000 0 0 0 \
7030 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
7031 flash bank super_flash_user_cm0 psoc6 0x16000800 0 0 0 \
7032 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
7033 flash bank super_flash_nar_cm0 psoc6 0x16001A00 0 0 0 \
7034 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
7035 flash bank super_flash_key_cm0 psoc6 0x16005A00 0 0 0 \
7036 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
7037 flash bank super_flash_toc2_cm0 psoc6 0x16007C00 0 0 0 \
7038 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
7039
7040 flash bank main_flash_cm4 psoc6 0x10000000 0 0 0 \
7041 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
7042 flash bank work_flash_cm4 psoc6 0x14000000 0 0 0 \
7043 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
7044 flash bank super_flash_user_cm4 psoc6 0x16000800 0 0 0 \
7045 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
7046 flash bank super_flash_nar_cm4 psoc6 0x16001A00 0 0 0 \
7047 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
7048 flash bank super_flash_key_cm4 psoc6 0x16005A00 0 0 0 \
7049 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
7050 flash bank super_flash_toc2_cm4 psoc6 0x16007C00 0 0 0 \
7051 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
7052 @end example
7053
7054 psoc6-specific commands
7055 @deffn {Command} {psoc6 reset_halt}
7056 Command can be used to simulate broken Vector Catch from gdbinit or tcl scripts.
7057 When invoked for CM0+ target, it will set break point at application entry point
7058 and issue SYSRESETREQ. This will reset both cores and all peripherals. CM0+ will
7059 reset CM4 during boot anyway so this is safe. On CM4 target, VECTRESET is used
7060 instead of SYSRESETREQ to avoid unwanted reset of CM0+;
7061 @end deffn
7062
7063 @deffn {Command} {psoc6 mass_erase} num
7064 Erases the contents given flash bank. The @var{num} parameter is a value shown
7065 by @command{flash banks}.
7066 Note: only Main and Work flash regions support Erase operation.
7067 @end deffn
7068 @end deffn
7069
7070 @deffn {Flash Driver} {rp2040}
7071 Supports RP2040 "Raspberry Pi Pico" microcontroller.
7072 RP2040 is a dual-core device with two CM0+ cores. Both cores share the same
7073 Flash/RAM/MMIO address space. Non-volatile storage is achieved with an
7074 external QSPI flash; a Boot ROM provides helper functions.
7075
7076 @example
7077 flash bank $_FLASHNAME rp2040_flash $_FLASHBASE $_FLASHSIZE 1 32 $_TARGETNAME
7078 @end example
7079 @end deffn
7080
7081 @deffn {Flash Driver} {sim3x}
7082 All members of the SiM3 microcontroller family from Silicon Laboratories
7083 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores. It supports both JTAG
7084 and SWD interface.
7085 The @var{sim3x} driver tries to probe the device to auto detect the MCU.
7086 If this fails, it will use the @var{size} parameter as the size of flash bank.
7087
7088 @example
7089 flash bank $_FLASHNAME sim3x 0 $_CPUROMSIZE 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7090 @end example
7091
7092 There are 2 commands defined in the @var{sim3x} driver:
7093
7094 @deffn {Command} {sim3x mass_erase}
7095 Erases the complete flash. This is used to unlock the flash.
7096 And this command is only possible when using the SWD interface.
7097 @end deffn
7098
7099 @deffn {Command} {sim3x lock}
7100 Lock the flash. To unlock use the @command{sim3x mass_erase} command.
7101 @end deffn
7102 @end deffn
7103
7104 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stellaris}
7105 All members of the Stellaris LM3Sxxx, LM4x and Tiva C microcontroller
7106 families from Texas Instruments include internal flash. The driver
7107 automatically recognizes a number of these chips using the chip
7108 identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7109
7110 @example
7111 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stellaris 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7112 @end example
7113
7114 @deffn {Command} {stellaris recover}
7115 Performs the @emph{Recovering a "Locked" Device} procedure to restore
7116 the flash and its associated nonvolatile registers to their factory
7117 default values (erased). This is the only way to remove flash
7118 protection or re-enable debugging if that capability has been
7119 disabled.
7120
7121 Note that the final "power cycle the chip" step in this procedure
7122 must be performed by hand, since OpenOCD can't do it.
7123 @quotation Warning
7124 if more than one Stellaris chip is connected, the procedure is
7125 applied to all of them.
7126 @end quotation
7127 @end deffn
7128 @end deffn
7129
7130 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stm32f1x}
7131 All members of the STM32F0, STM32F1 and STM32F3 microcontroller families
7132 from STMicroelectronics and all members of the GD32F1x0, GD32F3x0 and GD32E23x microcontroller
7133 families from GigaDevice include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0/M3/M4/M23 cores.
7134 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7135 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7136
7137 @example
7138 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7139 @end example
7140
7141 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7142 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7143 the flash driver.
7144
7145 @example
7146 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7147 @end example
7148
7149 If you have a target with dual flash banks then define the second bank
7150 as per the following example.
7151 @example
7152 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0x08080000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7153 @end example
7154
7155 Some stm32f1x-specific commands are defined:
7156
7157 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x lock} num
7158 Locks the entire stm32 device against reading.
7159 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7160 @end deffn
7161
7162 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x unlock} num
7163 Unlocks the entire stm32 device for reading. This command will cause
7164 a mass erase of the entire stm32 device if previously locked.
7165 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7166 @end deffn
7167
7168 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x mass_erase} num
7169 Mass erases the entire stm32 device.
7170 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7171 @end deffn
7172
7173 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x options_read} num
7174 Reads and displays active stm32 option bytes loaded during POR
7175 or upon executing the @command{stm32f1x options_load} command.
7176 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7177 @end deffn
7178
7179 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x options_write} num (@option{SWWDG}|@option{HWWDG}) (@option{RSTSTNDBY}|@option{NORSTSTNDBY}) (@option{RSTSTOP}|@option{NORSTSTOP}) (@option{USEROPT} user_data)
7180 Writes the stm32 option byte with the specified values.
7181 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7182 The @var{user_data} parameter is content of higher 16 bits of the option byte register (Data0 and Data1 as one 16bit number).
7183 @end deffn
7184
7185 @deffn {Command} {stm32f1x options_load} num
7186 Generates a special kind of reset to re-load the stm32 option bytes written
7187 by the @command{stm32f1x options_write} or @command{flash protect} commands
7188 without having to power cycle the target. Not applicable to stm32f1x devices.
7189 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7190 @end deffn
7191 @end deffn
7192
7193 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stm32f2x}
7194 All members of the STM32F2, STM32F4 and STM32F7 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
7195 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3/M4/M7 cores.
7196 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7197 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7198
7199 @example
7200 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7201 @end example
7202
7203 If you use OTP (One-Time Programmable) memory define it as a second bank
7204 as per the following example.
7205 @example
7206 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0x1FFF7800 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7207 @end example
7208
7209 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x otp} num (@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{show})
7210 Enables or disables OTP write commands for bank @var{num}.
7211 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7212 @end deffn
7213
7214 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7215 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7216 the flash driver.
7217
7218 @example
7219 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7220 @end example
7221
7222 Some stm32f2x-specific commands are defined:
7223
7224 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x lock} num
7225 Locks the entire stm32 device.
7226 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7227 @end deffn
7228
7229 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x unlock} num
7230 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
7231 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7232 @end deffn
7233
7234 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x mass_erase} num
7235 Mass erases the entire stm32f2x device.
7236 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7237 @end deffn
7238
7239 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x options_read} num
7240 Reads and displays user options and (where implemented) boot_addr0, boot_addr1, optcr2.
7241 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7242 @end deffn
7243
7244 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x options_write} num user_options boot_addr0 boot_addr1
7245 Writes user options and (where implemented) boot_addr0 and boot_addr1 in raw format.
7246 Warning: The meaning of the various bits depends on the device, always check datasheet!
7247 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{user_options} a
7248 12 bit value, consisting of bits 31-28 and 7-0 of FLASH_OPTCR, @var{boot_addr0} and
7249 @var{boot_addr1} two halfwords (of FLASH_OPTCR1).
7250 @end deffn
7251
7252 @deffn {Command} {stm32f2x optcr2_write} num optcr2
7253 Writes FLASH_OPTCR2 options. Warning: Clearing PCROPi bits requires a full mass erase!
7254 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{optcr2} a 32-bit word.
7255 @end deffn
7256 @end deffn
7257
7258 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stm32h7x}
7259 All members of the STM32H7 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
7260 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M7 core.
7261 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7262 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7263
7264 @example
7265 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32h7x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7266 @end example
7267
7268 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7269 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7270 the flash driver.
7271
7272 @example
7273 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32h7x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7274 @end example
7275
7276 Some stm32h7x-specific commands are defined:
7277
7278 @deffn {Command} {stm32h7x lock} num
7279 Locks the entire stm32 device.
7280 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7281 @end deffn
7282
7283 @deffn {Command} {stm32h7x unlock} num
7284 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
7285 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7286 @end deffn
7287
7288 @deffn {Command} {stm32h7x mass_erase} num
7289 Mass erases the entire stm32h7x device.
7290 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7291 @end deffn
7292
7293 @deffn {Command} {stm32h7x option_read} num reg_offset
7294 Reads an option byte register from the stm32h7x device.
7295 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
7296 is the register offset of the option byte to read from the used bank registers' base.
7297 For example: in STM32H74x/H75x the bank 1 registers' base is 0x52002000 and 0x52002100 for bank 2.
7298
7299 Example usage:
7300 @example
7301 # read OPTSR_CUR
7302 stm32h7x option_read 0 0x1c
7303 # read WPSN_CUR1R
7304 stm32h7x option_read 0 0x38
7305 # read WPSN_CUR2R
7306 stm32h7x option_read 1 0x38
7307 @end example
7308 @end deffn
7309
7310 @deffn {Command} {stm32h7x option_write} num reg_offset value [reg_mask]
7311 Writes an option byte register of the stm32h7x device.
7312 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
7313 is the register offset of the option byte to write from the used bank register base,
7314 and @var{reg_mask} is the mask to apply when writing the register (only bits with a '1'
7315 will be touched).
7316
7317 Example usage:
7318 @example
7319 # swap bank 1 and bank 2 in dual bank devices
7320 # by setting SWAP_BANK_OPT bit in OPTSR_PRG
7321 stm32h7x option_write 0 0x20 0x8000000 0x8000000
7322 @end example
7323 @end deffn
7324 @end deffn
7325
7326 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stm32lx}
7327 All members of the STM32L0 and STM32L1 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
7328 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 and Cortex-M0+ cores.
7329 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7330 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7331
7332 @example
7333 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32lx 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7334 @end example
7335
7336 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7337 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7338 the flash driver. If you use 0 as the bank base address, it tells the
7339 driver to autodetect the bank location assuming you're configuring the
7340 second bank.
7341
7342 @example
7343 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32lx 0x08000000 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7344 @end example
7345
7346 Some stm32lx-specific commands are defined:
7347
7348 @deffn {Command} {stm32lx lock} num
7349 Locks the entire stm32 device.
7350 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7351 @end deffn
7352
7353 @deffn {Command} {stm32lx unlock} num
7354 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
7355 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7356 @end deffn
7357
7358 @deffn {Command} {stm32lx mass_erase} num
7359 Mass erases the entire stm32lx device (all flash banks and EEPROM
7360 data). This is the only way to unlock a protected flash (unless RDP
7361 Level is 2 which can't be unlocked at all).
7362 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7363 @end deffn
7364 @end deffn
7365
7366 @deffn {Flash Driver} {stm32l4x}
7367 All members of the STM32 G0, G4, L4, L4+, L5, U5, WB and WL
7368 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics include internal flash
7369 and use ARM Cortex-M0+, M4 and M33 cores.
7370 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7371 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7372
7373 @example
7374 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7375 @end example
7376
7377 If you use OTP (One-Time Programmable) memory define it as a second bank
7378 as per the following example.
7379 @example
7380 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0x1FFF7000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7381 @end example
7382
7383 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x otp} num (@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{show})
7384 Enables or disables OTP write commands for bank @var{num}.
7385 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7386 @end deffn
7387
7388 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7389 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7390 the flash driver. However, specifying a wrong value might lead to a completely
7391 wrong flash layout, so this feature must be used carefully.
7392
7393 @example
7394 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0x08000000 0x40000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7395 @end example
7396
7397 Some stm32l4x-specific commands are defined:
7398
7399 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x lock} num
7400 Locks the entire stm32 device.
7401 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7402
7403 @emph{Note:} To apply the protection change immediately, use @command{stm32l4x option_load}.
7404 @end deffn
7405
7406 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x unlock} num
7407 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
7408 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7409
7410 @emph{Note:} To apply the protection change immediately, use @command{stm32l4x option_load}.
7411 @end deffn
7412
7413 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x mass_erase} num
7414 Mass erases the entire stm32l4x device.
7415 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7416 @end deffn
7417
7418 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x option_read} num reg_offset
7419 Reads an option byte register from the stm32l4x device.
7420 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
7421 is the register offset of the Option byte to read.
7422
7423 For example to read the FLASH_OPTR register:
7424 @example
7425 stm32l4x option_read 0 0x20
7426 # Option Register (for STM32L4x): <0x40022020> = 0xffeff8aa
7427 # Option Register (for STM32WBx): <0x58004020> = ...
7428 # The correct flash base address will be used automatically
7429 @end example
7430
7431 The above example will read out the FLASH_OPTR register which contains the RDP
7432 option byte, Watchdog configuration, BOR level etc.
7433 @end deffn
7434
7435 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x option_write} num reg_offset reg_mask
7436 Write an option byte register of the stm32l4x device.
7437 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
7438 is the register offset of the Option byte to write, and @var{reg_mask} is the mask
7439 to apply when writing the register (only bits with a '1' will be touched).
7440
7441 @emph{Note:} To apply the option bytes change immediately, use @command{stm32l4x option_load}.
7442
7443 For example to write the WRP1AR option bytes:
7444 @example
7445 stm32l4x option_write 0 0x28 0x00FF0000 0x00FF00FF
7446 @end example
7447
7448 The above example will write the WRP1AR option register configuring the Write protection
7449 Area A for bank 1. The above example set WRP1AR_END=255, WRP1AR_START=0.
7450 This will effectively write protect all sectors in flash bank 1.
7451 @end deffn
7452
7453 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x wrp_info} num [device_bank]
7454 List the protected areas using WRP.
7455 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7456 @var{device_bank} parameter is optional, possible values 'bank1' or 'bank2',
7457 if not specified, the command will display the whole flash protected areas.
7458
7459 @b{Note:} @var{device_bank} is different from banks created using @code{flash bank}.
7460 Devices supported in this flash driver, can have main flash memory organized
7461 in single or dual-banks mode.
7462 Thus the usage of @var{device_bank} is meaningful only in dual-bank mode, to get
7463 write protected areas in a specific @var{device_bank}
7464
7465 @end deffn
7466
7467 @deffn {Command} {stm32l4x option_load} num
7468 Forces a re-load of the option byte registers. Will cause a system reset of the device.
7469 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7470 @end deffn
7471
7472 @deffn Command {stm32l4x trustzone} num [@option{enable} | @option{disable}]
7473 Enables or disables Global TrustZone Security, using the TZEN option bit.
7474 If neither @option{enabled} nor @option{disable} are specified, the command will display
7475 the TrustZone status.
7476 @emph{Note:} This command works only with devices with TrustZone, eg. STM32L5.
7477 @emph{Note:} This command will perform an OBL_Launch after modifying the TZEN.
7478 @end deffn
7479 @end deffn
7480
7481 @deffn {Flash Driver} {str7x}
7482 All members of the STR7 microcontroller family from STMicroelectronics
7483 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
7484 The @var{str7x} driver defines one mandatory parameter, @var{variant},
7485 which is either @code{STR71x}, @code{STR73x} or @code{STR75x}.
7486
7487 @example
7488 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str7x \
7489 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME STR71x
7490 @end example
7491
7492 @deffn {Command} {str7x disable_jtag} bank
7493 Activate the Debug/Readout protection mechanism
7494 for the specified flash bank.
7495 @end deffn
7496 @end deffn
7497
7498 @deffn {Flash Driver} {str9x}
7499 Most members of the STR9 microcontroller family from STMicroelectronics
7500 include internal flash and use ARM966E cores.
7501 The str9 needs the flash controller to be configured using
7502 the @command{str9x flash_config} command prior to Flash programming.
7503
7504 @example
7505 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str9x 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7506 str9x flash_config 0 4 2 0 0x80000
7507 @end example
7508
7509 @deffn {Command} {str9x flash_config} num bbsr nbbsr bbadr nbbadr
7510 Configures the str9 flash controller.
7511 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7512
7513 @itemize @bullet
7514 @item @var{bbsr} - Boot Bank Size register
7515 @item @var{nbbsr} - Non Boot Bank Size register
7516 @item @var{bbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
7517 @item @var{nbbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
7518 @end itemize
7519 @end deffn
7520
7521 @end deffn
7522
7523 @deffn {Flash Driver} {str9xpec}
7524 @cindex str9xpec
7525
7526 Only use this driver for locking/unlocking the device or configuring the option bytes.
7527 Use the standard str9 driver for programming.
7528 Before using the flash commands the turbo mode must be enabled using the
7529 @command{str9xpec enable_turbo} command.
7530
7531 Here is some background info to help
7532 you better understand how this driver works. OpenOCD has two flash drivers for
7533 the str9:
7534 @enumerate
7535 @item
7536 Standard driver @option{str9x} programmed via the str9 core. Normally used for
7537 flash programming as it is faster than the @option{str9xpec} driver.
7538 @item
7539 Direct programming @option{str9xpec} using the flash controller. This is an
7540 ISC compliant (IEEE 1532) tap connected in series with the str9 core. The str9
7541 core does not need to be running to program using this flash driver. Typical use
7542 for this driver is locking/unlocking the target and programming the option bytes.
7543 @end enumerate
7544
7545 Before we run any commands using the @option{str9xpec} driver we must first disable
7546 the str9 core. This example assumes the @option{str9xpec} driver has been
7547 configured for flash bank 0.
7548 @example
7549 # assert srst, we do not want core running
7550 # while accessing str9xpec flash driver
7551 adapter assert srst
7552 # turn off target polling
7553 poll off
7554 # disable str9 core
7555 str9xpec enable_turbo 0
7556 # read option bytes
7557 str9xpec options_read 0
7558 # re-enable str9 core
7559 str9xpec disable_turbo 0
7560 poll on
7561 reset halt
7562 @end example
7563 The above example will read the str9 option bytes.
7564 When performing a unlock remember that you will not be able to halt the str9 - it
7565 has been locked. Halting the core is not required for the @option{str9xpec} driver
7566 as mentioned above, just issue the commands above manually or from a telnet prompt.
7567
7568 Several str9xpec-specific commands are defined:
7569
7570 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec disable_turbo} num
7571 Restore the str9 into JTAG chain.
7572 @end deffn
7573
7574 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec enable_turbo} num
7575 Enable turbo mode, will simply remove the str9 from the chain and talk
7576 directly to the embedded flash controller.
7577 @end deffn
7578
7579 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec lock} num
7580 Lock str9 device. The str9 will only respond to an unlock command that will
7581 erase the device.
7582 @end deffn
7583
7584 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec part_id} num
7585 Prints the part identifier for bank @var{num}.
7586 @end deffn
7587
7588 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_cmap} num (@option{bank0}|@option{bank1})
7589 Configure str9 boot bank.
7590 @end deffn
7591
7592 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_lvdsel} num (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
7593 Configure str9 lvd source.
7594 @end deffn
7595
7596 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_lvdthd} num (@option{2.4v}|@option{2.7v})
7597 Configure str9 lvd threshold.
7598 @end deffn
7599
7600 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_lvdwarn} bank (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
7601 Configure str9 lvd reset warning source.
7602 @end deffn
7603
7604 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_read} num
7605 Read str9 option bytes.
7606 @end deffn
7607
7608 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec options_write} num
7609 Write str9 option bytes.
7610 @end deffn
7611
7612 @deffn {Command} {str9xpec unlock} num
7613 unlock str9 device.
7614 @end deffn
7615
7616 @end deffn
7617
7618 @deffn {Flash Driver} {swm050}
7619 @cindex swm050
7620 All members of the swm050 microcontroller family from Foshan Synwit Tech.
7621
7622 @example
7623 flash bank $_FLASHNAME swm050 0x0 0x2000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7624 @end example
7625
7626 One swm050-specific command is defined:
7627
7628 @deffn {Command} {swm050 mass_erase} bank_id
7629 Erases the entire flash bank.
7630 @end deffn
7631
7632 @end deffn
7633
7634
7635 @deffn {Flash Driver} {tms470}
7636 Most members of the TMS470 microcontroller family from Texas Instruments
7637 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
7638 This driver doesn't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
7639
7640 Some tms470-specific commands are defined:
7641
7642 @deffn {Command} {tms470 flash_keyset} key0 key1 key2 key3
7643 Saves programming keys in a register, to enable flash erase and write commands.
7644 @end deffn
7645
7646 @deffn {Command} {tms470 osc_megahertz} clock_mhz
7647 Reports the clock speed, which is used to calculate timings.
7648 @end deffn
7649
7650 @deffn {Command} {tms470 plldis} (0|1)
7651 Disables (@var{1}) or enables (@var{0}) use of the PLL to speed up
7652 the flash clock.
7653 @end deffn
7654 @end deffn
7655
7656 @deffn {Flash Driver} {w600}
7657 W60x series Wi-Fi SoC from WinnerMicro
7658 are designed with ARM Cortex-M3 and have 1M Byte QFLASH inside.
7659 The @var{w600} driver uses the @var{target} parameter to select the
7660 correct bank config.
7661
7662 @example
7663 flash bank $_FLASHNAME w600 0x08000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAMEs
7664 @end example
7665 @end deffn
7666
7667 @deffn {Flash Driver} {xmc1xxx}
7668 All members of the XMC1xxx microcontroller family from Infineon.
7669 This driver does not require the chip and bus width to be specified.
7670 @end deffn
7671
7672 @deffn {Flash Driver} {xmc4xxx}
7673 All members of the XMC4xxx microcontroller family from Infineon.
7674 This driver does not require the chip and bus width to be specified.
7675
7676 Some xmc4xxx-specific commands are defined:
7677
7678 @deffn {Command} {xmc4xxx flash_password} bank_id passwd1 passwd2
7679 Saves flash protection passwords which are used to lock the user flash
7680 @end deffn
7681
7682 @deffn {Command} {xmc4xxx flash_unprotect} bank_id user_level[0-1]
7683 Removes Flash write protection from the selected user bank
7684 @end deffn
7685
7686 @end deffn
7687
7688 @section NAND Flash Commands
7689 @cindex NAND
7690
7691 Compared to NOR or SPI flash, NAND devices are inexpensive
7692 and high density. Today's NAND chips, and multi-chip modules,
7693 commonly hold multiple GigaBytes of data.
7694
7695 NAND chips consist of a number of ``erase blocks'' of a given
7696 size (such as 128 KBytes), each of which is divided into a
7697 number of pages (of perhaps 512 or 2048 bytes each). Each
7698 page of a NAND flash has an ``out of band'' (OOB) area to hold
7699 Error Correcting Code (ECC) and other metadata, usually 16 bytes
7700 of OOB for every 512 bytes of page data.
7701
7702 One key characteristic of NAND flash is that its error rate
7703 is higher than that of NOR flash. In normal operation, that
7704 ECC is used to correct and detect errors. However, NAND
7705 blocks can also wear out and become unusable; those blocks
7706 are then marked "bad". NAND chips are even shipped from the
7707 manufacturer with a few bad blocks. The highest density chips
7708 use a technology (MLC) that wears out more quickly, so ECC
7709 support is increasingly important as a way to detect blocks
7710 that have begun to fail, and help to preserve data integrity
7711 with techniques such as wear leveling.
7712
7713 Software is used to manage the ECC. Some controllers don't
7714 support ECC directly; in those cases, software ECC is used.
7715 Other controllers speed up the ECC calculations with hardware.
7716 Single-bit error correction hardware is routine. Controllers
7717 geared for newer MLC chips may correct 4 or more errors for
7718 every 512 bytes of data.
7719
7720 You will need to make sure that any data you write using
7721 OpenOCD includes the appropriate kind of ECC. For example,
7722 that may mean passing the @code{oob_softecc} flag when
7723 writing NAND data, or ensuring that the correct hardware
7724 ECC mode is used.
7725
7726 The basic steps for using NAND devices include:
7727 @enumerate
7728 @item Declare via the command @command{nand device}
7729 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
7730 passing parameters as needed by the controller.
7731 @item Configure each device using @command{nand probe}.
7732 @* Do this only after the associated target is set up,
7733 such as in its reset-init script or in procures defined
7734 to access that device.
7735 @item Operate on the flash via @command{nand subcommand}
7736 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
7737 via a script in some automated way. Common task include writing a
7738 boot loader, operating system, or other data needed to initialize or
7739 de-brick a board.
7740 @end enumerate
7741
7742 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, the largest NAND
7743 flash fully supported by OpenOCD is 2 GiBytes (16 GiBits).
7744 This is because the variables used to hold offsets and lengths
7745 are only 32 bits wide.
7746 (Larger chips may work in some cases, unless an offset or length
7747 is larger than 0xffffffff, the largest 32-bit unsigned integer.)
7748 Some larger devices will work, since they are actually multi-chip
7749 modules with two smaller chips and individual chipselect lines.
7750
7751 @anchor{nandconfiguration}
7752 @subsection NAND Configuration Commands
7753 @cindex NAND configuration
7754
7755 NAND chips must be declared in configuration scripts,
7756 plus some additional configuration that's done after
7757 OpenOCD has initialized.
7758
7759 @deffn {Config Command} {nand device} name driver target [configparams...]
7760 Declares a NAND device, which can be read and written to
7761 after it has been configured through @command{nand probe}.
7762 In OpenOCD, devices are single chips; this is unlike some
7763 operating systems, which may manage multiple chips as if
7764 they were a single (larger) device.
7765 In some cases, configuring a device will activate extra
7766 commands; see the controller-specific documentation.
7767
7768 @b{NOTE:} This command is not available after OpenOCD
7769 initialization has completed. Use it in board specific
7770 configuration files, not interactively.
7771
7772 @itemize @bullet
7773 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the NAND bank
7774 in most other NAND commands. A number is also available.
7775 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the NAND controller driver
7776 associated with the NAND device being declared.
7777 @xref{nanddriverlist,,NAND Driver List}.
7778 @item @var{target} ... names the target used when issuing
7779 commands to the NAND controller.
7780 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
7781 @item @var{configparams} ... controllers may support, or require,
7782 additional parameters. See the controller-specific documentation
7783 for more information.
7784 @end itemize
7785 @end deffn
7786
7787 @deffn {Command} {nand list}
7788 Prints a summary of each device declared
7789 using @command{nand device}, numbered from zero.
7790 Note that un-probed devices show no details.
7791 @example
7792 > nand list
7793 #0: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
7794 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
7795 #1: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
7796 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
7797 >
7798 @end example
7799 @end deffn
7800
7801 @deffn {Command} {nand probe} num
7802 Probes the specified device to determine key characteristics
7803 like its page and block sizes, and how many blocks it has.
7804 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7805 You must (successfully) probe a device before you can use
7806 it with most other NAND commands.
7807 @end deffn
7808
7809 @subsection Erasing, Reading, Writing to NAND Flash
7810
7811 @deffn {Command} {nand dump} num filename offset length [oob_option]
7812 @cindex NAND reading
7813 Reads binary data from the NAND device and writes it to the file,
7814 starting at the specified offset.
7815 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7816
7817 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
7818 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
7819
7820 The @var{offset} and @var{length} must be exact multiples of the
7821 device's page size. They describe a data region; the OOB data
7822 associated with each such page may also be accessed.
7823
7824 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, no error correction
7825 was done on the data that's read, unless raw access was disabled
7826 and the underlying NAND controller driver had a @code{read_page}
7827 method which handled that error correction.
7828
7829 By default, only page data is saved to the specified file.
7830 Use an @var{oob_option} parameter to save OOB data:
7831 @itemize @bullet
7832 @item no oob_* parameter
7833 @*Output file holds only page data; OOB is discarded.
7834 @item @code{oob_raw}
7835 @*Output file interleaves page data and OOB data;
7836 the file will be longer than "length" by the size of the
7837 spare areas associated with each data page.
7838 Note that this kind of "raw" access is different from
7839 what's implied by @command{nand raw_access}, which just
7840 controls whether a hardware-aware access method is used.
7841 @item @code{oob_only}
7842 @*Output file has only raw OOB data, and will
7843 be smaller than "length" since it will contain only the
7844 spare areas associated with each data page.
7845 @end itemize
7846 @end deffn
7847
7848 @deffn {Command} {nand erase} num [offset length]
7849 @cindex NAND erasing
7850 @cindex NAND programming
7851 Erases blocks on the specified NAND device, starting at the
7852 specified @var{offset} and continuing for @var{length} bytes.
7853 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
7854 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
7855 If those parameters are not specified,
7856 the whole NAND chip will be erased.
7857 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7858
7859 @b{NOTE:} This command will try to erase bad blocks, when told
7860 to do so, which will probably invalidate the manufacturer's bad
7861 block marker.
7862 For the remainder of the current server session, @command{nand info}
7863 will still report that the block ``is'' bad.
7864 @end deffn
7865
7866 @deffn {Command} {nand write} num filename offset [option...]
7867 @cindex NAND writing
7868 @cindex NAND programming
7869 Writes binary data from the file into the specified NAND device,
7870 starting at the specified offset. Those pages should already
7871 have been erased; you can't change zero bits to one bits.
7872 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7873
7874 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
7875 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
7876
7877 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
7878 All data in the file will be written, assuming it doesn't run
7879 past the end of the device.
7880 Only full pages are written, and any extra space in the last
7881 page will be filled with 0xff bytes. (That includes OOB data,
7882 if that's being written.)
7883
7884 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, bad blocks are
7885 ignored. That is, this routine will not skip bad blocks,
7886 but will instead try to write them. This can cause problems.
7887
7888 Provide at most one @var{option} parameter. With some
7889 NAND drivers, the meanings of these parameters may change
7890 if @command{nand raw_access} was used to disable hardware ECC.
7891 @itemize @bullet
7892 @item no oob_* parameter
7893 @*File has only page data, which is written.
7894 If raw access is in use, the OOB area will not be written.
7895 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
7896 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may write the OOB
7897 with hardware-computed ECC data.
7898 @item @code{oob_only}
7899 @*File has only raw OOB data, which is written to the OOB area.
7900 Each page's data area stays untouched. @i{This can be a dangerous
7901 option}, since it can invalidate the ECC data.
7902 You may need to force raw access to use this mode.
7903 @item @code{oob_raw}
7904 @*File interleaves data and OOB data, both of which are written
7905 If raw access is enabled, the data is written first, then the
7906 un-altered OOB.
7907 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
7908 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may modify the OOB
7909 before it's written, to include hardware-computed ECC data.
7910 @item @code{oob_softecc}
7911 @*File has only page data, which is written.
7912 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a standard 1-bit
7913 software ECC code stored in conventional locations.
7914 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
7915 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
7916 @item @code{oob_softecc_kw}
7917 @*File has only page data, which is written.
7918 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a 4-bit software ECC
7919 specific to the boot ROM in Marvell Kirkwood SoCs.
7920 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
7921 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
7922 @end itemize
7923 @end deffn
7924
7925 @deffn {Command} {nand verify} num filename offset [option...]
7926 @cindex NAND verification
7927 @cindex NAND programming
7928 Verify the binary data in the file has been programmed to the
7929 specified NAND device, starting at the specified offset.
7930 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7931
7932 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
7933 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
7934
7935 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
7936 All data in the file will be read and compared to the contents of the
7937 flash, assuming it doesn't run past the end of the device.
7938 As with @command{nand write}, only full pages are verified, so any extra
7939 space in the last page will be filled with 0xff bytes.
7940
7941 The same @var{options} accepted by @command{nand write},
7942 and the file will be processed similarly to produce the buffers that
7943 can be compared against the contents produced from @command{nand dump}.
7944
7945 @b{NOTE:} This will not work when the underlying NAND controller
7946 driver's @code{write_page} routine must update the OOB with a
7947 hardware-computed ECC before the data is written. This limitation may
7948 be removed in a future release.
7949 @end deffn
7950
7951 @subsection Other NAND commands
7952 @cindex NAND other commands
7953
7954 @deffn {Command} {nand check_bad_blocks} num [offset length]
7955 Checks for manufacturer bad block markers on the specified NAND
7956 device. If no parameters are provided, checks the whole
7957 device; otherwise, starts at the specified @var{offset} and
7958 continues for @var{length} bytes.
7959 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
7960 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
7961 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7962
7963 @b{NOTE:} Before using this command you should force raw access
7964 with @command{nand raw_access enable} to ensure that the underlying
7965 driver will not try to apply hardware ECC.
7966 @end deffn
7967
7968 @deffn {Command} {nand info} num
7969 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7970 This prints the one-line summary from "nand list", plus for
7971 devices which have been probed this also prints any known
7972 status for each block.
7973 @end deffn
7974
7975 @deffn {Command} {nand raw_access} num (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
7976 Sets or clears an flag affecting how page I/O is done.
7977 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7978
7979 This flag is cleared (disabled) by default, but changing that
7980 value won't affect all NAND devices. The key factor is whether
7981 the underlying driver provides @code{read_page} or @code{write_page}
7982 methods. If it doesn't provide those methods, the setting of
7983 this flag is irrelevant; all access is effectively ``raw''.
7984
7985 When those methods exist, they are normally used when reading
7986 data (@command{nand dump} or reading bad block markers) or
7987 writing it (@command{nand write}). However, enabling
7988 raw access (setting the flag) prevents use of those methods,
7989 bypassing hardware ECC logic.
7990 @i{This can be a dangerous option}, since writing blocks
7991 with the wrong ECC data can cause them to be marked as bad.
7992 @end deffn
7993
7994 @anchor{nanddriverlist}
7995 @subsection NAND Driver List
7996 As noted above, the @command{nand device} command allows
7997 driver-specific options and behaviors.
7998 Some controllers also activate controller-specific commands.
7999
8000 @deffn {NAND Driver} {at91sam9}
8001 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on AT91SAM9 family chips from
8002 Atmel. It takes two extra parameters: address of the NAND chip;
8003 address of the ECC controller.
8004 @example
8005 nand device $NANDFLASH at91sam9 $CHIPNAME 0x40000000 0xfffffe800
8006 @end example
8007 AT91SAM9 chips support single-bit ECC hardware. The @code{write_page} and
8008 @code{read_page} methods are used to utilize the ECC hardware unless they are
8009 disabled by using the @command{nand raw_access} command. There are four
8010 additional commands that are needed to fully configure the AT91SAM9 NAND
8011 controller. Two are optional; most boards use the same wiring for ALE/CLE:
8012 @deffn {Config Command} {at91sam9 cle} num addr_line
8013 Configure the address line used for latching commands. The @var{num}
8014 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
8015 @end deffn
8016 @deffn {Config Command} {at91sam9 ale} num addr_line
8017 Configure the address line used for latching addresses. The @var{num}
8018 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
8019 @end deffn
8020
8021 For the next two commands, it is assumed that the pins have already been
8022 properly configured for input or output.
8023 @deffn {Config Command} {at91sam9 rdy_busy} num pio_base_addr pin
8024 Configure the RDY/nBUSY input from the NAND device. The @var{num}
8025 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
8026 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
8027 @end deffn
8028 @deffn {Config Command} {at91sam9 ce} num pio_base_addr pin
8029 Configure the chip enable input to the NAND device. The @var{num}
8030 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
8031 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
8032 @end deffn
8033 @end deffn
8034
8035 @deffn {NAND Driver} {davinci}
8036 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on DaVinci family
8037 chips from Texas Instruments.
8038 It takes three extra parameters:
8039 address of the NAND chip;
8040 hardware ECC mode to use (@option{hwecc1},
8041 @option{hwecc4}, @option{hwecc4_infix});
8042 address of the AEMIF controller on this processor.
8043 @example
8044 nand device davinci dm355.arm 0x02000000 hwecc4 0x01e10000
8045 @end example
8046 All DaVinci processors support the single-bit ECC hardware,
8047 and newer ones also support the four-bit ECC hardware.
8048 The @code{write_page} and @code{read_page} methods are used
8049 to implement those ECC modes, unless they are disabled using
8050 the @command{nand raw_access} command.
8051 @end deffn
8052
8053 @deffn {NAND Driver} {lpc3180}
8054 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
8055 parameter: the clock rate used by the controller.
8056 @deffn {Command} {lpc3180 select} num [mlc|slc]
8057 Configures use of the MLC or SLC controller mode.
8058 MLC implies use of hardware ECC.
8059 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
8060 @end deffn
8061
8062 At this writing, this driver includes @code{write_page}
8063 and @code{read_page} methods. Using @command{nand raw_access}
8064 to disable those methods will prevent use of hardware ECC
8065 in the MLC controller mode, but won't change SLC behavior.
8066 @end deffn
8067 @comment current lpc3180 code won't issue 5-byte address cycles
8068
8069 @deffn {NAND Driver} {mx3}
8070 This driver handles the NAND controller in i.MX31. The mxc driver
8071 should work for this chip as well.
8072 @end deffn
8073
8074 @deffn {NAND Driver} {mxc}
8075 This driver handles the NAND controller found in Freescale i.MX
8076 chips. It has support for v1 (i.MX27 and i.MX31) and v2 (i.MX35).
8077 The driver takes 3 extra arguments, chip (@option{mx27},
8078 @option{mx31}, @option{mx35}), ecc (@option{noecc}, @option{hwecc})
8079 and optionally if bad block information should be swapped between
8080 main area and spare area (@option{biswap}), defaults to off.
8081 @example
8082 nand device mx35.nand mxc imx35.cpu mx35 hwecc biswap
8083 @end example
8084 @deffn {Command} {mxc biswap} bank_num [enable|disable]
8085 Turns on/off bad block information swapping from main area,
8086 without parameter query status.
8087 @end deffn
8088 @end deffn
8089
8090 @deffn {NAND Driver} {orion}
8091 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
8092 parameter: the address of the controller.
8093 @example
8094 nand device orion 0xd8000000
8095 @end example
8096 These controllers don't define any specialized commands.
8097 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
8098 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
8099 change any behavior.
8100 @end deffn
8101
8102 @deffn {NAND Driver} {s3c2410}
8103 @deffnx {NAND Driver} {s3c2412}
8104 @deffnx {NAND Driver} {s3c2440}
8105 @deffnx {NAND Driver} {s3c2443}
8106 @deffnx {NAND Driver} {s3c6400}
8107 These S3C family controllers don't have any special
8108 @command{nand device} options, and don't define any
8109 specialized commands.
8110 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
8111 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
8112 change any behavior.
8113 @end deffn
8114
8115 @node Flash Programming
8116 @chapter Flash Programming
8117
8118 OpenOCD implements numerous ways to program the target flash, whether internal or external.
8119 Programming can be achieved by either using @ref{programmingusinggdb,,Programming using GDB},
8120 or using the commands given in @ref{flashprogrammingcommands,,Flash Programming Commands}.
8121
8122 @*To simplify using the flash commands directly a jimtcl script is available that handles the programming and verify stage.
8123 OpenOCD will program/verify/reset the target and optionally shutdown.
8124
8125 The script is executed as follows and by default the following actions will be performed.
8126 @enumerate
8127 @item 'init' is executed.
8128 @item 'reset init' is called to reset and halt the target, any 'reset init' scripts are executed.
8129 @item @code{flash write_image} is called to erase and write any flash using the filename given.
8130 @item If the @option{preverify} parameter is given, the target is "verified" first and only flashed if this fails.
8131 @item @code{verify_image} is called if @option{verify} parameter is given.
8132 @item @code{reset run} is called if @option{reset} parameter is given.
8133 @item OpenOCD is shutdown if @option{exit} parameter is given.
8134 @end enumerate
8135
8136 An example of usage is given below. @xref{program}.
8137
8138 @example
8139 # program and verify using elf/hex/s19. verify and reset
8140 # are optional parameters
8141 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
8142 -c "program filename.elf verify reset exit"
8143
8144 # binary files need the flash address passing
8145 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
8146 -c "program filename.bin exit 0x08000000"
8147 @end example
8148
8149 @node PLD/FPGA Commands
8150 @chapter PLD/FPGA Commands
8151 @cindex PLD
8152 @cindex FPGA
8153
8154 Programmable Logic Devices (PLDs) and the more flexible
8155 Field Programmable Gate Arrays (FPGAs) are both types of programmable hardware.
8156 OpenOCD can support programming them.
8157 Although PLDs are generally restrictive (cells are less functional, and
8158 there are no special purpose cells for memory or computational tasks),
8159 they share the same OpenOCD infrastructure.
8160 Accordingly, both are called PLDs here.
8161
8162 @section PLD/FPGA Configuration and Commands
8163
8164 As it does for JTAG TAPs, debug targets, and flash chips (both NOR and NAND),
8165 OpenOCD maintains a list of PLDs available for use in various commands.
8166 Also, each such PLD requires a driver.
8167
8168 They are referenced by the number shown by the @command{pld devices} command,
8169 and new PLDs are defined by @command{pld device driver_name}.
8170
8171 @deffn {Config Command} {pld device} driver_name tap_name [driver_options]
8172 Defines a new PLD device, supported by driver @var{driver_name},
8173 using the TAP named @var{tap_name}.
8174 The driver may make use of any @var{driver_options} to configure its
8175 behavior.
8176 @end deffn
8177
8178 @deffn {Command} {pld devices}
8179 Lists the PLDs and their numbers.
8180 @end deffn
8181
8182 @deffn {Command} {pld load} num filename
8183 Loads the file @file{filename} into the PLD identified by @var{num}.
8184 The file format must be inferred by the driver.
8185 @end deffn
8186
8187 @section PLD/FPGA Drivers, Options, and Commands
8188
8189 Drivers may support PLD-specific options to the @command{pld device}
8190 definition command, and may also define commands usable only with
8191 that particular type of PLD.
8192
8193 @deffn {FPGA Driver} {virtex2} [no_jstart]
8194 Virtex-II is a family of FPGAs sold by Xilinx.
8195 It supports the IEEE 1532 standard for In-System Configuration (ISC).
8196
8197 If @var{no_jstart} is non-zero, the JSTART instruction is not used after
8198 loading the bitstream. While required for Series2, Series3, and Series6, it
8199 breaks bitstream loading on Series7.
8200
8201 @deffn {Command} {virtex2 read_stat} num
8202 Reads and displays the Virtex-II status register (STAT)
8203 for FPGA @var{num}.
8204 @end deffn
8205 @end deffn
8206
8207 @node General Commands
8208 @chapter General Commands
8209 @cindex commands
8210
8211 The commands documented in this chapter here are common commands that
8212 you, as a human, may want to type and see the output of. Configuration type
8213 commands are documented elsewhere.
8214
8215 Intent:
8216 @itemize @bullet
8217 @item @b{Source Of Commands}
8218 @* OpenOCD commands can occur in a configuration script (discussed
8219 elsewhere) or typed manually by a human or supplied programmatically,
8220 or via one of several TCP/IP Ports.
8221
8222 @item @b{From the human}
8223 @* A human should interact with the telnet interface (default port: 4444)
8224 or via GDB (default port 3333).
8225
8226 To issue commands from within a GDB session, use the @option{monitor}
8227 command, e.g. use @option{monitor poll} to issue the @option{poll}
8228 command. All output is relayed through the GDB session.
8229
8230 @item @b{Machine Interface}
8231 The Tcl interface's intent is to be a machine interface. The default Tcl
8232 port is 5555.
8233 @end itemize
8234
8235
8236 @section Server Commands
8237
8238 @deffn {Command} {exit}
8239 Exits the current telnet session.
8240 @end deffn
8241
8242 @deffn {Command} {help} [string]
8243 With no parameters, prints help text for all commands.
8244 Otherwise, prints each helptext containing @var{string}.
8245 Not every command provides helptext.
8246
8247 Configuration commands, and commands valid at any time, are
8248 explicitly noted in parenthesis.
8249 In most cases, no such restriction is listed; this indicates commands
8250 which are only available after the configuration stage has completed.
8251 @end deffn
8252
8253 @deffn {Command} {sleep} msec [@option{busy}]
8254 Wait for at least @var{msec} milliseconds before resuming.
8255 If @option{busy} is passed, busy-wait instead of sleeping.
8256 (This option is strongly discouraged.)
8257 Useful in connection with script files
8258 (@command{script} command and @command{target_name} configuration).
8259 @end deffn
8260
8261 @deffn {Command} {shutdown} [@option{error}]
8262 Close the OpenOCD server, disconnecting all clients (GDB, telnet,
8263 other). If option @option{error} is used, OpenOCD will return a
8264 non-zero exit code to the parent process.
8265
8266 Like any TCL commands, also @command{shutdown} can be redefined, e.g.:
8267 @example
8268 # redefine shutdown
8269 rename shutdown original_shutdown
8270 proc shutdown @{@} @{
8271 puts "This is my implementation of shutdown"
8272 # my own stuff before exit OpenOCD
8273 original_shutdown
8274 @}
8275 @end example
8276 If user types CTRL-C or kills OpenOCD, either the command @command{shutdown}
8277 or its replacement will be automatically executed before OpenOCD exits.
8278 @end deffn
8279
8280 @anchor{debuglevel}
8281 @deffn {Command} {debug_level} [n]
8282 @cindex message level
8283 Display debug level.
8284 If @var{n} (from 0..4) is provided, then set it to that level.
8285 This affects the kind of messages sent to the server log.
8286 Level 0 is error messages only;
8287 level 1 adds warnings;
8288 level 2 adds informational messages;
8289 level 3 adds debugging messages;
8290 and level 4 adds verbose low-level debug messages.
8291 The default is level 2, but that can be overridden on
8292 the command line along with the location of that log
8293 file (which is normally the server's standard output).
8294 @xref{Running}.
8295 @end deffn
8296
8297 @deffn {Command} {echo} [-n] message
8298 Logs a message at "user" priority.
8299 Option "-n" suppresses trailing newline.
8300 @example
8301 echo "Downloading kernel -- please wait"
8302 @end example
8303 @end deffn
8304
8305 @deffn {Command} {log_output} [filename | "default"]
8306 Redirect logging to @var{filename} or set it back to default output;
8307 the default log output channel is stderr.
8308 @end deffn
8309
8310 @deffn {Command} {add_script_search_dir} [directory]
8311 Add @var{directory} to the file/script search path.
8312 @end deffn
8313
8314 @deffn {Config Command} {bindto} [@var{name}]
8315 Specify hostname or IPv4 address on which to listen for incoming
8316 TCP/IP connections. By default, OpenOCD will listen on the loopback
8317 interface only. If your network environment is safe, @code{bindto
8318 0.0.0.0} can be used to cover all available interfaces.
8319 @end deffn
8320
8321 @anchor{targetstatehandling}
8322 @section Target State handling
8323 @cindex reset
8324 @cindex halt
8325 @cindex target initialization
8326
8327 In this section ``target'' refers to a CPU configured as
8328 shown earlier (@pxref{CPU Configuration}).
8329 These commands, like many, implicitly refer to
8330 a current target which is used to perform the
8331 various operations. The current target may be changed
8332 by using @command{targets} command with the name of the
8333 target which should become current.
8334
8335 @deffn {Command} {reg} [(number|name) [(value|'force')]]
8336 Access a single register by @var{number} or by its @var{name}.
8337 The target must generally be halted before access to CPU core
8338 registers is allowed. Depending on the hardware, some other
8339 registers may be accessible while the target is running.
8340
8341 @emph{With no arguments}:
8342 list all available registers for the current target,
8343 showing number, name, size, value, and cache status.
8344 For valid entries, a value is shown; valid entries
8345 which are also dirty (and will be written back later)
8346 are flagged as such.
8347
8348 @emph{With number/name}: display that register's value.
8349 Use @var{force} argument to read directly from the target,
8350 bypassing any internal cache.
8351
8352 @emph{With both number/name and value}: set register's value.
8353 Writes may be held in a writeback cache internal to OpenOCD,
8354 so that setting the value marks the register as dirty instead
8355 of immediately flushing that value. Resuming CPU execution
8356 (including by single stepping) or otherwise activating the
8357 relevant module will flush such values.
8358
8359 Cores may have surprisingly many registers in their
8360 Debug and trace infrastructure:
8361
8362 @example
8363 > reg
8364 ===== ARM registers
8365 (0) r0 (/32): 0x0000D3C2 (dirty)
8366 (1) r1 (/32): 0xFD61F31C
8367 (2) r2 (/32)
8368 ...
8369 (164) ETM_contextid_comparator_mask (/32)
8370 >
8371 @end example
8372 @end deffn
8373
8374 @deffn {Command} {halt} [ms]
8375 @deffnx {Command} {wait_halt} [ms]
8376 The @command{halt} command first sends a halt request to the target,
8377 which @command{wait_halt} doesn't.
8378 Otherwise these behave the same: wait up to @var{ms} milliseconds,
8379 or 5 seconds if there is no parameter, for the target to halt
8380 (and enter debug mode).
8381 Using 0 as the @var{ms} parameter prevents OpenOCD from waiting.
8382
8383 @quotation Warning
8384 On ARM cores, software using the @emph{wait for interrupt} operation
8385 often blocks the JTAG access needed by a @command{halt} command.
8386 This is because that operation also puts the core into a low
8387 power mode by gating the core clock;
8388 but the core clock is needed to detect JTAG clock transitions.
8389
8390 One partial workaround uses adaptive clocking: when the core is
8391 interrupted the operation completes, then JTAG clocks are accepted
8392 at least until the interrupt handler completes.
8393 However, this workaround is often unusable since the processor, board,
8394 and JTAG adapter must all support adaptive JTAG clocking.
8395 Also, it can't work until an interrupt is issued.
8396
8397 A more complete workaround is to not use that operation while you
8398 work with a JTAG debugger.
8399 Tasking environments generally have idle loops where the body is the
8400 @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
8401 (On older cores, it is a coprocessor action;
8402 newer cores have a @option{wfi} instruction.)
8403 Such loops can just remove that operation, at the cost of higher
8404 power consumption (because the CPU is needlessly clocked).
8405 @end quotation
8406
8407 @end deffn
8408
8409 @deffn {Command} {resume} [address]
8410 Resume the target at its current code position,
8411 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
8412 OpenOCD will wait 5 seconds for the target to resume.
8413 @end deffn
8414
8415 @deffn {Command} {step} [address]
8416 Single-step the target at its current code position,
8417 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
8418 @end deffn
8419
8420 @anchor{resetcommand}
8421 @deffn {Command} {reset}
8422 @deffnx {Command} {reset run}
8423 @deffnx {Command} {reset halt}
8424 @deffnx {Command} {reset init}
8425 Perform as hard a reset as possible, using SRST if possible.
8426 @emph{All defined targets will be reset, and target
8427 events will fire during the reset sequence.}
8428
8429 The optional parameter specifies what should
8430 happen after the reset.
8431 If there is no parameter, a @command{reset run} is executed.
8432 The other options will not work on all systems.
8433 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
8434
8435 @itemize @minus
8436 @item @b{run} Let the target run
8437 @item @b{halt} Immediately halt the target
8438 @item @b{init} Immediately halt the target, and execute the reset-init script
8439 @end itemize
8440 @end deffn
8441
8442 @deffn {Command} {soft_reset_halt}
8443 Requesting target halt and executing a soft reset. This is often used
8444 when a target cannot be reset and halted. The target, after reset is
8445 released begins to execute code. OpenOCD attempts to stop the CPU and
8446 then sets the program counter back to the reset vector. Unfortunately
8447 the code that was executed may have left the hardware in an unknown
8448 state.
8449 @end deffn
8450
8451 @deffn {Command} {adapter assert} [signal [assert|deassert signal]]
8452 @deffnx {Command} {adapter deassert} [signal [assert|deassert signal]]
8453 Set values of reset signals.
8454 Without parameters returns current status of the signals.
8455 The @var{signal} parameter values may be
8456 @option{srst}, indicating that srst signal is to be asserted or deasserted,
8457 @option{trst}, indicating that trst signal is to be asserted or deasserted.
8458
8459 The @command{reset_config} command should already have been used
8460 to configure how the board and the adapter treat these two
8461 signals, and to say if either signal is even present.
8462 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
8463 Trying to assert a signal that is not present triggers an error.
8464 If a signal is present on the adapter and not specified in the command,
8465 the signal will not be modified.
8466
8467 @quotation Note
8468 TRST is specially handled.
8469 It actually signifies JTAG's @sc{reset} state.
8470 So if the board doesn't support the optional TRST signal,
8471 or it doesn't support it along with the specified SRST value,
8472 JTAG reset is triggered with TMS and TCK signals
8473 instead of the TRST signal.
8474 And no matter how that JTAG reset is triggered, once
8475 the scan chain enters @sc{reset} with TRST inactive,
8476 TAP @code{post-reset} events are delivered to all TAPs
8477 with handlers for that event.
8478 @end quotation
8479 @end deffn
8480
8481 @anchor{memoryaccess}
8482 @section Memory access commands
8483 @cindex memory access
8484
8485 These commands allow accesses of a specific size to the memory
8486 system. Often these are used to configure the current target in some
8487 special way. For example - one may need to write certain values to the
8488 SDRAM controller to enable SDRAM.
8489
8490 @enumerate
8491 @item Use the @command{targets} (plural) command
8492 to change the current target.
8493 @item In system level scripts these commands are deprecated.
8494 Please use their TARGET object siblings to avoid making assumptions
8495 about what TAP is the current target, or about MMU configuration.
8496 @end enumerate
8497
8498 @deffn {Command} {mdd} [phys] addr [count]
8499 @deffnx {Command} {mdw} [phys] addr [count]
8500 @deffnx {Command} {mdh} [phys] addr [count]
8501 @deffnx {Command} {mdb} [phys] addr [count]
8502 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
8503 64-bit doublewords (@command{mdd}),
8504 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
8505 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
8506 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
8507 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
8508 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
8509 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
8510 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
8511 (If you want to manipulate the data instead of displaying it,
8512 see the @code{mem2array} primitives.)
8513 @end deffn
8514
8515 @deffn {Command} {mwd} [phys] addr doubleword [count]
8516 @deffnx {Command} {mww} [phys] addr word [count]
8517 @deffnx {Command} {mwh} [phys] addr halfword [count]
8518 @deffnx {Command} {mwb} [phys] addr byte [count]
8519 Writes the specified @var{doubleword} (64 bits), @var{word} (32 bits),
8520 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) value,
8521 at the specified address @var{addr}.
8522 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
8523 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
8524 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
8525 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
8526 If @var{count} is specified, fills that many units of consecutive address.
8527 @end deffn
8528
8529 @anchor{imageaccess}
8530 @section Image loading commands
8531 @cindex image loading
8532 @cindex image dumping
8533
8534 @deffn {Command} {dump_image} filename address size
8535 Dump @var{size} bytes of target memory starting at @var{address} to the
8536 binary file named @var{filename}.
8537 @end deffn
8538
8539 @deffn {Command} {fast_load}
8540 Loads an image stored in memory by @command{fast_load_image} to the
8541 current target. Must be preceded by fast_load_image.
8542 @end deffn
8543
8544 @deffn {Command} {fast_load_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}]
8545 Normally you should be using @command{load_image} or GDB load. However, for
8546 testing purposes or when I/O overhead is significant(OpenOCD running on an embedded
8547 host), storing the image in memory and uploading the image to the target
8548 can be a way to upload e.g. multiple debug sessions when the binary does not change.
8549 Arguments are the same as @command{load_image}, but the image is stored in OpenOCD host
8550 memory, i.e. does not affect target. This approach is also useful when profiling
8551 target programming performance as I/O and target programming can easily be profiled
8552 separately.
8553 @end deffn
8554
8555 @deffn {Command} {load_image} filename address [[@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}] @option{min_addr} @option{max_length}]
8556 Load image from file @var{filename} to target memory offset by @var{address} from its load address.
8557 The file format may optionally be specified
8558 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, @option{elf}, or @option{s19}).
8559 In addition the following arguments may be specified:
8560 @var{min_addr} - ignore data below @var{min_addr} (this is w.r.t. to the target's load address + @var{address})
8561 @var{max_length} - maximum number of bytes to load.
8562 @example
8563 proc load_image_bin @{fname foffset address length @} @{
8564 # Load data from fname filename at foffset offset to
8565 # target at address. Load at most length bytes.
8566 load_image $fname [expr $address - $foffset] bin \
8567 $address $length
8568 @}
8569 @end example
8570 @end deffn
8571
8572 @deffn {Command} {test_image} filename [address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]]
8573 Displays image section sizes and addresses
8574 as if @var{filename} were loaded into target memory
8575 starting at @var{address} (defaults to zero).
8576 The file format may optionally be specified
8577 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
8578 @end deffn
8579
8580 @deffn {Command} {verify_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]
8581 Verify @var{filename} against target memory starting at @var{address}.
8582 The file format may optionally be specified
8583 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
8584 This will first attempt a comparison using a CRC checksum, if this fails it will try a binary compare.
8585 @end deffn
8586
8587 @deffn {Command} {verify_image_checksum} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]
8588 Verify @var{filename} against target memory starting at @var{address}.
8589 The file format may optionally be specified
8590 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
8591 This perform a comparison using a CRC checksum only
8592 @end deffn
8593
8594
8595 @section Breakpoint and Watchpoint commands
8596 @cindex breakpoint
8597 @cindex watchpoint
8598
8599 CPUs often make debug modules accessible through JTAG, with
8600 hardware support for a handful of code breakpoints and data
8601 watchpoints.
8602 In addition, CPUs almost always support software breakpoints.
8603
8604 @deffn {Command} {bp} [address len [@option{hw}]]
8605 With no parameters, lists all active breakpoints.
8606 Else sets a breakpoint on code execution starting
8607 at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
8608 This is a software breakpoint, unless @option{hw} is specified
8609 in which case it will be a hardware breakpoint.
8610
8611 (@xref{arm9vectorcatch,,arm9 vector_catch}, or @pxref{xscalevectorcatch,,xscale vector_catch},
8612 for similar mechanisms that do not consume hardware breakpoints.)
8613 @end deffn
8614
8615 @deffn {Command} {rbp} @option{all} | address
8616 Remove the breakpoint at @var{address} or all breakpoints.
8617 @end deffn
8618
8619 @deffn {Command} {rwp} address
8620 Remove data watchpoint on @var{address}
8621 @end deffn
8622
8623 @deffn {Command} {wp} [address len [(@option{r}|@option{w}|@option{a}) [value [mask]]]]
8624 With no parameters, lists all active watchpoints.
8625 Else sets a data watchpoint on data from @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
8626 The watch point is an "access" watchpoint unless
8627 the @option{r} or @option{w} parameter is provided,
8628 defining it as respectively a read or write watchpoint.
8629 If a @var{value} is provided, that value is used when determining if
8630 the watchpoint should trigger. The value may be first be masked
8631 using @var{mask} to mark ``don't care'' fields.
8632 @end deffn
8633
8634
8635 @section Real Time Transfer (RTT)
8636
8637 Real Time Transfer (RTT) is an interface specified by SEGGER based on basic
8638 memory reads and writes to transfer data bidirectionally between target and host.
8639 The specification is independent of the target architecture.
8640 Every target that supports so called "background memory access", which means
8641 that the target memory can be accessed by the debugger while the target is
8642 running, can be used.
8643 This interface is especially of interest for targets without
8644 Serial Wire Output (SWO), such as ARM Cortex-M0, or where semihosting is not
8645 applicable because of real-time constraints.
8646
8647 @quotation Note
8648 The current implementation supports only single target devices.
8649 @end quotation
8650
8651 The data transfer between host and target device is organized through
8652 unidirectional up/down-channels for target-to-host and host-to-target
8653 communication, respectively.
8654
8655 @quotation Note
8656 The current implementation does not respect channel buffer flags.
8657 They are used to determine what happens when writing to a full buffer, for
8658 example.
8659 @end quotation
8660
8661 Channels are exposed via raw TCP/IP connections. One or more RTT servers can be
8662 assigned to each channel to make them accessible to an unlimited number
8663 of TCP/IP connections.
8664
8665 @deffn {Command} {rtt setup} address size ID
8666 Configure RTT for the currently selected target.
8667 Once RTT is started, OpenOCD searches for a control block with the
8668 identifier @var{ID} starting at the memory address @var{address} within the next
8669 @var{size} bytes.
8670 @end deffn
8671
8672 @deffn {Command} {rtt start}
8673 Start RTT.
8674 If the control block location is not known, OpenOCD starts searching for it.
8675 @end deffn
8676
8677 @deffn {Command} {rtt stop}
8678 Stop RTT.
8679 @end deffn
8680
8681 @deffn {Command} {rtt polling_interval} [interval]
8682 Display the polling interval.
8683 If @var{interval} is provided, set the polling interval.
8684 The polling interval determines (in milliseconds) how often the up-channels are
8685 checked for new data.
8686 @end deffn
8687
8688 @deffn {Command} {rtt channels}
8689 Display a list of all channels and their properties.
8690 @end deffn
8691
8692 @deffn {Command} {rtt channellist}
8693 Return a list of all channels and their properties as Tcl list.
8694 The list can be manipulated easily from within scripts.
8695 @end deffn
8696
8697 @deffn {Command} {rtt server start} port channel
8698 Start a TCP server on @var{port} for the channel @var{channel}.
8699 @end deffn
8700
8701 @deffn {Command} {rtt server stop} port
8702 Stop the TCP sever with port @var{port}.
8703 @end deffn
8704
8705 The following example shows how to setup RTT using the SEGGER RTT implementation
8706 on the target device.
8707
8708 @example
8709 resume
8710
8711 rtt setup 0x20000000 2048 "SEGGER RTT"
8712 rtt start
8713
8714 rtt server start 9090 0
8715 @end example
8716
8717 In this example, OpenOCD searches the control block with the ID "SEGGER RTT"
8718 starting at 0x20000000 for 2048 bytes. The RTT channel 0 is exposed through the
8719 TCP/IP port 9090.
8720
8721
8722 @section Misc Commands
8723
8724 @cindex profiling
8725 @deffn {Command} {profile} seconds filename [start end]
8726 Profiling samples the CPU's program counter as quickly as possible,
8727 which is useful for non-intrusive stochastic profiling.
8728 Saves up to 10000 samples in @file{filename} using ``gmon.out''
8729 format. Optional @option{start} and @option{end} parameters allow to
8730 limit the address range.
8731 @end deffn
8732
8733 @deffn {Command} {version}
8734 Displays a string identifying the version of this OpenOCD server.
8735 @end deffn
8736
8737 @deffn {Command} {virt2phys} virtual_address
8738 Requests the current target to map the specified @var{virtual_address}
8739 to its corresponding physical address, and displays the result.
8740 @end deffn
8741
8742 @node Architecture and Core Commands
8743 @chapter Architecture and Core Commands
8744 @cindex Architecture Specific Commands
8745 @cindex Core Specific Commands
8746
8747 Most CPUs have specialized JTAG operations to support debugging.
8748 OpenOCD packages most such operations in its standard command framework.
8749 Some of those operations don't fit well in that framework, so they are
8750 exposed here as architecture or implementation (core) specific commands.
8751
8752 @anchor{armhardwaretracing}
8753 @section ARM Hardware Tracing
8754 @cindex tracing
8755 @cindex ETM
8756 @cindex ETB
8757
8758 CPUs based on ARM cores may include standard tracing interfaces,
8759 based on an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM) which sends voluminous
8760 address and data bus trace records to a ``Trace Port''.
8761
8762 @itemize
8763 @item
8764 Development-oriented boards will sometimes provide a high speed
8765 trace connector for collecting that data, when the particular CPU
8766 supports such an interface.
8767 (The standard connector is a 38-pin Mictor, with both JTAG
8768 and trace port support.)
8769 Those trace connectors are supported by higher end JTAG adapters
8770 and some logic analyzer modules; frequently those modules can
8771 buffer several megabytes of trace data.
8772 Configuring an ETM coupled to such an external trace port belongs
8773 in the board-specific configuration file.
8774 @item
8775 If the CPU doesn't provide an external interface, it probably
8776 has an ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB) on the chip, which is a
8777 dedicated SRAM. 4KBytes is one common ETB size.
8778 Configuring an ETM coupled only to an ETB belongs in the CPU-specific
8779 (target) configuration file, since it works the same on all boards.
8780 @end itemize
8781
8782 ETM support in OpenOCD doesn't seem to be widely used yet.
8783
8784 @quotation Issues
8785 ETM support may be buggy, and at least some @command{etm config}
8786 parameters should be detected by asking the ETM for them.
8787
8788 ETM trigger events could also implement a kind of complex
8789 hardware breakpoint, much more powerful than the simple
8790 watchpoint hardware exported by EmbeddedICE modules.
8791 @emph{Such breakpoints can be triggered even when using the
8792 dummy trace port driver}.
8793
8794 It seems like a GDB hookup should be possible,
8795 as well as tracing only during specific states
8796 (perhaps @emph{handling IRQ 23} or @emph{calls foo()}).
8797
8798 There should be GUI tools to manipulate saved trace data and help
8799 analyse it in conjunction with the source code.
8800 It's unclear how much of a common interface is shared
8801 with the current XScale trace support, or should be
8802 shared with eventual Nexus-style trace module support.
8803
8804 At this writing (November 2009) only ARM7, ARM9, and ARM11 support
8805 for ETM modules is available. The code should be able to
8806 work with some newer cores; but not all of them support
8807 this original style of JTAG access.
8808 @end quotation
8809
8810 @subsection ETM Configuration
8811 ETM setup is coupled with the trace port driver configuration.
8812
8813 @deffn {Config Command} {etm config} target width mode clocking driver
8814 Declares the ETM associated with @var{target}, and associates it
8815 with a given trace port @var{driver}. @xref{traceportdrivers,,Trace Port Drivers}.
8816
8817 Several of the parameters must reflect the trace port capabilities,
8818 which are a function of silicon capabilities (exposed later
8819 using @command{etm info}) and of what hardware is connected to
8820 that port (such as an external pod, or ETB).
8821 The @var{width} must be either 4, 8, or 16,
8822 except with ETMv3.0 and newer modules which may also
8823 support 1, 2, 24, 32, 48, and 64 bit widths.
8824 (With those versions, @command{etm info} also shows whether
8825 the selected port width and mode are supported.)
8826
8827 The @var{mode} must be @option{normal}, @option{multiplexed},
8828 or @option{demultiplexed}.
8829 The @var{clocking} must be @option{half} or @option{full}.
8830
8831 @quotation Warning
8832 With ETMv3.0 and newer, the bits set with the @var{mode} and
8833 @var{clocking} parameters both control the mode.
8834 This modified mode does not map to the values supported by
8835 previous ETM modules, so this syntax is subject to change.
8836 @end quotation
8837
8838 @quotation Note
8839 You can see the ETM registers using the @command{reg} command.
8840 Not all possible registers are present in every ETM.
8841 Most of the registers are write-only, and are used to configure
8842 what CPU activities are traced.
8843 @end quotation
8844 @end deffn
8845
8846 @deffn {Command} {etm info}
8847 Displays information about the current target's ETM.
8848 This includes resource counts from the @code{ETM_CONFIG} register,
8849 as well as silicon capabilities (except on rather old modules).
8850 from the @code{ETM_SYS_CONFIG} register.
8851 @end deffn
8852
8853 @deffn {Command} {etm status}
8854 Displays status of the current target's ETM and trace port driver:
8855 is the ETM idle, or is it collecting data?
8856 Did trace data overflow?
8857 Was it triggered?
8858 @end deffn
8859
8860 @deffn {Command} {etm tracemode} [type context_id_bits cycle_accurate branch_output]
8861 Displays what data that ETM will collect.
8862 If arguments are provided, first configures that data.
8863 When the configuration changes, tracing is stopped
8864 and any buffered trace data is invalidated.
8865
8866 @itemize
8867 @item @var{type} ... describing how data accesses are traced,
8868 when they pass any ViewData filtering that was set up.
8869 The value is one of
8870 @option{none} (save nothing),
8871 @option{data} (save data),
8872 @option{address} (save addresses),
8873 @option{all} (save data and addresses)
8874 @item @var{context_id_bits} ... 0, 8, 16, or 32
8875 @item @var{cycle_accurate} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}
8876 cycle-accurate instruction tracing.
8877 Before ETMv3, enabling this causes much extra data to be recorded.
8878 @item @var{branch_output} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}.
8879 Disable this unless you need to try reconstructing the instruction
8880 trace stream without an image of the code.
8881 @end itemize
8882 @end deffn
8883
8884 @deffn {Command} {etm trigger_debug} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
8885 Displays whether ETM triggering debug entry (like a breakpoint) is
8886 enabled or disabled, after optionally modifying that configuration.
8887 The default behaviour is @option{disable}.
8888 Any change takes effect after the next @command{etm start}.
8889
8890 By using script commands to configure ETM registers, you can make the
8891 processor enter debug state automatically when certain conditions,
8892 more complex than supported by the breakpoint hardware, happen.
8893 @end deffn
8894
8895 @subsection ETM Trace Operation
8896
8897 After setting up the ETM, you can use it to collect data.
8898 That data can be exported to files for later analysis.
8899 It can also be parsed with OpenOCD, for basic sanity checking.
8900
8901 To configure what is being traced, you will need to write
8902 various trace registers using @command{reg ETM_*} commands.
8903 For the definitions of these registers, read ARM publication
8904 @emph{IHI 0014, ``Embedded Trace Macrocell, Architecture Specification''}.
8905 Be aware that most of the relevant registers are write-only,
8906 and that ETM resources are limited. There are only a handful
8907 of address comparators, data comparators, counters, and so on.
8908
8909 Examples of scenarios you might arrange to trace include:
8910
8911 @itemize
8912 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{excluding} subroutines
8913 it calls. Use address range comparators to enable tracing
8914 for instruction access within that function's body.
8915 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{including} subroutines
8916 it calls. Use the sequencer and address comparators to activate
8917 tracing on an ``entered function'' state, then deactivate it by
8918 exiting that state when the function's exit code is invoked.
8919 @item Code flow starting at the fifth invocation of a function,
8920 combining one of the above models with a counter.
8921 @item CPU data accesses to the registers for a particular device,
8922 using address range comparators and the ViewData logic.
8923 @item Such data accesses only during IRQ handling, combining the above
8924 model with sequencer triggers which on entry and exit to the IRQ handler.
8925 @item @emph{... more}
8926 @end itemize
8927
8928 At this writing, September 2009, there are no Tcl utility
8929 procedures to help set up any common tracing scenarios.
8930
8931 @deffn {Command} {etm analyze}
8932 Reads trace data into memory, if it wasn't already present.
8933 Decodes and prints the data that was collected.
8934 @end deffn
8935
8936 @deffn {Command} {etm dump} filename
8937 Stores the captured trace data in @file{filename}.
8938 @end deffn
8939
8940 @deffn {Command} {etm image} filename [base_address] [type]
8941 Opens an image file.
8942 @end deffn
8943
8944 @deffn {Command} {etm load} filename
8945 Loads captured trace data from @file{filename}.
8946 @end deffn
8947
8948 @deffn {Command} {etm start}
8949 Starts trace data collection.
8950 @end deffn
8951
8952 @deffn {Command} {etm stop}
8953 Stops trace data collection.
8954 @end deffn
8955
8956 @anchor{traceportdrivers}
8957 @subsection Trace Port Drivers
8958
8959 To use an ETM trace port it must be associated with a driver.
8960
8961 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} {dummy}
8962 Use the @option{dummy} driver if you are configuring an ETM that's
8963 not connected to anything (on-chip ETB or off-chip trace connector).
8964 @emph{This driver lets OpenOCD talk to the ETM, but it does not expose
8965 any trace data collection.}
8966 @deffn {Config Command} {etm_dummy config} target
8967 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with a dummy driver.
8968 @end deffn
8969 @end deffn
8970
8971 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} {etb}
8972 Use the @option{etb} driver if you are configuring an ETM
8973 to use on-chip ETB memory.
8974 @deffn {Config Command} {etb config} target etb_tap
8975 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with the ETB at @var{etb_tap}.
8976 You can see the ETB registers using the @command{reg} command.
8977 @end deffn
8978 @deffn {Command} {etb trigger_percent} [percent]
8979 This displays, or optionally changes, ETB behavior after the
8980 ETM's configured @emph{trigger} event fires.
8981 It controls how much more trace data is saved after the (single)
8982 trace trigger becomes active.
8983
8984 @itemize
8985 @item The default corresponds to @emph{trace around} usage,
8986 recording 50 percent data before the event and the rest
8987 afterwards.
8988 @item The minimum value of @var{percent} is 2 percent,
8989 recording almost exclusively data before the trigger.
8990 Such extreme @emph{trace before} usage can help figure out
8991 what caused that event to happen.
8992 @item The maximum value of @var{percent} is 100 percent,
8993 recording data almost exclusively after the event.
8994 This extreme @emph{trace after} usage might help sort out
8995 how the event caused trouble.
8996 @end itemize
8997 @c REVISIT allow "break" too -- enter debug mode.
8998 @end deffn
8999
9000 @end deffn
9001
9002 @anchor{armcrosstrigger}
9003 @section ARM Cross-Trigger Interface
9004 @cindex CTI
9005
9006 The ARM Cross-Trigger Interface (CTI) is a generic CoreSight component
9007 that connects event sources like tracing components or CPU cores with each
9008 other through a common trigger matrix (CTM). For ARMv8 architecture, a
9009 CTI is mandatory for core run control and each core has an individual
9010 CTI instance attached to it. OpenOCD has limited support for CTI using
9011 the @emph{cti} group of commands.
9012
9013 @deffn {Command} {cti create} cti_name @option{-dap} dap_name @option{-ap-num} apn @option{-baseaddr} base_address
9014 Creates a CTI instance @var{cti_name} on the DAP instance @var{dap_name} on MEM-AP
9015 @var{apn}. The @var{base_address} must match the base address of the CTI
9016 on the respective MEM-AP. All arguments are mandatory. This creates a
9017 new command @command{$cti_name} which is used for various purposes
9018 including additional configuration.
9019 @end deffn
9020
9021 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name enable} @option{on|off}
9022 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) the CTI.
9023 @end deffn
9024
9025 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name dump}
9026 Displays a register dump of the CTI.
9027 @end deffn
9028
9029 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name write} @var{reg_name} @var{value}
9030 Write @var{value} to the CTI register with the symbolic name @var{reg_name}.
9031 @end deffn
9032
9033 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name read} @var{reg_name}
9034 Print the value read from the CTI register with the symbolic name @var{reg_name}.
9035 @end deffn
9036
9037 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name ack} @var{event}
9038 Acknowledge a CTI @var{event}.
9039 @end deffn
9040
9041 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name channel} @var{channel_number} @var{operation}
9042 Perform a specific channel operation, the possible operations are:
9043 gate, ungate, set, clear and pulse
9044 @end deffn
9045
9046 @deffn {Command} {$cti_name testmode} @option{on|off}
9047 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) the integration test mode
9048 of the CTI.
9049 @end deffn
9050
9051 @deffn {Command} {cti names}
9052 Prints a list of names of all CTI objects created. This command is mainly
9053 useful in TCL scripting.
9054 @end deffn
9055
9056 @section Generic ARM
9057 @cindex ARM
9058
9059 These commands should be available on all ARM processors.
9060 They are available in addition to other core-specific
9061 commands that may be available.
9062
9063 @deffn {Command} {arm core_state} [@option{arm}|@option{thumb}]
9064 Displays the core_state, optionally changing it to process
9065 either @option{arm} or @option{thumb} instructions.
9066 The target may later be resumed in the currently set core_state.
9067 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
9068 that is not currently supported in OpenOCD.)
9069 @end deffn
9070
9071 @deffn {Command} {arm disassemble} address [count [@option{thumb}]]
9072 @cindex disassemble
9073 Disassembles @var{count} instructions starting at @var{address}.
9074 If @var{count} is not specified, a single instruction is disassembled.
9075 If @option{thumb} is specified, or the low bit of the address is set,
9076 Thumb2 (mixed 16/32-bit) instructions are used;
9077 else ARM (32-bit) instructions are used.
9078 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
9079 those instructions are not currently understood by OpenOCD.)
9080
9081 Note that all Thumb instructions are Thumb2 instructions,
9082 so older processors (without Thumb2 support) will still
9083 see correct disassembly of Thumb code.
9084 Also, ThumbEE opcodes are the same as Thumb2,
9085 with a handful of exceptions.
9086 ThumbEE disassembly currently has no explicit support.
9087 @end deffn
9088
9089 @deffn {Command} {arm mcr} pX op1 CRn CRm op2 value
9090 Write @var{value} to a coprocessor @var{pX} register
9091 passing parameters @var{CRn},
9092 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
9093 and using the MCR instruction.
9094 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
9095 an ARM register.)
9096 @end deffn
9097
9098 @deffn {Command} {arm mrc} pX coproc op1 CRn CRm op2
9099 Read a coprocessor @var{pX} register passing parameters @var{CRn},
9100 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
9101 and the MRC instruction.
9102 Returns the result so it can be manipulated by Jim scripts.
9103 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
9104 an ARM register.)
9105 @end deffn
9106
9107 @deffn {Command} {arm reg}
9108 Display a table of all banked core registers, fetching the current value from every
9109 core mode if necessary.
9110 @end deffn
9111
9112 @deffn {Command} {arm semihosting} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9113 @cindex ARM semihosting
9114 Display status of semihosting, after optionally changing that status.
9115
9116 Semihosting allows for code executing on an ARM target to use the
9117 I/O facilities on the host computer i.e. the system where OpenOCD
9118 is running. The target application must be linked against a library
9119 implementing the ARM semihosting convention that forwards operation
9120 requests by using a special SVC instruction that is trapped at the
9121 Supervisor Call vector by OpenOCD.
9122 @end deffn
9123
9124 @deffn {Command} {arm semihosting_cmdline} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9125 @cindex ARM semihosting
9126 Set the command line to be passed to the debugger.
9127
9128 @example
9129 arm semihosting_cmdline argv0 argv1 argv2 ...
9130 @end example
9131
9132 This option lets one set the command line arguments to be passed to
9133 the program. The first argument (argv0) is the program name in a
9134 standard C environment (argv[0]). Depending on the program (not much
9135 programs look at argv[0]), argv0 is ignored and can be any string.
9136 @end deffn
9137
9138 @deffn {Command} {arm semihosting_fileio} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9139 @cindex ARM semihosting
9140 Display status of semihosting fileio, after optionally changing that
9141 status.
9142
9143 Enabling this option forwards semihosting I/O to GDB process using the
9144 File-I/O remote protocol extension. This is especially useful for
9145 interacting with remote files or displaying console messages in the
9146 debugger.
9147 @end deffn
9148
9149 @deffn {Command} {arm semihosting_resexit} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9150 @cindex ARM semihosting
9151 Enable resumable SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT.
9152
9153 When SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT is called outside a debug session,
9154 things are simple, the openocd process calls exit() and passes
9155 the value returned by the target.
9156
9157 When SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT is called during a debug session,
9158 by default execution returns to the debugger, leaving the
9159 debugger in a HALT state, similar to the state entered when
9160 encountering a break.
9161
9162 In some use cases, it is useful to have SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT
9163 return normally, as any semihosting call, and do not break
9164 to the debugger.
9165 The standard allows this to happen, but the condition
9166 to trigger it is a bit obscure ("by performing an RDI_Execute
9167 request or equivalent").
9168
9169 To make the SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT call return normally, enable
9170 this option (default: disabled).
9171 @end deffn
9172
9173 @section ARMv4 and ARMv5 Architecture
9174 @cindex ARMv4
9175 @cindex ARMv5
9176
9177 The ARMv4 and ARMv5 architectures are widely used in embedded systems,
9178 and introduced core parts of the instruction set in use today.
9179 That includes the Thumb instruction set, introduced in the ARMv4T
9180 variant.
9181
9182 @subsection ARM7 and ARM9 specific commands
9183 @cindex ARM7
9184 @cindex ARM9
9185
9186 These commands are specific to ARM7 and ARM9 cores, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T,
9187 ARM9TDMI, ARM920T or ARM926EJ-S.
9188 They are available in addition to the ARM commands,
9189 and any other core-specific commands that may be available.
9190
9191 @deffn {Command} {arm7_9 dbgrq} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9192 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the
9193 EmbeddedIce DBGRQ signal to force entry into debug mode,
9194 instead of breakpoints.
9195 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9196
9197 This should be
9198 safe for all but ARM7TDMI-S cores (like NXP LPC).
9199 This feature is enabled by default on most ARM9 cores,
9200 including ARM9TDMI, ARM920T, and ARM926EJ-S.
9201 @end deffn
9202
9203 @deffn {Command} {arm7_9 dcc_downloads} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9204 @cindex DCC
9205 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the debug communications
9206 channel (DCC) to write larger (>128 byte) amounts of memory.
9207 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9208
9209 DCC downloads offer a huge speed increase, but might be
9210 unsafe, especially with targets running at very low speeds. This command was introduced
9211 with OpenOCD rev. 60, and requires a few bytes of working area.
9212 @end deffn
9213
9214 @deffn {Command} {arm7_9 fast_memory_access} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9215 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of memory writes and reads
9216 that don't check completion of the operation.
9217 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9218
9219 This provides a huge speed increase, especially with USB JTAG
9220 cables (FT2232), but might be unsafe if used with targets running at very low
9221 speeds, like the 32kHz startup clock of an AT91RM9200.
9222 @end deffn
9223
9224 @subsection ARM9 specific commands
9225 @cindex ARM9
9226
9227 ARM9-family cores are built around ARM9TDMI or ARM9E (including ARM9EJS)
9228 integer processors.
9229 Such cores include the ARM920T, ARM926EJ-S, and ARM966.
9230
9231 @c 9-june-2009: tried this on arm920t, it didn't work.
9232 @c no-params always lists nothing caught, and that's how it acts.
9233 @c 23-oct-2009: doesn't work _consistently_ ... as if the ICE
9234 @c versions have different rules about when they commit writes.
9235
9236 @anchor{arm9vectorcatch}
9237 @deffn {Command} {arm9 vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
9238 @cindex vector_catch
9239 Vector Catch hardware provides a sort of dedicated breakpoint
9240 for hardware events such as reset, interrupt, and abort.
9241 You can use this to conserve normal breakpoint resources,
9242 so long as you're not concerned with code that branches directly
9243 to those hardware vectors.
9244
9245 This always finishes by listing the current configuration.
9246 If parameters are provided, it first reconfigures the
9247 vector catch hardware to intercept
9248 @option{all} of the hardware vectors,
9249 @option{none} of them,
9250 or a list with one or more of the following:
9251 @option{reset} @option{undef} @option{swi} @option{pabt} @option{dabt}
9252 @option{irq} @option{fiq}.
9253 @end deffn
9254
9255 @subsection ARM920T specific commands
9256 @cindex ARM920T
9257
9258 These commands are available to ARM920T based CPUs,
9259 which are implementations of the ARMv4T architecture
9260 built using the ARM9TDMI integer core.
9261 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
9262 and ARM9 commands.
9263
9264 @deffn {Command} {arm920t cache_info}
9265 Print information about the caches found. This allows to see whether your target
9266 is an ARM920T (2x16kByte cache) or ARM922T (2x8kByte cache).
9267 @end deffn
9268
9269 @deffn {Command} {arm920t cp15} regnum [value]
9270 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
9271 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
9272 This uses "physical access" and the register number is as
9273 shown in bits 38..33 of table 9-9 in the ARM920T TRM.
9274 (Not all registers can be written.)
9275 @end deffn
9276
9277 @deffn {Command} {arm920t read_cache} filename
9278 Dump the content of ICache and DCache to a file named @file{filename}.
9279 @end deffn
9280
9281 @deffn {Command} {arm920t read_mmu} filename
9282 Dump the content of the ITLB and DTLB to a file named @file{filename}.
9283 @end deffn
9284
9285 @subsection ARM926ej-s specific commands
9286 @cindex ARM926ej-s
9287
9288 These commands are available to ARM926ej-s based CPUs,
9289 which are implementations of the ARMv5TEJ architecture
9290 based on the ARM9EJ-S integer core.
9291 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
9292 and ARM9 commands.
9293
9294 The Feroceon cores also support these commands, although
9295 they are not built from ARM926ej-s designs.
9296
9297 @deffn {Command} {arm926ejs cache_info}
9298 Print information about the caches found.
9299 @end deffn
9300
9301 @subsection ARM966E specific commands
9302 @cindex ARM966E
9303
9304 These commands are available to ARM966 based CPUs,
9305 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
9306 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
9307 and ARM9 commands.
9308
9309 @deffn {Command} {arm966e cp15} regnum [value]
9310 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
9311 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
9312 The six bit @var{regnum} values are bits 37..32 from table 7-2 of the
9313 ARM966E-S TRM.
9314 There is no current control over bits 31..30 from that table,
9315 as required for BIST support.
9316 @end deffn
9317
9318 @subsection XScale specific commands
9319 @cindex XScale
9320
9321 Some notes about the debug implementation on the XScale CPUs:
9322
9323 The XScale CPU provides a special debug-only mini-instruction cache
9324 (mini-IC) in which exception vectors and target-resident debug handler
9325 code are placed by OpenOCD. In order to get access to the CPU, OpenOCD
9326 must point vector 0 (the reset vector) to the entry of the debug
9327 handler. However, this means that the complete first cacheline in the
9328 mini-IC is marked valid, which makes the CPU fetch all exception
9329 handlers from the mini-IC, ignoring the code in RAM.
9330
9331 To address this situation, OpenOCD provides the @code{xscale
9332 vector_table} command, which allows the user to explicitly write
9333 individual entries to either the high or low vector table stored in
9334 the mini-IC.
9335
9336 It is recommended to place a pc-relative indirect branch in the vector
9337 table, and put the branch destination somewhere in memory. Doing so
9338 makes sure the code in the vector table stays constant regardless of
9339 code layout in memory:
9340 @example
9341 _vectors:
9342 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9343 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9344 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9345 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9346 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9347 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9348 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9349 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9350 .org 0x100
9351 .long real_reset_vector
9352 .long real_ui_handler
9353 .long real_swi_handler
9354 .long real_pf_abort
9355 .long real_data_abort
9356 .long 0 /* unused */
9357 .long real_irq_handler
9358 .long real_fiq_handler
9359 @end example
9360
9361 Alternatively, you may choose to keep some or all of the mini-IC
9362 vector table entries synced with those written to memory by your
9363 system software. The mini-IC can not be modified while the processor
9364 is executing, but for each vector table entry not previously defined
9365 using the @code{xscale vector_table} command, OpenOCD will copy the
9366 value from memory to the mini-IC every time execution resumes from a
9367 halt. This is done for both high and low vector tables (although the
9368 table not in use may not be mapped to valid memory, and in this case
9369 that copy operation will silently fail). This means that you will
9370 need to briefly halt execution at some strategic point during system
9371 start-up; e.g., after the software has initialized the vector table,
9372 but before exceptions are enabled. A breakpoint can be used to
9373 accomplish this once the appropriate location in the start-up code has
9374 been identified. A watchpoint over the vector table region is helpful
9375 in finding the location if you're not sure. Note that the same
9376 situation exists any time the vector table is modified by the system
9377 software.
9378
9379 The debug handler must be placed somewhere in the address space using
9380 the @code{xscale debug_handler} command. The allowed locations for the
9381 debug handler are either (0x800 - 0x1fef800) or (0xfe000800 -
9382 0xfffff800). The default value is 0xfe000800.
9383
9384 XScale has resources to support two hardware breakpoints and two
9385 watchpoints. However, the following restrictions on watchpoint
9386 functionality apply: (1) the value and mask arguments to the @code{wp}
9387 command are not supported, (2) the watchpoint length must be a
9388 power of two and not less than four, and can not be greater than the
9389 watchpoint address, and (3) a watchpoint with a length greater than
9390 four consumes all the watchpoint hardware resources. This means that
9391 at any one time, you can have enabled either two watchpoints with a
9392 length of four, or one watchpoint with a length greater than four.
9393
9394 These commands are available to XScale based CPUs,
9395 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
9396
9397 @deffn {Command} {xscale analyze_trace}
9398 Displays the contents of the trace buffer.
9399 @end deffn
9400
9401 @deffn {Command} {xscale cache_clean_address} address
9402 Changes the address used when cleaning the data cache.
9403 @end deffn
9404
9405 @deffn {Command} {xscale cache_info}
9406 Displays information about the CPU caches.
9407 @end deffn
9408
9409 @deffn {Command} {xscale cp15} regnum [value]
9410 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
9411 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
9412 @end deffn
9413
9414 @deffn {Command} {xscale debug_handler} target address
9415 Changes the address used for the specified target's debug handler.
9416 @end deffn
9417
9418 @deffn {Command} {xscale dcache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9419 Enables or disable the CPU's data cache.
9420 @end deffn
9421
9422 @deffn {Command} {xscale dump_trace} filename
9423 Dumps the raw contents of the trace buffer to @file{filename}.
9424 @end deffn
9425
9426 @deffn {Command} {xscale icache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9427 Enables or disable the CPU's instruction cache.
9428 @end deffn
9429
9430 @deffn {Command} {xscale mmu} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9431 Enables or disable the CPU's memory management unit.
9432 @end deffn
9433
9434 @deffn {Command} {xscale trace_buffer} [@option{enable}|@option{disable} [@option{fill} [n] | @option{wrap}]]
9435 Displays the trace buffer status, after optionally
9436 enabling or disabling the trace buffer
9437 and modifying how it is emptied.
9438 @end deffn
9439
9440 @deffn {Command} {xscale trace_image} filename [offset [type]]
9441 Opens a trace image from @file{filename}, optionally rebasing
9442 its segment addresses by @var{offset}.
9443 The image @var{type} may be one of
9444 @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
9445 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19),
9446 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
9447 @end deffn
9448
9449 @anchor{xscalevectorcatch}
9450 @deffn {Command} {xscale vector_catch} [mask]
9451 @cindex vector_catch
9452 Display a bitmask showing the hardware vectors to catch.
9453 If the optional parameter is provided, first set the bitmask to that value.
9454
9455 The mask bits correspond with bit 16..23 in the DCSR:
9456 @example
9457 0x01 Trap Reset
9458 0x02 Trap Undefined Instructions
9459 0x04 Trap Software Interrupt
9460 0x08 Trap Prefetch Abort
9461 0x10 Trap Data Abort
9462 0x20 reserved
9463 0x40 Trap IRQ
9464 0x80 Trap FIQ
9465 @end example
9466 @end deffn
9467
9468 @deffn {Command} {xscale vector_table} [(@option{low}|@option{high}) index value]
9469 @cindex vector_table
9470
9471 Set an entry in the mini-IC vector table. There are two tables: one for
9472 low vectors (at 0x00000000), and one for high vectors (0xFFFF0000), each
9473 holding the 8 exception vectors. @var{index} can be 1-7, because vector 0
9474 points to the debug handler entry and can not be overwritten.
9475 @var{value} holds the 32-bit opcode that is placed in the mini-IC.
9476
9477 Without arguments, the current settings are displayed.
9478
9479 @end deffn
9480
9481 @section ARMv6 Architecture
9482 @cindex ARMv6
9483
9484 @subsection ARM11 specific commands
9485 @cindex ARM11
9486
9487 @deffn {Command} {arm11 memwrite burst} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9488 Displays the value of the memwrite burst-enable flag,
9489 which is enabled by default.
9490 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9491 Burst writes are only used for memory writes larger than 1 word.
9492 They improve performance by assuming that the CPU has read each data
9493 word over JTAG and completed its write before the next word arrives,
9494 instead of polling for a status flag to verify that completion.
9495 This is usually safe, because JTAG runs much slower than the CPU.
9496 @end deffn
9497
9498 @deffn {Command} {arm11 memwrite error_fatal} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9499 Displays the value of the memwrite error_fatal flag,
9500 which is enabled by default.
9501 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9502 When set, certain memory write errors cause earlier transfer termination.
9503 @end deffn
9504
9505 @deffn {Command} {arm11 step_irq_enable} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9506 Displays the value of the flag controlling whether
9507 IRQs are enabled during single stepping;
9508 they are disabled by default.
9509 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that.
9510 @end deffn
9511
9512 @deffn {Command} {arm11 vcr} [value]
9513 @cindex vector_catch
9514 Displays the value of the @emph{Vector Catch Register (VCR)},
9515 coprocessor 14 register 7.
9516 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
9517
9518 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
9519 for certain hardware events.
9520 The specific bit values are core-specific (as in fact is using
9521 coprocessor 14 register 7 itself) but all current ARM11
9522 cores @emph{except the ARM1176} use the same six bits.
9523 @end deffn
9524
9525 @section ARMv7 and ARMv8 Architecture
9526 @cindex ARMv7
9527 @cindex ARMv8
9528
9529 @subsection ARMv7-A specific commands
9530 @cindex Cortex-A
9531
9532 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a cache_info}
9533 display information about target caches
9534 @end deffn
9535
9536 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a dacrfixup} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
9537 Work around issues with software breakpoints when the program text is
9538 mapped read-only by the operating system. This option sets the CP15 DACR
9539 to "all-manager" to bypass MMU permission checks on memory access.
9540 Defaults to 'off'.
9541 @end deffn
9542
9543 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a dbginit}
9544 Initialize core debug
9545 Enables debug by unlocking the Software Lock and clearing sticky powerdown indications
9546 @end deffn
9547
9548 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a smp} [on|off]
9549 Display/set the current SMP mode
9550 @end deffn
9551
9552 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a smp_gdb} [core_id]
9553 Display/set the current core displayed in GDB
9554 @end deffn
9555
9556 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
9557 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping
9558 @end deffn
9559
9560 @deffn {Command} {cache_config l2x} [base way]
9561 configure l2x cache
9562 @end deffn
9563
9564 @deffn {Command} {cortex_a mmu dump} [@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{addr} address [@option{num_entries}]]
9565 Dump the MMU translation table from TTB0 or TTB1 register, or from physical
9566 memory location @var{address}. When dumping the table from @var{address}, print at most
9567 @var{num_entries} page table entries. @var{num_entries} is optional, if omitted, the maximum
9568 possible (4096) entries are printed.
9569 @end deffn
9570
9571 @subsection ARMv7-R specific commands
9572 @cindex Cortex-R
9573
9574 @deffn {Command} {cortex_r4 dbginit}
9575 Initialize core debug
9576 Enables debug by unlocking the Software Lock and clearing sticky powerdown indications
9577 @end deffn
9578
9579 @deffn {Command} {cortex_r4 maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
9580 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping
9581 @end deffn
9582
9583
9584 @subsection ARM CoreSight TPIU and SWO specific commands
9585 @cindex tracing
9586 @cindex SWO
9587 @cindex SWV
9588 @cindex TPIU
9589
9590 ARM CoreSight provides several modules to generate debugging
9591 information internally (ITM, DWT and ETM). Their output is directed
9592 through TPIU or SWO modules to be captured externally either on an SWO pin (this
9593 configuration is called SWV) or on a synchronous parallel trace port.
9594
9595 ARM CoreSight provides independent HW blocks named TPIU and SWO each with its
9596 own functionality. Embedded in Cortex-M3 and M4, ARM provides an optional HW
9597 block that includes both TPIU and SWO functionalities and is again named TPIU,
9598 which causes quite some confusion.
9599 The registers map of all the TPIU and SWO implementations allows using a single
9600 driver that detects at runtime the features available.
9601
9602 The @command{tpiu} is used for either TPIU or SWO.
9603 A convenient alias @command{swo} is available to help distinguish, in scripts,
9604 the commands for SWO from the commands for TPIU.
9605
9606 @deffn {Command} {swo} ...
9607 Alias of @command{tpiu ...}. Can be used in scripts to distinguish the commands
9608 for SWO from the commands for TPIU.
9609 @end deffn
9610
9611 @deffn {Command} {tpiu create} tpiu_name configparams...
9612 Creates a TPIU or a SWO object. The two commands are equivalent.
9613 Add the object in a list and add new commands (@command{@var{tpiu_name}})
9614 which are used for various purposes including additional configuration.
9615
9616 @itemize @bullet
9617 @item @var{tpiu_name} -- the name of the TPIU or SWO object.
9618 This name is also used to create the object's command, referred to here
9619 as @command{$tpiu_name}, and in other places where the TPIU or SWO needs to be identified.
9620 @item @var{configparams} -- all parameters accepted by @command{$tpiu_name configure} are permitted.
9621
9622 You @emph{must} set here the AP and MEM_AP base_address through @code{-dap @var{dap_name}},
9623 @code{-ap-num @var{ap_number}} and @code{-baseaddr @var{base_address}}.
9624 @end itemize
9625 @end deffn
9626
9627 @deffn {Command} {tpiu names}
9628 Lists all the TPIU or SWO objects created so far. The two commands are equivalent.
9629 @end deffn
9630
9631 @deffn {Command} {tpiu init}
9632 Initialize all registered TPIU and SWO. The two commands are equivalent.
9633 These commands are used internally during initialization. They can be issued
9634 at any time after the initialization, too.
9635 @end deffn
9636
9637 @deffn {Command} {$tpiu_name cget} queryparm
9638 Each configuration parameter accepted by @command{$tpiu_name configure} can be
9639 individually queried, to return its current value.
9640 The @var{queryparm} is a parameter name accepted by that command, such as @code{-dap}.
9641 @end deffn
9642
9643 @deffn {Command} {$tpiu_name configure} configparams...
9644 The options accepted by this command may also be specified as parameters
9645 to @command{tpiu create}. Their values can later be queried one at a time by
9646 using the @command{$tpiu_name cget} command.
9647
9648 @itemize @bullet
9649 @item @code{-dap} @var{dap_name} -- names the DAP used to access this
9650 TPIU. @xref{dapdeclaration,,DAP declaration}, on how to create and manage DAP instances.
9651
9652 @item @code{-ap-num} @var{ap_number} -- sets DAP access port for TPIU,
9653 @var{ap_number} is the numeric index of the DAP AP the TPIU is connected to.
9654
9655 @item @code{-baseaddr} @var{base_address} -- sets the TPIU @var{base_address} where
9656 to access the TPIU in the DAP AP memory space.
9657
9658 @item @code{-protocol} (@option{sync}|@option{uart}|@option{manchester}) -- sets the
9659 protocol used for trace data:
9660 @itemize @minus
9661 @item @option{sync} -- synchronous parallel trace output mode, using @var{port_width}
9662 data bits (default);
9663 @item @option{uart} -- use asynchronous SWO mode with NRZ (same as regular UART 8N1) coding;
9664 @item @option{manchester} -- use asynchronous SWO mode with Manchester coding.
9665 @end itemize
9666
9667 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} @var{event_body} -- assigns an event handler,
9668 a TCL string which is evaluated when the event is triggered. The events
9669 @code{pre-enable}, @code{post-enable}, @code{pre-disable} and @code{post-disable}
9670 are defined for TPIU/SWO.
9671 A typical use case for the event @code{pre-enable} is to enable the trace clock
9672 of the TPIU.
9673
9674 @item @code{-output} (@option{external}|@option{:}@var{port}|@var{filename}|@option{-}) -- specifies
9675 the destination of the trace data:
9676 @itemize @minus
9677 @item @option{external} -- configure TPIU/SWO to let user capture trace
9678 output externally, either with an additional UART or with a logic analyzer (default);
9679 @item @option{-} -- configure TPIU/SWO and debug adapter to gather trace data
9680 and forward it to @command{tcl_trace} command;
9681 @item @option{:}@var{port} -- configure TPIU/SWO and debug adapter to gather
9682 trace data, open a TCP server at port @var{port} and send the trace data to
9683 each connected client;
9684 @item @var{filename} -- configure TPIU/SWO and debug adapter to
9685 gather trace data and append it to @var{filename}, which can be
9686 either a regular file or a named pipe.
9687 @end itemize
9688
9689 @item @code{-traceclk} @var{TRACECLKIN_freq} -- mandatory parameter.
9690 Specifies the frequency in Hz of the trace clock. For the TPIU embedded in
9691 Cortex-M3 or M4, this is usually the same frequency as HCLK. For protocol
9692 @option{sync} this is twice the frequency of the pin data rate.
9693
9694 @item @code{-pin-freq} @var{trace_freq} -- specifies the expected data rate
9695 in Hz of the SWO pin. Parameter used only on protocols @option{uart} and
9696 @option{manchester}. Can be omitted to let the adapter driver select the
9697 maximum supported rate automatically.
9698
9699 @item @code{-port-width} @var{port_width} -- sets to @var{port_width} the width
9700 of the synchronous parallel port used for trace output. Parameter used only on
9701 protocol @option{sync}. If not specified, default value is @var{1}.
9702
9703 @item @code{-formatter} (@option{0}|@option{1}) -- specifies if the formatter
9704 should be enabled. Parameter used only on protocol @option{sync}. If not specified,
9705 default value is @var{0}.
9706 @end itemize
9707 @end deffn
9708
9709 @deffn {Command} {$tpiu_name enable}
9710 Uses the parameters specified by the previous @command{$tpiu_name configure}
9711 to configure and enable the TPIU or the SWO.
9712 If required, the adapter is also configured and enabled to receive the trace
9713 data.
9714 This command can be used before @command{init}, but it will take effect only
9715 after the @command{init}.
9716 @end deffn
9717
9718 @deffn {Command} {$tpiu_name disable}
9719 Disable the TPIU or the SWO, terminating the receiving of the trace data.
9720 @end deffn
9721
9722
9723
9724 Example usage:
9725 @enumerate
9726 @item STM32L152 board is programmed with an application that configures
9727 PLL to provide core clock with 24MHz frequency; to use ITM output it's
9728 enough to:
9729 @example
9730 #include <libopencm3/cm3/itm.h>
9731 ...
9732 ITM_STIM8(0) = c;
9733 ...
9734 @end example
9735 (the most obvious way is to use the first stimulus port for printf,
9736 for that this ITM_STIM8 assignment can be used inside _write(); to make it
9737 blocking to avoid data loss, add @code{while (!(ITM_STIM8(0) &
9738 ITM_STIM_FIFOREADY));});
9739 @item An FT2232H UART is connected to the SWO pin of the board;
9740 @item Commands to configure UART for 12MHz baud rate:
9741 @example
9742 $ setserial /dev/ttyUSB1 spd_cust divisor 5
9743 $ stty -F /dev/ttyUSB1 38400
9744 @end example
9745 (FT2232H's base frequency is 60MHz, spd_cust allows to alias 38400
9746 baud with our custom divisor to get 12MHz)
9747 @item @code{itmdump -f /dev/ttyUSB1 -d1}
9748 @item OpenOCD invocation line:
9749 @example
9750 openocd -f interface/stlink.cfg \
9751 -c "transport select hla_swd" \
9752 -f target/stm32l1.cfg \
9753 -c "stm32l1.tpiu configure -protocol uart" \
9754 -c "stm32l1.tpiu configure -traceclk 24000000 -pin-freq 12000000" \
9755 -c "stm32l1.tpiu enable"
9756 @end example
9757 @end enumerate
9758
9759 @subsection ARMv7-M specific commands
9760 @cindex tracing
9761 @cindex SWO
9762 @cindex SWV
9763 @cindex ITM
9764 @cindex ETM
9765
9766 @deffn {Command} {itm port} @var{port} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
9767 Enable or disable trace output for ITM stimulus @var{port} (counting
9768 from 0). Port 0 is enabled on target creation automatically.
9769 @end deffn
9770
9771 @deffn {Command} {itm ports} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
9772 Enable or disable trace output for all ITM stimulus ports.
9773 @end deffn
9774
9775 @subsection Cortex-M specific commands
9776 @cindex Cortex-M
9777
9778 @deffn {Command} {cortex_m maskisr} (@option{auto}|@option{on}|@option{off}|@option{steponly})
9779 Control masking (disabling) interrupts during target step/resume.
9780
9781 The @option{auto} option handles interrupts during stepping in a way that they
9782 get served but don't disturb the program flow. The step command first allows
9783 pending interrupt handlers to execute, then disables interrupts and steps over
9784 the next instruction where the core was halted. After the step interrupts
9785 are enabled again. If the interrupt handlers don't complete within 500ms,
9786 the step command leaves with the core running.
9787
9788 The @option{steponly} option disables interrupts during single-stepping but
9789 enables them during normal execution. This can be used as a partial workaround
9790 for 702596 erratum in Cortex-M7 r0p1. See "Cortex-M7 (AT610) and Cortex-M7 with
9791 FPU (AT611) Software Developer Errata Notice" from ARM for further details.
9792
9793 Note that a free hardware (FPB) breakpoint is required for the @option{auto}
9794 option. If no breakpoint is available at the time of the step, then the step
9795 is taken with interrupts enabled, i.e. the same way the @option{off} option
9796 does.
9797
9798 Default is @option{auto}.
9799 @end deffn
9800
9801 @deffn {Command} {cortex_m vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
9802 @cindex vector_catch
9803 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
9804 for certain hardware events.
9805
9806 Parameters request interception of
9807 @option{all} of these hardware event vectors,
9808 @option{none} of them,
9809 or one or more of the following:
9810 @option{hard_err} for a HardFault exception;
9811 @option{mm_err} for a MemManage exception;
9812 @option{bus_err} for a BusFault exception;
9813 @option{irq_err},
9814 @option{state_err},
9815 @option{chk_err}, or
9816 @option{nocp_err} for various UsageFault exceptions; or
9817 @option{reset}.
9818 If NVIC setup code does not enable them,
9819 MemManage, BusFault, and UsageFault exceptions
9820 are mapped to HardFault.
9821 UsageFault checks for
9822 divide-by-zero and unaligned access
9823 must also be explicitly enabled.
9824
9825 This finishes by listing the current vector catch configuration.
9826 @end deffn
9827
9828 @deffn {Command} {cortex_m reset_config} (@option{sysresetreq}|@option{vectreset})
9829 Control reset handling if hardware srst is not fitted
9830 @xref{reset_config,,reset_config}.
9831
9832 @itemize @minus
9833 @item @option{sysresetreq} use AIRCR SYSRESETREQ to reset system.
9834 @item @option{vectreset} use AIRCR VECTRESET to reset system (default).
9835 @end itemize
9836
9837 Using @option{vectreset} is a safe option for Cortex-M3, M4 and M7 cores.
9838 This however has the disadvantage of only resetting the core, all peripherals
9839 are unaffected. A solution would be to use a @code{reset-init} event handler
9840 to manually reset the peripherals.
9841 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
9842
9843 Cortex-M0, M0+ and M1 do not support @option{vectreset}, use @option{sysresetreq}
9844 instead.
9845 @end deffn
9846
9847 @subsection ARMv8-A specific commands
9848 @cindex ARMv8-A
9849 @cindex aarch64
9850
9851 @deffn {Command} {aarch64 cache_info}
9852 Display information about target caches
9853 @end deffn
9854
9855 @deffn {Command} {aarch64 dbginit}
9856 This command enables debugging by clearing the OS Lock and sticky power-down and reset
9857 indications. It also establishes the expected, basic cross-trigger configuration the aarch64
9858 target code relies on. In a configuration file, the command would typically be called from a
9859 @code{reset-end} or @code{reset-deassert-post} handler, to re-enable debugging after a system reset.
9860 However, normally it is not necessary to use the command at all.
9861 @end deffn
9862
9863 @deffn {Command} {aarch64 disassemble} address [count]
9864 @cindex disassemble
9865 Disassembles @var{count} instructions starting at @var{address}.
9866 If @var{count} is not specified, a single instruction is disassembled.
9867 @end deffn
9868
9869 @deffn {Command} {aarch64 smp} [on|off]
9870 Display, enable or disable SMP handling mode. The state of SMP handling influences the way targets in an SMP group
9871 are handled by the run control. With SMP handling enabled, issuing halt or resume to one core will trigger
9872 halting or resuming of all cores in the group. The command @code{target smp} defines which targets are in the SMP
9873 group. With SMP handling disabled, all targets need to be treated individually.
9874 @end deffn
9875
9876 @deffn {Command} {aarch64 maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
9877 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping. The default configuration is
9878 @option{on}.
9879 @end deffn
9880
9881 @deffn {Command} {$target_name catch_exc} [@option{off}|@option{sec_el1}|@option{sec_el3}|@option{nsec_el1}|@option{nsec_el2}]+
9882 Cause @command{$target_name} to halt when an exception is taken. Any combination of
9883 Secure (sec) EL1/EL3 or Non-Secure (nsec) EL1/EL2 is valid. The target
9884 @command{$target_name} will halt before taking the exception. In order to resume
9885 the target, the exception catch must be disabled again with @command{$target_name catch_exc off}.
9886 Issuing the command without options prints the current configuration.
9887 @end deffn
9888
9889 @section EnSilica eSi-RISC Architecture
9890
9891 eSi-RISC is a highly configurable microprocessor architecture for embedded systems
9892 provided by EnSilica. (See: @url{http://www.ensilica.com/risc-ip/}.)
9893
9894 @subsection eSi-RISC Configuration
9895
9896 @deffn {Command} {esirisc cache_arch} (@option{harvard}|@option{von_neumann})
9897 Configure the caching architecture. Targets with the @code{UNIFIED_ADDRESS_SPACE}
9898 option disabled employ a Harvard architecture. By default, @option{von_neumann} is assumed.
9899 @end deffn
9900
9901 @deffn {Command} {esirisc hwdc} (@option{all}|@option{none}|mask ...)
9902 Configure hardware debug control. The HWDC register controls which exceptions return
9903 control back to the debugger. Possible masks are @option{all}, @option{none},
9904 @option{reset}, @option{interrupt}, @option{syscall}, @option{error}, and @option{debug}.
9905 By default, @option{reset}, @option{error}, and @option{debug} are enabled.
9906 @end deffn
9907
9908 @subsection eSi-RISC Operation
9909
9910 @deffn {Command} {esirisc flush_caches}
9911 Flush instruction and data caches. This command requires that the target is halted
9912 when the command is issued and configured with an instruction or data cache.
9913 @end deffn
9914
9915 @subsection eSi-Trace Configuration
9916
9917 eSi-RISC targets may be configured with support for instruction tracing. Trace
9918 data may be written to an in-memory buffer or FIFO. If a FIFO is configured, DMA
9919 is typically employed to move trace data off-device using a high-speed
9920 peripheral (eg. SPI). Collected trace data is encoded in one of three different
9921 formats. At a minimum, @command{esirisc trace buffer} or @command{esirisc trace
9922 fifo} must be issued along with @command{esirisc trace format} before trace data
9923 can be collected.
9924
9925 OpenOCD provides rudimentary analysis of collected trace data. If more detail is
9926 needed, collected trace data can be dumped to a file and processed by external
9927 tooling.
9928
9929 @quotation Issues
9930 OpenOCD is unable to process trace data sent to a FIFO. A potential workaround
9931 for this issue is to configure DMA to copy trace data to an in-memory buffer,
9932 which can then be passed to the @command{esirisc trace analyze} and
9933 @command{esirisc trace dump} commands.
9934
9935 It is possible to corrupt trace data when using a FIFO if the peripheral
9936 responsible for draining data from the FIFO is not fast enough. This can be
9937 managed by enabling flow control, however this can impact timing-sensitive
9938 software operation on the CPU.
9939 @end quotation
9940
9941 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace buffer} address size [@option{wrap}]
9942 Configure trace buffer using the provided address and size. If the @option{wrap}
9943 option is specified, trace collection will continue once the end of the buffer
9944 is reached. By default, wrap is disabled.
9945 @end deffn
9946
9947 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace fifo} address
9948 Configure trace FIFO using the provided address.
9949 @end deffn
9950
9951 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace flow_control} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
9952 Enable or disable stalling the CPU to collect trace data. By default, flow
9953 control is disabled.
9954 @end deffn
9955
9956 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace format} (@option{full}|@option{branch}|@option{icache}) pc_bits
9957 Configure trace format and number of PC bits to be captured. @option{pc_bits}
9958 must be within 1 and 31 as the LSB is not collected. If external tooling is used
9959 to analyze collected trace data, these values must match.
9960
9961 Supported trace formats:
9962 @itemize
9963 @item @option{full} capture full trace data, allowing execution history and
9964 timing to be determined.
9965 @item @option{branch} capture taken branch instructions and branch target
9966 addresses.
9967 @item @option{icache} capture instruction cache misses.
9968 @end itemize
9969 @end deffn
9970
9971 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace trigger start} (@option{condition}) [start_data start_mask]
9972 Configure trigger start condition using the provided start data and mask. A
9973 brief description of each condition is provided below; for more detail on how
9974 these values are used, see the eSi-RISC Architecture Manual.
9975
9976 Supported conditions:
9977 @itemize
9978 @item @option{none} manual tracing (see @command{esirisc trace start}).
9979 @item @option{pc} start tracing if the PC matches start data and mask.
9980 @item @option{load} start tracing if the effective address of a load
9981 instruction matches start data and mask.
9982 @item @option{store} start tracing if the effective address of a store
9983 instruction matches start data and mask.
9984 @item @option{exception} start tracing if the EID of an exception matches start
9985 data and mask.
9986 @item @option{eret} start tracing when an @code{ERET} instruction is executed.
9987 @item @option{wait} start tracing when a @code{WAIT} instruction is executed.
9988 @item @option{stop} start tracing when a @code{STOP} instruction is executed.
9989 @item @option{high} start tracing when an external signal is a logical high.
9990 @item @option{low} start tracing when an external signal is a logical low.
9991 @end itemize
9992 @end deffn
9993
9994 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace trigger stop} (@option{condition}) [stop_data stop_mask]
9995 Configure trigger stop condition using the provided stop data and mask. A brief
9996 description of each condition is provided below; for more detail on how these
9997 values are used, see the eSi-RISC Architecture Manual.
9998
9999 Supported conditions:
10000 @itemize
10001 @item @option{none} manual tracing (see @command{esirisc trace stop}).
10002 @item @option{pc} stop tracing if the PC matches stop data and mask.
10003 @item @option{load} stop tracing if the effective address of a load
10004 instruction matches stop data and mask.
10005 @item @option{store} stop tracing if the effective address of a store
10006 instruction matches stop data and mask.
10007 @item @option{exception} stop tracing if the EID of an exception matches stop
10008 data and mask.
10009 @item @option{eret} stop tracing when an @code{ERET} instruction is executed.
10010 @item @option{wait} stop tracing when a @code{WAIT} instruction is executed.
10011 @item @option{stop} stop tracing when a @code{STOP} instruction is executed.
10012 @end itemize
10013 @end deffn
10014
10015 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace trigger delay} (@option{trigger}) [cycles]
10016 Configure trigger start/stop delay in clock cycles.
10017
10018 Supported triggers:
10019 @itemize
10020 @item @option{none} no delay to start or stop collection.
10021 @item @option{start} delay @option{cycles} after trigger to start collection.
10022 @item @option{stop} delay @option{cycles} after trigger to stop collection.
10023 @item @option{both} delay @option{cycles} after both triggers to start or stop
10024 collection.
10025 @end itemize
10026 @end deffn
10027
10028 @subsection eSi-Trace Operation
10029
10030 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace init}
10031 Initialize trace collection. This command must be called any time the
10032 configuration changes. If a trace buffer has been configured, the contents will
10033 be overwritten when trace collection starts.
10034 @end deffn
10035
10036 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace info}
10037 Display trace configuration.
10038 @end deffn
10039
10040 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace status}
10041 Display trace collection status.
10042 @end deffn
10043
10044 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace start}
10045 Start manual trace collection.
10046 @end deffn
10047
10048 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace stop}
10049 Stop manual trace collection.
10050 @end deffn
10051
10052 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace analyze} [address size]
10053 Analyze collected trace data. This command may only be used if a trace buffer
10054 has been configured. If a trace FIFO has been configured, trace data must be
10055 copied to an in-memory buffer identified by the @option{address} and
10056 @option{size} options using DMA.
10057 @end deffn
10058
10059 @deffn {Command} {esirisc trace dump} [address size] @file{filename}
10060 Dump collected trace data to file. This command may only be used if a trace
10061 buffer has been configured. If a trace FIFO has been configured, trace data must
10062 be copied to an in-memory buffer identified by the @option{address} and
10063 @option{size} options using DMA.
10064 @end deffn
10065
10066 @section Intel Architecture
10067
10068 Intel Quark X10xx is the first product in the Quark family of SoCs. It is an IA-32
10069 (Pentium x86 ISA) compatible SoC. The core CPU in the X10xx is codenamed Lakemont.
10070 Lakemont version 1 (LMT1) is used in X10xx. The CPU TAP (Lakemont TAP) is used for
10071 software debug and the CLTAP is used for SoC level operations.
10072 Useful docs are here: https://communities.intel.com/community/makers/documentation
10073 @itemize
10074 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 OpenOCD/GDB/Eclipse App Note (web search for doc num 330015)
10075 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Debug Operations User Guide (web search for doc num 329866)
10076 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Datasheet (web search for doc num 329676)
10077 @end itemize
10078
10079 @subsection x86 32-bit specific commands
10080 The three main address spaces for x86 are memory, I/O and configuration space.
10081 These commands allow a user to read and write to the 64Kbyte I/O address space.
10082
10083 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 idw} address
10084 Display the contents of a 32-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10085 @end deffn
10086
10087 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 idh} address
10088 Display the contents of a 16-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10089 @end deffn
10090
10091 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 idb} address
10092 Display the contents of a 8-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10093 @end deffn
10094
10095 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 iww} address
10096 Write the contents of a 32-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10097 @end deffn
10098
10099 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 iwh} address
10100 Write the contents of a 16-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10101 @end deffn
10102
10103 @deffn {Command} {x86_32 iwb} address
10104 Write the contents of a 8-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
10105 @end deffn
10106
10107 @section OpenRISC Architecture
10108
10109 The OpenRISC CPU is a soft core. It is used in a programmable SoC which can be
10110 configured with any of the TAP / Debug Unit available.
10111
10112 @subsection TAP and Debug Unit selection commands
10113 @deffn {Command} {tap_select} (@option{vjtag}|@option{mohor}|@option{xilinx_bscan})
10114 Select between the Altera Virtual JTAG , Xilinx Virtual JTAG and Mohor TAP.
10115 @end deffn
10116 @deffn {Command} {du_select} (@option{adv}|@option{mohor}) [option]
10117 Select between the Advanced Debug Interface and the classic one.
10118
10119 An option can be passed as a second argument to the debug unit.
10120
10121 When using the Advanced Debug Interface, option = 1 means the RTL core is
10122 configured with ADBG_USE_HISPEED = 1. This configuration skips status checking
10123 between bytes while doing read or write bursts.
10124 @end deffn
10125
10126 @subsection Registers commands
10127 @deffn {Command} {addreg} [name] [address] [feature] [reg_group]
10128 Add a new register in the cpu register list. This register will be
10129 included in the generated target descriptor file.
10130
10131 @strong{[feature]} must be "org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group[0..10]".
10132
10133 @strong{[reg_group]} can be anything. The default register list defines "system",
10134 "dmmu", "immu", "dcache", "icache", "mac", "debug", "perf", "power", "pic"
10135 and "timer" groups.
10136
10137 @emph{example:}
10138 @example
10139 addreg rtest 0x1234 org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group0 system
10140 @end example
10141
10142 @end deffn
10143
10144 @section RISC-V Architecture
10145
10146 @uref{http://riscv.org/, RISC-V} is a free and open ISA. OpenOCD supports JTAG
10147 debug of RV32 and RV64 cores in heterogeneous multicore systems of up to 32
10148 harts. (It's possible to increase this limit to 1024 by changing
10149 RISCV_MAX_HARTS in riscv.h.) OpenOCD primarily supports 0.13 of the RISC-V
10150 Debug Specification, but there is also support for legacy targets that
10151 implement version 0.11.
10152
10153 @subsection RISC-V Terminology
10154
10155 A @emph{hart} is a hardware thread. A hart may share resources (eg. FPU) with
10156 another hart, or may be a separate core. RISC-V treats those the same, and
10157 OpenOCD exposes each hart as a separate core.
10158
10159 @subsection RISC-V Debug Configuration Commands
10160
10161 @deffn {Command} {riscv expose_csrs} n0[-m0][,n1[-m1]]...
10162 Configure a list of inclusive ranges for CSRs to expose in addition to the
10163 standard ones. This must be executed before `init`.
10164
10165 By default OpenOCD attempts to expose only CSRs that are mentioned in a spec,
10166 and then only if the corresponding extension appears to be implemented. This
10167 command can be used if OpenOCD gets this wrong, or a target implements custom
10168 CSRs.
10169 @end deffn
10170
10171 @deffn {Command} {riscv expose_custom} n0[-m0][,n1[-m1]]...
10172 The RISC-V Debug Specification allows targets to expose custom registers
10173 through abstract commands. (See Section 3.5.1.1 in that document.) This command
10174 configures a list of inclusive ranges of those registers to expose. Number 0
10175 indicates the first custom register, whose abstract command number is 0xc000.
10176 This command must be executed before `init`.
10177 @end deffn
10178
10179 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_command_timeout_sec} [seconds]
10180 Set the wall-clock timeout (in seconds) for individual commands. The default
10181 should work fine for all but the slowest targets (eg. simulators).
10182 @end deffn
10183
10184 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_reset_timeout_sec} [seconds]
10185 Set the maximum time to wait for a hart to come out of reset after reset is
10186 deasserted.
10187 @end deffn
10188
10189 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_prefer_sba} on|off
10190 When on, prefer to use System Bus Access to access memory. When off (default),
10191 prefer to use the Program Buffer to access memory.
10192 @end deffn
10193
10194 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_enable_virtual} on|off
10195 When on, memory accesses are performed on physical or virtual memory depending
10196 on the current system configuration. When off (default), all memory accessses are performed
10197 on physical memory.
10198 @end deffn
10199
10200 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_enable_virt2phys} on|off
10201 When on (default), memory accesses are performed on physical or virtual memory
10202 depending on the current satp configuration. When off, all memory accessses are
10203 performed on physical memory.
10204 @end deffn
10205
10206 @deffn {Command} {riscv resume_order} normal|reversed
10207 Some software assumes all harts are executing nearly continuously. Such
10208 software may be sensitive to the order that harts are resumed in. On harts
10209 that don't support hasel, this option allows the user to choose the order the
10210 harts are resumed in. If you are using this option, it's probably masking a
10211 race condition problem in your code.
10212
10213 Normal order is from lowest hart index to highest. This is the default
10214 behavior. Reversed order is from highest hart index to lowest.
10215 @end deffn
10216
10217 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_ir} (@option{idcode}|@option{dtmcs}|@option{dmi}) [value]
10218 Set the IR value for the specified JTAG register. This is useful, for
10219 example, when using the existing JTAG interface on a Xilinx FPGA by
10220 way of BSCANE2 primitives that only permit a limited selection of IR
10221 values.
10222
10223 When utilizing version 0.11 of the RISC-V Debug Specification,
10224 @option{dtmcs} and @option{dmi} set the IR values for the DTMCONTROL
10225 and DBUS registers, respectively.
10226 @end deffn
10227
10228 @deffn {Command} {riscv use_bscan_tunnel} value
10229 Enable or disable use of a BSCAN tunnel to reach DM. Supply the width of
10230 the DM transport TAP's instruction register to enable. Supply a value of 0 to disable.
10231 @end deffn
10232
10233 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_ebreakm} on|off
10234 Control dcsr.ebreakm. When on (default), M-mode ebreak instructions trap to
10235 OpenOCD. When off, they generate a breakpoint exception handled internally.
10236 @end deffn
10237
10238 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_ebreaks} on|off
10239 Control dcsr.ebreaks. When on (default), S-mode ebreak instructions trap to
10240 OpenOCD. When off, they generate a breakpoint exception handled internally.
10241 @end deffn
10242
10243 @deffn {Command} {riscv set_ebreaku} on|off
10244 Control dcsr.ebreaku. When on (default), U-mode ebreak instructions trap to
10245 OpenOCD. When off, they generate a breakpoint exception handled internally.
10246 @end deffn
10247
10248 @subsection RISC-V Authentication Commands
10249
10250 The following commands can be used to authenticate to a RISC-V system. Eg. a
10251 trivial challenge-response protocol could be implemented as follows in a
10252 configuration file, immediately following @command{init}:
10253 @example
10254 set challenge [riscv authdata_read]
10255 riscv authdata_write [expr $challenge + 1]
10256 @end example
10257
10258 @deffn {Command} {riscv authdata_read}
10259 Return the 32-bit value read from authdata.
10260 @end deffn
10261
10262 @deffn {Command} {riscv authdata_write} value
10263 Write the 32-bit value to authdata.
10264 @end deffn
10265
10266 @subsection RISC-V DMI Commands
10267
10268 The following commands allow direct access to the Debug Module Interface, which
10269 can be used to interact with custom debug features.
10270
10271 @deffn {Command} {riscv dmi_read} address
10272 Perform a 32-bit DMI read at address, returning the value.
10273 @end deffn
10274
10275 @deffn {Command} {riscv dmi_write} address value
10276 Perform a 32-bit DMI write of value at address.
10277 @end deffn
10278
10279 @section ARC Architecture
10280 @cindex ARC
10281
10282 Synopsys DesignWare ARC Processors are a family of 32-bit CPUs that SoC
10283 designers can optimize for a wide range of uses, from deeply embedded to
10284 high-performance host applications in a variety of market segments. See more
10285 at: @url{http://www.synopsys.com/IP/ProcessorIP/ARCProcessors/Pages/default.aspx}.
10286 OpenOCD currently supports ARC EM processors.
10287 There is a set ARC-specific OpenOCD commands that allow low-level
10288 access to the core and provide necessary support for ARC extensibility and
10289 configurability capabilities. ARC processors has much more configuration
10290 capabilities than most of the other processors and in addition there is an
10291 extension interface that allows SoC designers to add custom registers and
10292 instructions. For the OpenOCD that mostly means that set of core and AUX
10293 registers in target will vary and is not fixed for a particular processor
10294 model. To enable extensibility several TCL commands are provided that allow to
10295 describe those optional registers in OpenOCD configuration files. Moreover
10296 those commands allow for a dynamic target features discovery.
10297
10298
10299 @subsection General ARC commands
10300
10301 @deffn {Config Command} {arc add-reg} configparams
10302
10303 Add a new register to processor target. By default newly created register is
10304 marked as not existing. @var{configparams} must have following required
10305 arguments:
10306
10307 @itemize @bullet
10308
10309 @item @code{-name} name
10310 @*Name of a register.
10311
10312 @item @code{-num} number
10313 @*Architectural register number: core register number or AUX register number.
10314
10315 @item @code{-feature} XML_feature
10316 @*Name of GDB XML target description feature.
10317
10318 @end itemize
10319
10320 @var{configparams} may have following optional arguments:
10321
10322 @itemize @bullet
10323
10324 @item @code{-gdbnum} number
10325 @*GDB register number. It is recommended to not assign GDB register number
10326 manually, because there would be a risk that two register will have same
10327 number. When register GDB number is not set with this option, then register
10328 will get a previous register number + 1. This option is required only for those
10329 registers that must be at particular address expected by GDB.
10330
10331 @item @code{-core}
10332 @*This option specifies that register is a core registers. If not - this is an
10333 AUX register. AUX registers and core registers reside in different address
10334 spaces.
10335
10336 @item @code{-bcr}
10337 @*This options specifies that register is a BCR register. BCR means Build
10338 Configuration Registers - this is a special type of AUX registers that are read
10339 only and non-volatile, that is - they never change their value. Therefore OpenOCD
10340 never invalidates values of those registers in internal caches. Because BCR is a
10341 type of AUX registers, this option cannot be used with @code{-core}.
10342
10343 @item @code{-type} type_name
10344 @*Name of type of this register. This can be either one of the basic GDB types,
10345 or a custom types described with @command{arc add-reg-type-[flags|struct]}.
10346
10347 @item @code{-g}
10348 @* If specified then this is a "general" register. General registers are always
10349 read by OpenOCD on context save (when core has just been halted) and is always
10350 transferred to GDB client in a response to g-packet. Contrary to this,
10351 non-general registers are read and sent to GDB client on-demand. In general it
10352 is not recommended to apply this option to custom registers.
10353
10354 @end itemize
10355
10356 @end deffn
10357
10358 @deffn {Config Command} {arc add-reg-type-flags} -name name flags...
10359 Adds new register type of ``flags'' class. ``Flags'' types can contain only
10360 one-bit fields. Each flag definition looks like @code{-flag name bit-position}.
10361 @end deffn
10362
10363 @anchor{add-reg-type-struct}
10364 @deffn {Config Command} {arc add-reg-type-struct} -name name structs...
10365 Adds new register type of ``struct'' class. ``Struct'' types can contain either
10366 bit-fields or fields of other types, however at the moment only bit fields are
10367 supported. Structure bit field definition looks like @code{-bitfield name
10368 startbit endbit}.
10369 @end deffn
10370
10371 @deffn {Command} {arc get-reg-field} reg-name field-name
10372 Returns value of bit-field in a register. Register must be ``struct'' register
10373 type, @xref{add-reg-type-struct}. command definition.
10374 @end deffn
10375
10376 @deffn {Command} {arc set-reg-exists} reg-names...
10377 Specify that some register exists. Any amount of names can be passed
10378 as an argument for a single command invocation.
10379 @end deffn
10380
10381 @subsection ARC JTAG commands
10382
10383 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag set-aux-reg} regnum value
10384 This command writes value to AUX register via its number. This command access
10385 register in target directly via JTAG, bypassing any OpenOCD internal caches,
10386 therefore it is unsafe to use if that register can be operated by other means.
10387
10388 @end deffn
10389
10390 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag set-core-reg} regnum value
10391 This command is similar to @command{arc jtag set-aux-reg} but is for core
10392 registers.
10393 @end deffn
10394
10395 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag get-aux-reg} regnum
10396 This command returns the value storded in AUX register via its number. This commands access
10397 register in target directly via JTAG, bypassing any OpenOCD internal caches,
10398 therefore it is unsafe to use if that register can be operated by other means.
10399
10400 @end deffn
10401
10402 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag get-core-reg} regnum
10403 This command is similar to @command{arc jtag get-aux-reg} but is for core
10404 registers.
10405 @end deffn
10406
10407 @section STM8 Architecture
10408 @uref{http://st.com/stm8/, STM8} is a 8-bit microcontroller platform from
10409 STMicroelectronics, based on a proprietary 8-bit core architecture.
10410
10411 OpenOCD supports debugging STM8 through the STMicroelectronics debug
10412 protocol SWIM, @pxref{swimtransport,,SWIM}.
10413
10414 @anchor{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing}
10415 @section Software Debug Messages and Tracing
10416 @cindex Linux-ARM DCC support
10417 @cindex tracing
10418 @cindex libdcc
10419 @cindex DCC
10420 OpenOCD can process certain requests from target software, when
10421 the target uses appropriate libraries.
10422 The most powerful mechanism is semihosting, but there is also
10423 a lighter weight mechanism using only the DCC channel.
10424
10425 Currently @command{target_request debugmsgs}
10426 is supported only for @option{arm7_9} and @option{cortex_m} cores.
10427 These messages are received as part of target polling, so
10428 you need to have @command{poll on} active to receive them.
10429 They are intrusive in that they will affect program execution
10430 times. If that is a problem, @pxref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.
10431
10432 See @file{libdcc} in the contrib dir for more details.
10433 In addition to sending strings, characters, and
10434 arrays of various size integers from the target,
10435 @file{libdcc} also exports a software trace point mechanism.
10436 The target being debugged may
10437 issue trace messages which include a 24-bit @dfn{trace point} number.
10438 Trace point support includes two distinct mechanisms,
10439 each supported by a command:
10440
10441 @itemize
10442 @item @emph{History} ... A circular buffer of trace points
10443 can be set up, and then displayed at any time.
10444 This tracks where code has been, which can be invaluable in
10445 finding out how some fault was triggered.
10446
10447 The buffer may overflow, since it collects records continuously.
10448 It may be useful to use some of the 24 bits to represent a
10449 particular event, and other bits to hold data.
10450
10451 @item @emph{Counting} ... An array of counters can be set up,
10452 and then displayed at any time.
10453 This can help establish code coverage and identify hot spots.
10454
10455 The array of counters is directly indexed by the trace point
10456 number, so trace points with higher numbers are not counted.
10457 @end itemize
10458
10459 Linux-ARM kernels have a ``Kernel low-level debugging
10460 via EmbeddedICE DCC channel'' option (CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC,
10461 depends on CONFIG_DEBUG_LL) which uses this mechanism to
10462 deliver messages before a serial console can be activated.
10463 This is not the same format used by @file{libdcc}.
10464 Other software, such as the U-Boot boot loader, sometimes
10465 does the same thing.
10466
10467 @deffn {Command} {target_request debugmsgs} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{charmsg}]
10468 Displays current handling of target DCC message requests.
10469 These messages may be sent to the debugger while the target is running.
10470 The optional @option{enable} and @option{charmsg} parameters
10471 both enable the messages, while @option{disable} disables them.
10472
10473 With @option{charmsg} the DCC words each contain one character,
10474 as used by Linux with CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC;
10475 otherwise the libdcc format is used.
10476 @end deffn
10477
10478 @deffn {Command} {trace history} [@option{clear}|count]
10479 With no parameter, displays all the trace points that have triggered
10480 in the order they triggered.
10481 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace history records.
10482 With a @var{count} parameter, allocates space for that many
10483 history records.
10484 @end deffn
10485
10486 @deffn {Command} {trace point} [@option{clear}|identifier]
10487 With no parameter, displays all trace point identifiers and how many times
10488 they have been triggered.
10489 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace point counters.
10490 With a numeric @var{identifier} parameter, creates a new a trace point counter
10491 and associates it with that identifier.
10492
10493 @emph{Important:} The identifier and the trace point number
10494 are not related except by this command.
10495 These trace point numbers always start at zero (from server startup,
10496 or after @command{trace point clear}) and count up from there.
10497 @end deffn
10498
10499
10500 @node JTAG Commands
10501 @chapter JTAG Commands
10502 @cindex JTAG Commands
10503 Most general purpose JTAG commands have been presented earlier.
10504 (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}, @ref{Reset Configuration}, and @ref{TAP Declaration}.)
10505 Lower level JTAG commands, as presented here,
10506 may be needed to work with targets which require special
10507 attention during operations such as reset or initialization.
10508
10509 To use these commands you will need to understand some
10510 of the basics of JTAG, including:
10511
10512 @itemize @bullet
10513 @item A JTAG scan chain consists of a sequence of individual TAP
10514 devices such as a CPUs.
10515 @item Control operations involve moving each TAP through the same
10516 standard state machine (in parallel)
10517 using their shared TMS and clock signals.
10518 @item Data transfer involves shifting data through the chain of
10519 instruction or data registers of each TAP, writing new register values
10520 while the reading previous ones.
10521 @item Data register sizes are a function of the instruction active in
10522 a given TAP, while instruction register sizes are fixed for each TAP.
10523 All TAPs support a BYPASS instruction with a single bit data register.
10524 @item The way OpenOCD differentiates between TAP devices is by
10525 shifting different instructions into (and out of) their instruction
10526 registers.
10527 @end itemize
10528
10529 @section Low Level JTAG Commands
10530
10531 These commands are used by developers who need to access
10532 JTAG instruction or data registers, possibly controlling
10533 the order of TAP state transitions.
10534 If you're not debugging OpenOCD internals, or bringing up a
10535 new JTAG adapter or a new type of TAP device (like a CPU or
10536 JTAG router), you probably won't need to use these commands.
10537 In a debug session that doesn't use JTAG for its transport protocol,
10538 these commands are not available.
10539
10540 @deffn {Command} {drscan} tap [numbits value]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
10541 Loads the data register of @var{tap} with a series of bit fields
10542 that specify the entire register.
10543 Each field is @var{numbits} bits long with
10544 a numeric @var{value} (hexadecimal encouraged).
10545 The return value holds the original value of each
10546 of those fields.
10547
10548 For example, a 38 bit number might be specified as one
10549 field of 32 bits then one of 6 bits.
10550 @emph{For portability, never pass fields which are more
10551 than 32 bits long. Many OpenOCD implementations do not
10552 support 64-bit (or larger) integer values.}
10553
10554 All TAPs other than @var{tap} must be in BYPASS mode.
10555 The single bit in their data registers does not matter.
10556
10557 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
10558 in that state.
10559 For example @sc{drpause} might be specified, so that more
10560 instructions can be issued before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
10561 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
10562
10563 @quotation Warning
10564 OpenOCD does not record information about data register lengths,
10565 so @emph{it is important that you get the bit field lengths right}.
10566 Remember that different JTAG instructions refer to different
10567 data registers, which may have different lengths.
10568 Moreover, those lengths may not be fixed;
10569 the SCAN_N instruction can change the length of
10570 the register accessed by the INTEST instruction
10571 (by connecting a different scan chain).
10572 @end quotation
10573 @end deffn
10574
10575 @deffn {Command} {flush_count}
10576 Returns the number of times the JTAG queue has been flushed.
10577 This may be used for performance tuning.
10578
10579 For example, flushing a queue over USB involves a
10580 minimum latency, often several milliseconds, which does
10581 not change with the amount of data which is written.
10582 You may be able to identify performance problems by finding
10583 tasks which waste bandwidth by flushing small transfers too often,
10584 instead of batching them into larger operations.
10585 @end deffn
10586
10587 @deffn {Command} {irscan} [tap instruction]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
10588 For each @var{tap} listed, loads the instruction register
10589 with its associated numeric @var{instruction}.
10590 (The number of bits in that instruction may be displayed
10591 using the @command{scan_chain} command.)
10592 For other TAPs, a BYPASS instruction is loaded.
10593
10594 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
10595 in that state.
10596 For example @sc{irpause} might be specified, so the data register
10597 can be loaded before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
10598 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
10599
10600 @quotation Note
10601 OpenOCD currently supports only a single field for instruction
10602 register values, unlike data register values.
10603 For TAPs where the instruction register length is more than 32 bits,
10604 portable scripts currently must issue only BYPASS instructions.
10605 @end quotation
10606 @end deffn
10607
10608 @deffn {Command} {pathmove} start_state [next_state ...]
10609 Start by moving to @var{start_state}, which
10610 must be one of the @emph{stable} states.
10611 Unless it is the only state given, this will often be the
10612 current state, so that no TCK transitions are needed.
10613 Then, in a series of single state transitions
10614 (conforming to the JTAG state machine) shift to
10615 each @var{next_state} in sequence, one per TCK cycle.
10616 The final state must also be stable.
10617 @end deffn
10618
10619 @deffn {Command} {runtest} @var{num_cycles}
10620 Move to the @sc{run/idle} state, and execute at least
10621 @var{num_cycles} of the JTAG clock (TCK).
10622 Instructions often need some time
10623 to execute before they take effect.
10624 @end deffn
10625
10626 @c tms_sequence (short|long)
10627 @c ... temporary, debug-only, other than USBprog bug workaround...
10628
10629 @deffn {Command} {verify_ircapture} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
10630 Verify values captured during @sc{ircapture} and returned
10631 during IR scans. Default is enabled, but this can be
10632 overridden by @command{verify_jtag}.
10633 This flag is ignored when validating JTAG chain configuration.
10634 @end deffn
10635
10636 @deffn {Command} {verify_jtag} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
10637 Enables verification of DR and IR scans, to help detect
10638 programming errors. For IR scans, @command{verify_ircapture}
10639 must also be enabled.
10640 Default is enabled.
10641 @end deffn
10642
10643 @section TAP state names
10644 @cindex TAP state names
10645
10646 The @var{tap_state} names used by OpenOCD in the @command{drscan},
10647 @command{irscan}, and @command{pathmove} commands are the same
10648 as those used in SVF boundary scan documents, except that
10649 SVF uses @sc{idle} instead of @sc{run/idle}.
10650
10651 @itemize @bullet
10652 @item @b{RESET} ... @emph{stable} (with TMS high);
10653 acts as if TRST were pulsed
10654 @item @b{RUN/IDLE} ... @emph{stable}; don't assume this always means IDLE
10655 @item @b{DRSELECT}
10656 @item @b{DRCAPTURE}
10657 @item @b{DRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
10658 through the data register
10659 @item @b{DREXIT1}
10660 @item @b{DRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; data register ready
10661 for update or more shifting
10662 @item @b{DREXIT2}
10663 @item @b{DRUPDATE}
10664 @item @b{IRSELECT}
10665 @item @b{IRCAPTURE}
10666 @item @b{IRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
10667 through the instruction register
10668 @item @b{IREXIT1}
10669 @item @b{IRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; instruction register ready
10670 for update or more shifting
10671 @item @b{IREXIT2}
10672 @item @b{IRUPDATE}
10673 @end itemize
10674
10675 Note that only six of those states are fully ``stable'' in the
10676 face of TMS fixed (low except for @sc{reset})
10677 and a free-running JTAG clock. For all the
10678 others, the next TCK transition changes to a new state.
10679
10680 @itemize @bullet
10681 @item From @sc{drshift} and @sc{irshift}, clock transitions will
10682 produce side effects by changing register contents. The values
10683 to be latched in upcoming @sc{drupdate} or @sc{irupdate} states
10684 may not be as expected.
10685 @item @sc{run/idle}, @sc{drpause}, and @sc{irpause} are reasonable
10686 choices after @command{drscan} or @command{irscan} commands,
10687 since they are free of JTAG side effects.
10688 @item @sc{run/idle} may have side effects that appear at non-JTAG
10689 levels, such as advancing the ARM9E-S instruction pipeline.
10690 Consult the documentation for the TAP(s) you are working with.
10691 @end itemize
10692
10693 @node Boundary Scan Commands
10694 @chapter Boundary Scan Commands
10695
10696 One of the original purposes of JTAG was to support
10697 boundary scan based hardware testing.
10698 Although its primary focus is to support On-Chip Debugging,
10699 OpenOCD also includes some boundary scan commands.
10700
10701 @section SVF: Serial Vector Format
10702 @cindex Serial Vector Format
10703 @cindex SVF
10704
10705 The Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{SVF}, is a
10706 way to represent JTAG test patterns in text files.
10707 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
10708 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
10709
10710 @deffn {Command} {svf} @file{filename} [@option{-tap @var{tapname}}] [@option{[-]quiet}] @
10711 [@option{[-]nil}] [@option{[-]progress}] [@option{[-]ignore_error}]
10712 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
10713 runs the SVF script from @file{filename}.
10714
10715 Arguments can be specified in any order; the optional dash doesn't
10716 affect their semantics.
10717
10718 Command options:
10719 @itemize @minus
10720 @item @option{-tap @var{tapname}} ignore IR and DR headers and footers
10721 specified by the SVF file with HIR, TIR, HDR and TDR commands;
10722 instead, calculate them automatically according to the current JTAG
10723 chain configuration, targeting @var{tapname};
10724 @item @option{[-]quiet} do not log every command before execution;
10725 @item @option{[-]nil} ``dry run'', i.e., do not perform any operations
10726 on the real interface;
10727 @item @option{[-]progress} enable progress indication;
10728 @item @option{[-]ignore_error} continue execution despite TDO check
10729 errors.
10730 @end itemize
10731 @end deffn
10732
10733 @section XSVF: Xilinx Serial Vector Format
10734 @cindex Xilinx Serial Vector Format
10735 @cindex XSVF
10736
10737 The Xilinx Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{XSVF}, is a
10738 binary representation of SVF which is optimized for use with
10739 Xilinx devices.
10740 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
10741 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
10742
10743 @quotation Important
10744 Not all XSVF commands are supported.
10745 @end quotation
10746
10747 @deffn {Command} {xsvf} (tapname|@option{plain}) filename [@option{virt2}] [@option{quiet}]
10748 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
10749 runs the XSVF script from @file{filename}.
10750 When a @var{tapname} is specified, the commands are directed at
10751 that TAP.
10752 When @option{virt2} is specified, the @sc{xruntest} command counts
10753 are interpreted as TCK cycles instead of microseconds.
10754 Unless the @option{quiet} option is specified,
10755 messages are logged for comments and some retries.
10756 @end deffn
10757
10758 The OpenOCD sources also include two utility scripts
10759 for working with XSVF; they are not currently installed
10760 after building the software.
10761 You may find them useful:
10762
10763 @itemize
10764 @item @emph{svf2xsvf} ... converts SVF files into the extended XSVF
10765 syntax understood by the @command{xsvf} command; see notes below.
10766 @item @emph{xsvfdump} ... converts XSVF files into a text output format;
10767 understands the OpenOCD extensions.
10768 @end itemize
10769
10770 The input format accepts a handful of non-standard extensions.
10771 These include three opcodes corresponding to SVF extensions
10772 from Lattice Semiconductor (LCOUNT, LDELAY, LDSR), and
10773 two opcodes supporting a more accurate translation of SVF
10774 (XTRST, XWAITSTATE).
10775 If @emph{xsvfdump} shows a file is using those opcodes, it
10776 probably will not be usable with other XSVF tools.
10777
10778
10779 @section IPDBG: JTAG-Host server
10780 @cindex IPDBG JTAG-Host server
10781 @cindex IPDBG
10782
10783 IPDBG is a set of tools to debug IP-Cores. It comprises, among others, a logic analyzer and an arbitrary
10784 waveform generator. These are synthesize-able hardware descriptions of
10785 logic circuits in addition to software for control, visualization and further analysis.
10786 In a session using JTAG for its transport protocol, OpenOCD supports the function
10787 of a JTAG-Host. The JTAG-Host is needed to connect the circuit over JTAG to the
10788 control-software. For more details see @url{http://ipdbg.org}.
10789
10790 @deffn {Command} {ipdbg} [@option{-start|-stop}] @option{-tap @var{tapname}} @option{-hub @var{ir_value} [@var{dr_length}]} [@option{-port @var{number}}] [@option{-tool @var{number}}] [@option{-vir [@var{vir_value} [@var{length} [@var{instr_code}]]]}]
10791 Starts or stops a IPDBG JTAG-Host server. Arguments can be specified in any order.
10792
10793 Command options:
10794 @itemize @bullet
10795 @item @option{-start|-stop} starts or stops a IPDBG JTAG-Host server (default: start).
10796 @item @option{-tap @var{tapname}} targeting the TAP @var{tapname}.
10797 @item @option{-hub @var{ir_value}} states that the JTAG hub is
10798 reachable with dr-scans while the JTAG instruction register has the value @var{ir_value}.
10799 @item @option{-port @var{number}} tcp port number where the JTAG-Host is listening.
10800 @item @option{-tool @var{number}} number of the tool/feature. These corresponds to the ports "data_(up/down)_(0..6)" at the JtagHub.
10801 @item @option{-vir [@var{vir_value} [@var{length} [@var{instr_code}]]]} On some devices, the user data-register is only reachable if there is a
10802 specific value in a second dr. This second dr is called vir (virtual ir). With this parameter given, the IPDBG satisfies this condition prior an
10803 access to the IPDBG-Hub. The value shifted into the vir is given by the first parameter @var{vir_value} (default: 0x11). The second
10804 parameter @var{length} is the length of the vir data register (default: 5). With the @var{instr_code} (default: 0x00e) parameter the ir value to
10805 shift data through vir can be configured.
10806 @end itemize
10807 @end deffn
10808
10809 Examples:
10810 @example
10811 ipdbg -start -tap xc6s.tap -hub 0x02 -port 4242 -tool 4
10812 @end example
10813 Starts a server listening on tcp-port 4242 which connects to tool 4.
10814 The connection is through the TAP of a Xilinx Spartan 6 on USER1 instruction (tested with a papillion pro board).
10815
10816 @example
10817 ipdbg -start -tap 10m50.tap -hub 0x00C -vir -port 60000 -tool 1
10818 @end example
10819 Starts a server listening on tcp-port 60000 which connects to tool 1 (data_up_1/data_down_1).
10820 The connection is through the TAP of a Intel MAX10 virtual jtag component (sld_instance_index is 0; sld_ir_width is smaller than 5).
10821
10822 @node Utility Commands
10823 @chapter Utility Commands
10824 @cindex Utility Commands
10825
10826 @section RAM testing
10827 @cindex RAM testing
10828
10829 There is often a need to stress-test random access memory (RAM) for
10830 errors. OpenOCD comes with a Tcl implementation of well-known memory
10831 testing procedures allowing the detection of all sorts of issues with
10832 electrical wiring, defective chips, PCB layout and other common
10833 hardware problems.
10834
10835 To use them, you usually need to initialise your RAM controller first;
10836 consult your SoC's documentation to get the recommended list of
10837 register operations and translate them to the corresponding
10838 @command{mww}/@command{mwb} commands.
10839
10840 Load the memory testing functions with
10841
10842 @example
10843 source [find tools/memtest.tcl]
10844 @end example
10845
10846 to get access to the following facilities:
10847
10848 @deffn {Command} {memTestDataBus} address
10849 Test the data bus wiring in a memory region by performing a walking
10850 1's test at a fixed address within that region.
10851 @end deffn
10852
10853 @deffn {Command} {memTestAddressBus} baseaddress size
10854 Perform a walking 1's test on the relevant bits of the address and
10855 check for aliasing. This test will find single-bit address failures
10856 such as stuck-high, stuck-low, and shorted pins.
10857 @end deffn
10858
10859 @deffn {Command} {memTestDevice} baseaddress size
10860 Test the integrity of a physical memory device by performing an
10861 increment/decrement test over the entire region. In the process every
10862 storage bit in the device is tested as zero and as one.
10863 @end deffn
10864
10865 @deffn {Command} {runAllMemTests} baseaddress size
10866 Run all of the above tests over a specified memory region.
10867 @end deffn
10868
10869 @section Firmware recovery helpers
10870 @cindex Firmware recovery
10871
10872 OpenOCD includes an easy-to-use script to facilitate mass-market
10873 devices recovery with JTAG.
10874
10875 For quickstart instructions run:
10876 @example
10877 openocd -f tools/firmware-recovery.tcl -c firmware_help
10878 @end example
10879
10880 @node GDB and OpenOCD
10881 @chapter GDB and OpenOCD
10882 @cindex GDB
10883 OpenOCD complies with the remote gdbserver protocol and, as such, can be used
10884 to debug remote targets.
10885 Setting up GDB to work with OpenOCD can involve several components:
10886
10887 @itemize
10888 @item The OpenOCD server support for GDB may need to be configured.
10889 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
10890 @item GDB's support for OpenOCD may need configuration,
10891 as shown in this chapter.
10892 @item If you have a GUI environment like Eclipse,
10893 that also will probably need to be configured.
10894 @end itemize
10895
10896 Of course, the version of GDB you use will need to be one which has
10897 been built to know about the target CPU you're using. It's probably
10898 part of the tool chain you're using. For example, if you are doing
10899 cross-development for ARM on an x86 PC, instead of using the native
10900 x86 @command{gdb} command you might use @command{arm-none-eabi-gdb}
10901 if that's the tool chain used to compile your code.
10902
10903 @section Connecting to GDB
10904 @cindex Connecting to GDB
10905 Use GDB 6.7 or newer with OpenOCD if you run into trouble. For
10906 instance GDB 6.3 has a known bug that produces bogus memory access
10907 errors, which has since been fixed; see
10908 @url{http://osdir.com/ml/gdb.bugs.discuss/2004-12/msg00018.html}
10909
10910 OpenOCD can communicate with GDB in two ways:
10911
10912 @enumerate
10913 @item
10914 A socket (TCP/IP) connection is typically started as follows:
10915 @example
10916 target extended-remote localhost:3333
10917 @end example
10918 This would cause GDB to connect to the gdbserver on the local pc using port 3333.
10919
10920 The extended remote protocol is a super-set of the remote protocol and should
10921 be the preferred choice. More details are available in GDB documentation
10922 @url{https://sourceware.org/gdb/onlinedocs/gdb/Connecting.html}
10923
10924 To speed-up typing, any GDB command can be abbreviated, including the extended
10925 remote command above that becomes:
10926 @example
10927 tar ext :3333
10928 @end example
10929
10930 @b{Note:} If any backward compatibility issue requires using the old remote
10931 protocol in place of the extended remote one, the former protocol is still
10932 available through the command:
10933 @example
10934 target remote localhost:3333
10935 @end example
10936
10937 @item
10938 A pipe connection is typically started as follows:
10939 @example
10940 target extended-remote | \
10941 openocd -c "gdb_port pipe; log_output openocd.log"
10942 @end example
10943 This would cause GDB to run OpenOCD and communicate using pipes (stdin/stdout).
10944 Using this method has the advantage of GDB starting/stopping OpenOCD for the debug
10945 session. log_output sends the log output to a file to ensure that the pipe is
10946 not saturated when using higher debug level outputs.
10947 @end enumerate
10948
10949 To list the available OpenOCD commands type @command{monitor help} on the
10950 GDB command line.
10951
10952 @section Sample GDB session startup
10953
10954 With the remote protocol, GDB sessions start a little differently
10955 than they do when you're debugging locally.
10956 Here's an example showing how to start a debug session with a
10957 small ARM program.
10958 In this case the program was linked to be loaded into SRAM on a Cortex-M3.
10959 Most programs would be written into flash (address 0) and run from there.
10960
10961 @example
10962 $ arm-none-eabi-gdb example.elf
10963 (gdb) target extended-remote localhost:3333
10964 Remote debugging using localhost:3333
10965 ...
10966 (gdb) monitor reset halt
10967 ...
10968 (gdb) load
10969 Loading section .vectors, size 0x100 lma 0x20000000
10970 Loading section .text, size 0x5a0 lma 0x20000100
10971 Loading section .data, size 0x18 lma 0x200006a0
10972 Start address 0x2000061c, load size 1720
10973 Transfer rate: 22 KB/sec, 573 bytes/write.
10974 (gdb) continue
10975 Continuing.
10976 ...
10977 @end example
10978
10979 You could then interrupt the GDB session to make the program break,
10980 type @command{where} to show the stack, @command{list} to show the
10981 code around the program counter, @command{step} through code,
10982 set breakpoints or watchpoints, and so on.
10983
10984 @section Configuring GDB for OpenOCD
10985
10986 OpenOCD supports the gdb @option{qSupported} packet, this enables information
10987 to be sent by the GDB remote server (i.e. OpenOCD) to GDB. Typical information includes
10988 packet size and the device's memory map.
10989 You do not need to configure the packet size by hand,
10990 and the relevant parts of the memory map should be automatically
10991 set up when you declare (NOR) flash banks.
10992
10993 However, there are other things which GDB can't currently query.
10994 You may need to set those up by hand.
10995 As OpenOCD starts up, you will often see a line reporting
10996 something like:
10997
10998 @example
10999 Info : lm3s.cpu: hardware has 6 breakpoints, 4 watchpoints
11000 @end example
11001
11002 You can pass that information to GDB with these commands:
11003
11004 @example
11005 set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit 6
11006 set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit 4
11007 @end example
11008
11009 With that particular hardware (Cortex-M3) the hardware breakpoints
11010 only work for code running from flash memory. Most other ARM systems
11011 do not have such restrictions.
11012
11013 Rather than typing such commands interactively, you may prefer to
11014 save them in a file and have GDB execute them as it starts, perhaps
11015 using a @file{.gdbinit} in your project directory or starting GDB
11016 using @command{gdb -x filename}.
11017
11018 @section Programming using GDB
11019 @cindex Programming using GDB
11020 @anchor{programmingusinggdb}
11021
11022 By default the target memory map is sent to GDB. This can be disabled by
11023 the following OpenOCD configuration option:
11024 @example
11025 gdb_memory_map disable
11026 @end example
11027 For this to function correctly a valid flash configuration must also be set
11028 in OpenOCD. For faster performance you should also configure a valid
11029 working area.
11030
11031 Informing GDB of the memory map of the target will enable GDB to protect any
11032 flash areas of the target and use hardware breakpoints by default. This means
11033 that the OpenOCD option @command{gdb_breakpoint_override} is not required when
11034 using a memory map. @xref{gdbbreakpointoverride,,gdb_breakpoint_override}.
11035
11036 To view the configured memory map in GDB, use the GDB command @option{info mem}.
11037 All other unassigned addresses within GDB are treated as RAM.
11038
11039 GDB 6.8 and higher set any memory area not in the memory map as inaccessible.
11040 This can be changed to the old behaviour by using the following GDB command
11041 @example
11042 set mem inaccessible-by-default off
11043 @end example
11044
11045 If @command{gdb_flash_program enable} is also used, GDB will be able to
11046 program any flash memory using the vFlash interface.
11047
11048 GDB will look at the target memory map when a load command is given, if any
11049 areas to be programmed lie within the target flash area the vFlash packets
11050 will be used.
11051
11052 If the target needs configuring before GDB programming, set target
11053 event gdb-flash-erase-start:
11054 @example
11055 $_TARGETNAME configure -event gdb-flash-erase-start BODY
11056 @end example
11057 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}, for other GDB programming related events.
11058
11059 To verify any flash programming the GDB command @option{compare-sections}
11060 can be used.
11061
11062 @section Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector
11063 @cindex Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector
11064 @anchor{gdbmeminspect}
11065
11066 If your project controls more than a blinking LED, let's say a heavy industrial
11067 robot or an experimental nuclear reactor, stopping the controlling process
11068 just because you want to attach GDB is not a good option.
11069
11070 OpenOCD does not support GDB non-stop mode (might be implemented in the future).
11071 Though there is a possible setup where the target does not get stopped
11072 and GDB treats it as it were running.
11073 If the target supports background access to memory while it is running,
11074 you can use GDB in this mode to inspect memory (mainly global variables)
11075 without any intrusion of the target process.
11076
11077 Remove default setting of gdb-attach event. @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
11078 Place following command after target configuration:
11079 @example
11080 $_TARGETNAME configure -event gdb-attach @{@}
11081 @end example
11082
11083 If any of installed flash banks does not support probe on running target,
11084 switch off gdb_memory_map:
11085 @example
11086 gdb_memory_map disable
11087 @end example
11088
11089 Ensure GDB is configured without interrupt-on-connect.
11090 Some GDB versions set it by default, some does not.
11091 @example
11092 set remote interrupt-on-connect off
11093 @end example
11094
11095 If you switched gdb_memory_map off, you may want to setup GDB memory map
11096 manually or issue @command{set mem inaccessible-by-default off}
11097
11098 Now you can issue GDB command @command{target extended-remote ...} and inspect memory
11099 of a running target. Do not use GDB commands @command{continue},
11100 @command{step} or @command{next} as they synchronize GDB with your target
11101 and GDB would require stopping the target to get the prompt back.
11102
11103 Do not use this mode under an IDE like Eclipse as it caches values of
11104 previously shown variables.
11105
11106 It's also possible to connect more than one GDB to the same target by the
11107 target's configuration option @code{-gdb-max-connections}. This allows, for
11108 example, one GDB to run a script that continuously polls a set of variables
11109 while other GDB can be used interactively. Be extremely careful in this case,
11110 because the two GDB can easily get out-of-sync.
11111
11112 @section RTOS Support
11113 @cindex RTOS Support
11114 @anchor{gdbrtossupport}
11115
11116 OpenOCD includes RTOS support, this will however need enabling as it defaults to disabled.
11117 It can be enabled by passing @option{-rtos} arg to the target. @xref{rtostype,,RTOS Type}.
11118
11119 @xref{Threads, Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads,
11120 Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads, gdb, GDB manual}, for details about relevant
11121 GDB commands.
11122
11123 @* An example setup is below:
11124
11125 @example
11126 $_TARGETNAME configure -rtos auto
11127 @end example
11128
11129 This will attempt to auto detect the RTOS within your application.
11130
11131 Currently supported rtos's include:
11132 @itemize @bullet
11133 @item @option{eCos}
11134 @item @option{ThreadX}
11135 @item @option{FreeRTOS}
11136 @item @option{linux}
11137 @item @option{ChibiOS}
11138 @item @option{embKernel}
11139 @item @option{mqx}
11140 @item @option{uCOS-III}
11141 @item @option{nuttx}
11142 @item @option{RIOT}
11143 @item @option{hwthread} (This is not an actual RTOS. @xref{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb,,Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB}.)
11144 @item @option{Zephyr}
11145 @end itemize
11146
11147 Before an RTOS can be detected, it must export certain symbols; otherwise, it cannot
11148 be used by OpenOCD. Below is a list of the required symbols for each supported RTOS.
11149
11150 @table @code
11151 @item eCos symbols
11152 Cyg_Thread::thread_list, Cyg_Scheduler_Base::current_thread.
11153 @item ThreadX symbols
11154 _tx_thread_current_ptr, _tx_thread_created_ptr, _tx_thread_created_count.
11155 @item FreeRTOS symbols
11156 @raggedright
11157 pxCurrentTCB, pxReadyTasksLists, xDelayedTaskList1, xDelayedTaskList2,
11158 pxDelayedTaskList, pxOverflowDelayedTaskList, xPendingReadyList,
11159 uxCurrentNumberOfTasks, uxTopUsedPriority.
11160 @end raggedright
11161 @item linux symbols
11162 init_task.
11163 @item ChibiOS symbols
11164 rlist, ch_debug, chSysInit.
11165 @item embKernel symbols
11166 Rtos::sCurrentTask, Rtos::sListReady, Rtos::sListSleep,
11167 Rtos::sListSuspended, Rtos::sMaxPriorities, Rtos::sCurrentTaskCount.
11168 @item mqx symbols
11169 _mqx_kernel_data, MQX_init_struct.
11170 @item uC/OS-III symbols
11171 OSRunning, OSTCBCurPtr, OSTaskDbgListPtr, OSTaskQty.
11172 @item nuttx symbols
11173 g_readytorun, g_tasklisttable.
11174 @item RIOT symbols
11175 @raggedright
11176 sched_threads, sched_num_threads, sched_active_pid, max_threads,
11177 _tcb_name_offset.
11178 @end raggedright
11179 @item Zephyr symbols
11180 _kernel, _kernel_openocd_offsets, _kernel_openocd_size_t_size
11181 @end table
11182
11183 For most RTOS supported the above symbols will be exported by default. However for
11184 some, eg. FreeRTOS, uC/OS-III and Zephyr, extra steps must be taken.
11185
11186 Zephyr must be compiled with the DEBUG_THREAD_INFO option. This will generate some symbols
11187 with information needed in order to build the list of threads.
11188
11189 FreeRTOS and uC/OS-III RTOSes may require additional OpenOCD-specific file to be linked
11190 along with the project:
11191
11192 @table @code
11193 @item FreeRTOS
11194 contrib/rtos-helpers/FreeRTOS-openocd.c
11195 @item uC/OS-III
11196 contrib/rtos-helpers/uCOS-III-openocd.c
11197 @end table
11198
11199 @anchor{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb}
11200 @section Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB
11201 @cindex SMP
11202 @cindex RTOS
11203 @cindex hwthread
11204 OpenOCD includes a pseudo RTOS called @emph{hwthread} that presents CPU cores
11205 ("hardware threads") in an SMP system as threads to GDB. With this extension,
11206 GDB can be used to inspect the state of an SMP system in a natural way.
11207 After halting the system, using the GDB command @command{info threads} will
11208 list the context of each active CPU core in the system. GDB's @command{thread}
11209 command can be used to switch the view to a different CPU core.
11210 The @command{step} and @command{stepi} commands can be used to step a specific core
11211 while other cores are free-running or remain halted, depending on the
11212 scheduler-locking mode configured in GDB.
11213
11214 @section Legacy SMP core switching support
11215 @quotation Note
11216 This method is deprecated in favor of the @emph{hwthread} pseudo RTOS.
11217 @end quotation
11218
11219 For SMP support following GDB serial protocol packet have been defined :
11220 @itemize @bullet
11221 @item j - smp status request
11222 @item J - smp set request
11223 @end itemize
11224
11225 OpenOCD implements :
11226 @itemize @bullet
11227 @item @option{jc} packet for reading core id displayed by
11228 GDB connection. Reply is @option{XXXXXXXX} (8 hex digits giving core id) or
11229 @option{E01} for target not smp.
11230 @item @option{JcXXXXXXXX} (8 hex digits) packet for setting core id displayed at next GDB continue
11231 (core id -1 is reserved for returning to normal resume mode). Reply @option{E01}
11232 for target not smp or @option{OK} on success.
11233 @end itemize
11234
11235 Handling of this packet within GDB can be done :
11236 @itemize @bullet
11237 @item by the creation of an internal variable (i.e @option{_core}) by mean
11238 of function allocate_computed_value allowing following GDB command.
11239 @example
11240 set $_core 1
11241 #Jc01 packet is sent
11242 print $_core
11243 #jc packet is sent and result is affected in $
11244 @end example
11245
11246 @item by the usage of GDB maintenance command as described in following example (2 cpus in SMP with
11247 core id 0 and 1 @pxref{definecputargetsworkinginsmp,,Define CPU targets working in SMP}).
11248
11249 @example
11250 # toggle0 : force display of coreid 0
11251 define toggle0
11252 maint packet Jc0
11253 continue
11254 main packet Jc-1
11255 end
11256 # toggle1 : force display of coreid 1
11257 define toggle1
11258 maint packet Jc1
11259 continue
11260 main packet Jc-1
11261 end
11262 @end example
11263 @end itemize
11264
11265 @node Tcl Scripting API
11266 @chapter Tcl Scripting API
11267 @cindex Tcl Scripting API
11268 @cindex Tcl scripts
11269 @section API rules
11270
11271 Tcl commands are stateless; e.g. the @command{telnet} command has
11272 a concept of currently active target, the Tcl API proc's take this sort
11273 of state information as an argument to each proc.
11274
11275 There are three main types of return values: single value, name value
11276 pair list and lists.
11277
11278 Name value pair. The proc 'foo' below returns a name/value pair
11279 list.
11280
11281 @example
11282 > set foo(me) Duane
11283 > set foo(you) Oyvind
11284 > set foo(mouse) Micky
11285 > set foo(duck) Donald
11286 @end example
11287
11288 If one does this:
11289
11290 @example
11291 > set foo
11292 @end example
11293
11294 The result is:
11295
11296 @example
11297 me Duane you Oyvind mouse Micky duck Donald
11298 @end example
11299
11300 Thus, to get the names of the associative array is easy:
11301
11302 @verbatim
11303 foreach { name value } [set foo] {
11304 puts "Name: $name, Value: $value"
11305 }
11306 @end verbatim
11307
11308 Lists returned should be relatively small. Otherwise, a range
11309 should be passed in to the proc in question.
11310
11311 @section Internal low-level Commands
11312
11313 By "low-level", we mean commands that a human would typically not
11314 invoke directly.
11315
11316 @itemize @bullet
11317 @item @b{mem2array} <@var{varname}> <@var{width}> <@var{addr}> <@var{nelems}>
11318
11319 Read memory and return as a Tcl array for script processing
11320 @item @b{array2mem} <@var{varname}> <@var{width}> <@var{addr}> <@var{nelems}>
11321
11322 Convert a Tcl array to memory locations and write the values
11323 @item @b{flash banks} <@var{driver}> <@var{base}> <@var{size}> <@var{chip_width}> <@var{bus_width}> <@var{target}> [@option{driver options} ...]
11324
11325 Return information about the flash banks
11326
11327 @item @b{capture} <@var{command}>
11328
11329 Run <@var{command}> and return full log output that was produced during
11330 its execution. Example:
11331
11332 @example
11333 > capture "reset init"
11334 @end example
11335
11336 @end itemize
11337
11338 OpenOCD commands can consist of two words, e.g. "flash banks". The
11339 @file{startup.tcl} "unknown" proc will translate this into a Tcl proc
11340 called "flash_banks".
11341
11342 @section Tcl RPC server
11343 @cindex RPC
11344
11345 OpenOCD provides a simple RPC server that allows to run arbitrary Tcl
11346 commands and receive the results.
11347
11348 To access it, your application needs to connect to a configured TCP port
11349 (see @command{tcl_port}). Then it can pass any string to the
11350 interpreter terminating it with @code{0x1a} and wait for the return
11351 value (it will be terminated with @code{0x1a} as well). This can be
11352 repeated as many times as desired without reopening the connection.
11353
11354 It is not needed anymore to prefix the OpenOCD commands with
11355 @code{ocd_} to get the results back. But sometimes you might need the
11356 @command{capture} command.
11357
11358 See @file{contrib/rpc_examples/} for specific client implementations.
11359
11360 @section Tcl RPC server notifications
11361 @cindex RPC Notifications
11362
11363 Notifications are sent asynchronously to other commands being executed over
11364 the RPC server, so the port must be polled continuously.
11365
11366 Target event, state and reset notifications are emitted as Tcl associative arrays
11367 in the following format.
11368
11369 @verbatim
11370 type target_event event [event-name]
11371 type target_state state [state-name]
11372 type target_reset mode [reset-mode]
11373 @end verbatim
11374
11375 @deffn {Command} {tcl_notifications} [on/off]
11376 Toggle output of target notifications to the current Tcl RPC server.
11377 Only available from the Tcl RPC server.
11378 Defaults to off.
11379
11380 @end deffn
11381
11382 @section Tcl RPC server trace output
11383 @cindex RPC trace output
11384
11385 Trace data is sent asynchronously to other commands being executed over
11386 the RPC server, so the port must be polled continuously.
11387
11388 Target trace data is emitted as a Tcl associative array in the following format.
11389
11390 @verbatim
11391 type target_trace data [trace-data-hex-encoded]
11392 @end verbatim
11393
11394 @deffn {Command} {tcl_trace} [on/off]
11395 Toggle output of target trace data to the current Tcl RPC server.
11396 Only available from the Tcl RPC server.
11397 Defaults to off.
11398
11399 See an example application here:
11400 @url{https://github.com/apmorton/OpenOcdTraceUtil} [OpenOcdTraceUtil]
11401
11402 @end deffn
11403
11404 @node FAQ
11405 @chapter FAQ
11406 @cindex faq
11407 @enumerate
11408 @anchor{faqrtck}
11409 @item @b{RTCK, also known as: Adaptive Clocking - What is it?}
11410 @cindex RTCK
11411 @cindex adaptive clocking
11412 @*
11413
11414 In digital circuit design it is often referred to as ``clock
11415 synchronisation'' the JTAG interface uses one clock (TCK or TCLK)
11416 operating at some speed, your CPU target is operating at another.
11417 The two clocks are not synchronised, they are ``asynchronous''
11418
11419 In order for the two to work together they must be synchronised
11420 well enough to work; JTAG can't go ten times faster than the CPU,
11421 for example. There are 2 basic options:
11422 @enumerate
11423 @item
11424 Use a special "adaptive clocking" circuit to change the JTAG
11425 clock rate to match what the CPU currently supports.
11426 @item
11427 The JTAG clock must be fixed at some speed that's enough slower than
11428 the CPU clock that all TMS and TDI transitions can be detected.
11429 @end enumerate
11430
11431 @b{Does this really matter?} For some chips and some situations, this
11432 is a non-issue, like a 500MHz ARM926 with a 5 MHz JTAG link;
11433 the CPU has no difficulty keeping up with JTAG.
11434 Startup sequences are often problematic though, as are other
11435 situations where the CPU clock rate changes (perhaps to save
11436 power).
11437
11438 For example, Atmel AT91SAM chips start operation from reset with
11439 a 32kHz system clock. Boot firmware may activate the main oscillator
11440 and PLL before switching to a faster clock (perhaps that 500 MHz
11441 ARM926 scenario).
11442 If you're using JTAG to debug that startup sequence, you must slow
11443 the JTAG clock to sometimes 1 to 4kHz. After startup completes,
11444 JTAG can use a faster clock.
11445
11446 Consider also debugging a 500MHz ARM926 hand held battery powered
11447 device that enters a low power ``deep sleep'' mode, at 32kHz CPU
11448 clock, between keystrokes unless it has work to do. When would
11449 that 5 MHz JTAG clock be usable?
11450
11451 @b{Solution #1 - A special circuit}
11452
11453 In order to make use of this,
11454 your CPU, board, and JTAG adapter must all support the RTCK
11455 feature. Not all of them support this; keep reading!
11456
11457 The RTCK ("Return TCK") signal in some ARM chips is used to help with
11458 this problem. ARM has a good description of the problem described at
11459 this link: @url{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} [checked
11460 28/nov/2008]. Link title: ``How does the JTAG synchronisation logic
11461 work? / how does adaptive clocking work?''.
11462
11463 The nice thing about adaptive clocking is that ``battery powered hand
11464 held device example'' - the adaptiveness works perfectly all the
11465 time. One can set a break point or halt the system in the deep power
11466 down code, slow step out until the system speeds up.
11467
11468 Note that adaptive clocking may also need to work at the board level,
11469 when a board-level scan chain has multiple chips.
11470 Parallel clock voting schemes are good way to implement this,
11471 both within and between chips, and can easily be implemented
11472 with a CPLD.
11473 It's not difficult to have logic fan a module's input TCK signal out
11474 to each TAP in the scan chain, and then wait until each TAP's RTCK comes
11475 back with the right polarity before changing the output RTCK signal.
11476 Texas Instruments makes some clock voting logic available
11477 for free (with no support) in VHDL form; see
11478 @url{http://tiexpressdsp.com/index.php/Adaptive_Clocking}
11479
11480 @b{Solution #2 - Always works - but may be slower}
11481
11482 Often this is a perfectly acceptable solution.
11483
11484 In most simple terms: Often the JTAG clock must be 1/10 to 1/12 of
11485 the target clock speed. But what that ``magic division'' is varies
11486 depending on the chips on your board.
11487 @b{ARM rule of thumb} Most ARM based systems require an 6:1 division;
11488 ARM11 cores use an 8:1 division.
11489 @b{Xilinx rule of thumb} is 1/12 the clock speed.
11490
11491 Note: most full speed FT2232 based JTAG adapters are limited to a
11492 maximum of 6MHz. The ones using USB high speed chips (FT2232H)
11493 often support faster clock rates (and adaptive clocking).
11494
11495 You can still debug the 'low power' situations - you just need to
11496 either use a fixed and very slow JTAG clock rate ... or else
11497 manually adjust the clock speed at every step. (Adjusting is painful
11498 and tedious, and is not always practical.)
11499
11500 It is however easy to ``code your way around it'' - i.e.: Cheat a little,
11501 have a special debug mode in your application that does a ``high power
11502 sleep''. If you are careful - 98% of your problems can be debugged
11503 this way.
11504
11505 Note that on ARM you may need to avoid using the @emph{wait for interrupt}
11506 operation in your idle loops even if you don't otherwise change the CPU
11507 clock rate.
11508 That operation gates the CPU clock, and thus the JTAG clock; which
11509 prevents JTAG access. One consequence is not being able to @command{halt}
11510 cores which are executing that @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
11511
11512 To set the JTAG frequency use the command:
11513
11514 @example
11515 # Example: 1.234MHz
11516 adapter speed 1234
11517 @end example
11518
11519
11520 @item @b{Win32 Pathnames} Why don't backslashes work in Windows paths?
11521
11522 OpenOCD uses Tcl and a backslash is an escape char. Use @{ and @}
11523 around Windows filenames.
11524
11525 @example
11526 > echo \a
11527
11528 > echo @{\a@}
11529 \a
11530 > echo "\a"
11531
11532 >
11533 @end example
11534
11535
11536 @item @b{Missing: cygwin1.dll} OpenOCD complains about a missing cygwin1.dll.
11537
11538 Make sure you have Cygwin installed, or at least a version of OpenOCD that
11539 claims to come with all the necessary DLLs. When using Cygwin, try launching
11540 OpenOCD from the Cygwin shell.
11541
11542 @item @b{Breakpoint Issue} I'm trying to set a breakpoint using GDB (or a front-end like Insight or
11543 Eclipse), but OpenOCD complains that "Info: arm7_9_common.c:213
11544 arm7_9_add_breakpoint(): sw breakpoint requested, but software breakpoints not enabled".
11545
11546 GDB issues software breakpoints when a normal breakpoint is requested, or to implement
11547 source-line single-stepping. On ARMv4T systems, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T or ARM920T,
11548 software breakpoints consume one of the two available hardware breakpoints.
11549
11550 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} When erasing or writing LPC2000 on-chip flash, the operation fails at random.
11551
11552 Make sure the core frequency specified in the @option{flash lpc2000} line matches the
11553 clock at the time you're programming the flash. If you've specified the crystal's
11554 frequency, make sure the PLL is disabled. If you've specified the full core speed
11555 (e.g. 60MHz), make sure the PLL is enabled.
11556
11557 @item @b{Amontec Chameleon} When debugging using an Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
11558 I keep getting "Error: amt_jtagaccel.c:184 amt_wait_scan_busy(): amt_jtagaccel timed
11559 out while waiting for end of scan, rtck was disabled".
11560
11561 Make sure your PC's parallel port operates in EPP mode. You might have to try several
11562 settings in your PC BIOS (ECP, EPP, and different versions of those).
11563
11564 @item @b{Data Aborts} When debugging with OpenOCD and GDB (plain GDB, Insight, or Eclipse),
11565 I get lots of "Error: arm7_9_common.c:1771 arm7_9_read_memory():
11566 memory read caused data abort".
11567
11568 The errors are non-fatal, and are the result of GDB trying to trace stack frames
11569 beyond the last valid frame. It might be possible to prevent this by setting up
11570 a proper "initial" stack frame, if you happen to know what exactly has to
11571 be done, feel free to add this here.
11572
11573 @b{Simple:} In your startup code - push 8 registers of zeros onto the
11574 stack before calling main(). What GDB is doing is ``climbing'' the run
11575 time stack by reading various values on the stack using the standard
11576 call frame for the target. GDB keeps going - until one of 2 things
11577 happen @b{#1} an invalid frame is found, or @b{#2} some huge number of
11578 stackframes have been processed. By pushing zeros on the stack, GDB
11579 gracefully stops.
11580
11581 @b{Debugging Interrupt Service Routines} - In your ISR before you call
11582 your C code, do the same - artificially push some zeros onto the stack,
11583 remember to pop them off when the ISR is done.
11584
11585 @b{Also note:} If you have a multi-threaded operating system, they
11586 often do not @b{in the interest of saving memory} waste these few
11587 bytes. Painful...
11588
11589
11590 @item @b{JTAG Reset Config} I get the following message in the OpenOCD console (or log file):
11591 "Warning: arm7_9_common.c:679 arm7_9_assert_reset(): srst resets test logic, too".
11592
11593 This warning doesn't indicate any serious problem, as long as you don't want to
11594 debug your core right out of reset. Your .cfg file specified @option{reset_config
11595 trst_and_srst srst_pulls_trst} to tell OpenOCD that either your board,
11596 your debugger or your target uC (e.g. LPC2000) can't assert the two reset signals
11597 independently. With this setup, it's not possible to halt the core right out of
11598 reset, everything else should work fine.
11599
11600 @item @b{USB Power} When using OpenOCD in conjunction with Amontec JTAGkey and the Yagarto
11601 toolchain (Eclipse, arm-elf-gcc, arm-elf-gdb), the debugging seems to be
11602 unstable. When single-stepping over large blocks of code, GDB and OpenOCD
11603 quit with an error message. Is there a stability issue with OpenOCD?
11604
11605 No, this is not a stability issue concerning OpenOCD. Most users have solved
11606 this issue by simply using a self-powered USB hub, which they connect their
11607 Amontec JTAGkey to. Apparently, some computers do not provide a USB power
11608 supply stable enough for the Amontec JTAGkey to be operated.
11609
11610 @b{Laptops running on battery have this problem too...}
11611
11612 @item @b{GDB Disconnects} When using the Amontec JTAGkey, sometimes OpenOCD crashes with the following
11613 error message: "Error: gdb_server.c:101 gdb_get_char(): read: 10054".
11614 What does that mean and what might be the reason for this?
11615
11616 Error code 10054 corresponds to WSAECONNRESET, which means that the debugger (GDB)
11617 has closed the connection to OpenOCD. This might be a GDB issue.
11618
11619 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} In the configuration file in the section where flash device configurations
11620 are described, there is a parameter for specifying the clock frequency
11621 for LPC2000 internal flash devices (e.g. @option{flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000
11622 0x0 0x40000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME lpc2000_v1 14746 calc_checksum}), which must be
11623 specified in kilohertz. However, I do have a quartz crystal of a
11624 frequency that contains fractions of kilohertz (e.g. 14,745,600 Hz,
11625 i.e. 14,745.600 kHz). Is it possible to specify real numbers for the
11626 clock frequency?
11627
11628 No. The clock frequency specified here must be given as an integral number.
11629 However, this clock frequency is used by the In-Application-Programming (IAP)
11630 routines of the LPC2000 family only, which seems to be very tolerant concerning
11631 the given clock frequency, so a slight difference between the specified clock
11632 frequency and the actual clock frequency will not cause any trouble.
11633
11634 @item @b{Command Order} Do I have to keep a specific order for the commands in the configuration file?
11635
11636 Well, yes and no. Commands can be given in arbitrary order, yet the
11637 devices listed for the JTAG scan chain must be given in the right
11638 order (jtag newdevice), with the device closest to the TDO-Pin being
11639 listed first. In general, whenever objects of the same type exist
11640 which require an index number, then these objects must be given in the
11641 right order (jtag newtap, targets and flash banks - a target
11642 references a jtag newtap and a flash bank references a target).
11643
11644 You can use the ``scan_chain'' command to verify and display the tap order.
11645
11646 Also, some commands can't execute until after @command{init} has been
11647 processed. Such commands include @command{nand probe} and everything
11648 else that needs to write to controller registers, perhaps for setting
11649 up DRAM and loading it with code.
11650
11651 @anchor{faqtaporder}
11652 @item @b{JTAG TAP Order} Do I have to declare the TAPS in some
11653 particular order?
11654
11655 Yes; whenever you have more than one, you must declare them in
11656 the same order used by the hardware.
11657
11658 Many newer devices have multiple JTAG TAPs. For example:
11659 STMicroelectronics STM32 chips have two TAPs, a ``boundary scan TAP'' and
11660 ``Cortex-M3'' TAP. Example: The STM32 reference manual, Document ID:
11661 RM0008, Section 26.5, Figure 259, page 651/681, the ``TDI'' pin is
11662 connected to the boundary scan TAP, which then connects to the
11663 Cortex-M3 TAP, which then connects to the TDO pin.
11664
11665 Thus, the proper order for the STM32 chip is: (1) The Cortex-M3, then
11666 (2) The boundary scan TAP. If your board includes an additional JTAG
11667 chip in the scan chain (for example a Xilinx CPLD or FPGA) you could
11668 place it before or after the STM32 chip in the chain. For example:
11669
11670 @itemize @bullet
11671 @item OpenOCD_TDI(output) -> STM32 TDI Pin (BS Input)
11672 @item STM32 BS TDO (output) -> STM32 Cortex-M3 TDI (input)
11673 @item STM32 Cortex-M3 TDO (output) -> SM32 TDO Pin
11674 @item STM32 TDO Pin (output) -> Xilinx TDI Pin (input)
11675 @item Xilinx TDO Pin -> OpenOCD TDO (input)
11676 @end itemize
11677
11678 The ``jtag device'' commands would thus be in the order shown below. Note:
11679
11680 @itemize @bullet
11681 @item jtag newtap Xilinx tap -irlen ...
11682 @item jtag newtap stm32 cpu -irlen ...
11683 @item jtag newtap stm32 bs -irlen ...
11684 @item # Create the debug target and say where it is
11685 @item target create stm32.cpu -chain-position stm32.cpu ...
11686 @end itemize
11687
11688
11689 @item @b{SYSCOMP} Sometimes my debugging session terminates with an error. When I look into the
11690 log file, I can see these error messages: Error: arm7_9_common.c:561
11691 arm7_9_execute_sys_speed(): timeout waiting for SYSCOMP
11692
11693 TODO.
11694
11695 @end enumerate
11696
11697 @node Tcl Crash Course
11698 @chapter Tcl Crash Course
11699 @cindex Tcl
11700
11701 Not everyone knows Tcl - this is not intended to be a replacement for
11702 learning Tcl, the intent of this chapter is to give you some idea of
11703 how the Tcl scripts work.
11704
11705 This chapter is written with two audiences in mind. (1) OpenOCD users
11706 who need to understand a bit more of how Jim-Tcl works so they can do
11707 something useful, and (2) those that want to add a new command to
11708 OpenOCD.
11709
11710 @section Tcl Rule #1
11711 There is a famous joke, it goes like this:
11712 @enumerate
11713 @item Rule #1: The wife is always correct
11714 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
11715 @end enumerate
11716
11717 The Tcl equal is this:
11718
11719 @enumerate
11720 @item Rule #1: Everything is a string
11721 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
11722 @end enumerate
11723
11724 As in the famous joke, the consequences of Rule #1 are profound. Once
11725 you understand Rule #1, you will understand Tcl.
11726
11727 @section Tcl Rule #1b
11728 There is a second pair of rules.
11729 @enumerate
11730 @item Rule #1: Control flow does not exist. Only commands
11731 @* For example: the classic FOR loop or IF statement is not a control
11732 flow item, they are commands, there is no such thing as control flow
11733 in Tcl.
11734 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
11735 @* Actually what happens is this: There are commands that by
11736 convention, act like control flow key words in other languages. One of
11737 those commands is the word ``for'', another command is ``if''.
11738 @end enumerate
11739
11740 @section Per Rule #1 - All Results are strings
11741 Every Tcl command results in a string. The word ``result'' is used
11742 deliberately. No result is just an empty string. Remember: @i{Rule #1 -
11743 Everything is a string}
11744
11745 @section Tcl Quoting Operators
11746 In life of a Tcl script, there are two important periods of time, the
11747 difference is subtle.
11748 @enumerate
11749 @item Parse Time
11750 @item Evaluation Time
11751 @end enumerate
11752
11753 The two key items here are how ``quoted things'' work in Tcl. Tcl has
11754 three primary quoting constructs, the [square-brackets] the
11755 @{curly-braces@} and ``double-quotes''
11756
11757 By now you should know $VARIABLES always start with a $DOLLAR
11758 sign. BTW: To set a variable, you actually use the command ``set'', as
11759 in ``set VARNAME VALUE'' much like the ancient BASIC language ``let x
11760 = 1'' statement, but without the equal sign.
11761
11762 @itemize @bullet
11763 @item @b{[square-brackets]}
11764 @* @b{[square-brackets]} are command substitutions. It operates much
11765 like Unix Shell `back-ticks`. The result of a [square-bracket]
11766 operation is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything is a
11767 string}. These two statements are roughly identical:
11768 @example
11769 # bash example
11770 X=`date`
11771 echo "The Date is: $X"
11772 # Tcl example
11773 set X [date]
11774 puts "The Date is: $X"
11775 @end example
11776 @item @b{``double-quoted-things''}
11777 @* @b{``double-quoted-things''} are just simply quoted
11778 text. $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are expanded in place - the
11779 result however is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything
11780 is a string}
11781 @example
11782 set x "Dinner"
11783 puts "It is now \"[date]\", $x is in 1 hour"
11784 @end example
11785 @item @b{@{Curly-Braces@}}
11786 @*@b{@{Curly-Braces@}} are magic: $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are
11787 parsed, but are NOT expanded or executed. @{Curly-Braces@} are like
11788 'single-quote' operators in BASH shell scripts, with the added
11789 feature: @{curly-braces@} can be nested, single quotes can not. @{@{@{this is
11790 nested 3 times@}@}@} NOTE: [date] is a bad example;
11791 at this writing, Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command.
11792 @end itemize
11793
11794 @section Consequences of Rule 1/2/3/4
11795
11796 The consequences of Rule 1 are profound.
11797
11798 @subsection Tokenisation & Execution.
11799
11800 Of course, whitespace, blank lines and #comment lines are handled in
11801 the normal way.
11802
11803 As a script is parsed, each (multi) line in the script file is
11804 tokenised and according to the quoting rules. After tokenisation, that
11805 line is immediately executed.
11806
11807 Multi line statements end with one or more ``still-open''
11808 @{curly-braces@} which - eventually - closes a few lines later.
11809
11810 @subsection Command Execution
11811
11812 Remember earlier: There are no ``control flow''
11813 statements in Tcl. Instead there are COMMANDS that simply act like
11814 control flow operators.
11815
11816 Commands are executed like this:
11817
11818 @enumerate
11819 @item Parse the next line into (argc) and (argv[]).
11820 @item Look up (argv[0]) in a table and call its function.
11821 @item Repeat until End Of File.
11822 @end enumerate
11823
11824 It sort of works like this:
11825 @example
11826 for(;;)@{
11827 ReadAndParse( &argc, &argv );
11828
11829 cmdPtr = LookupCommand( argv[0] );
11830
11831 (*cmdPtr->Execute)( argc, argv );
11832 @}
11833 @end example
11834
11835 When the command ``proc'' is parsed (which creates a procedure
11836 function) it gets 3 parameters on the command line. @b{1} the name of
11837 the proc (function), @b{2} the list of parameters, and @b{3} the body
11838 of the function. Not the choice of words: LIST and BODY. The PROC
11839 command stores these items in a table somewhere so it can be found by
11840 ``LookupCommand()''
11841
11842 @subsection The FOR command
11843
11844 The most interesting command to look at is the FOR command. In Tcl,
11845 the FOR command is normally implemented in C. Remember, FOR is a
11846 command just like any other command.
11847
11848 When the ascii text containing the FOR command is parsed, the parser
11849 produces 5 parameter strings, @i{(If in doubt: Refer to Rule #1)} they
11850 are:
11851
11852 @enumerate 0
11853 @item The ascii text 'for'
11854 @item The start text
11855 @item The test expression
11856 @item The next text
11857 @item The body text
11858 @end enumerate
11859
11860 Sort of reminds you of ``main( int argc, char **argv )'' does it not?
11861 Remember @i{Rule #1 - Everything is a string.} The key point is this:
11862 Often many of those parameters are in @{curly-braces@} - thus the
11863 variables inside are not expanded or replaced until later.
11864
11865 Remember that every Tcl command looks like the classic ``main( argc,
11866 argv )'' function in C. In JimTCL - they actually look like this:
11867
11868 @example
11869 int
11870 MyCommand( Jim_Interp *interp,
11871 int *argc,
11872 Jim_Obj * const *argvs );
11873 @end example
11874
11875 Real Tcl is nearly identical. Although the newer versions have
11876 introduced a byte-code parser and interpreter, but at the core, it
11877 still operates in the same basic way.
11878
11879 @subsection FOR command implementation
11880
11881 To understand Tcl it is perhaps most helpful to see the FOR
11882 command. Remember, it is a COMMAND not a control flow structure.
11883
11884 In Tcl there are two underlying C helper functions.
11885
11886 Remember Rule #1 - You are a string.
11887
11888 The @b{first} helper parses and executes commands found in an ascii
11889 string. Commands can be separated by semicolons, or newlines. While
11890 parsing, variables are expanded via the quoting rules.
11891
11892 The @b{second} helper evaluates an ascii string as a numerical
11893 expression and returns a value.
11894
11895 Here is an example of how the @b{FOR} command could be
11896 implemented. The pseudo code below does not show error handling.
11897 @example
11898 void Execute_AsciiString( void *interp, const char *string );
11899
11900 int Evaluate_AsciiExpression( void *interp, const char *string );
11901
11902 int
11903 MyForCommand( void *interp,
11904 int argc,
11905 char **argv )
11906 @{
11907 if( argc != 5 )@{
11908 SetResult( interp, "WRONG number of parameters");
11909 return ERROR;
11910 @}
11911
11912 // argv[0] = the ascii string just like C
11913
11914 // Execute the start statement.
11915 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[1] );
11916
11917 // Top of loop test
11918 for(;;)@{
11919 i = Evaluate_AsciiExpression(interp, argv[2]);
11920 if( i == 0 )
11921 break;
11922
11923 // Execute the body
11924 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[3] );
11925
11926 // Execute the LOOP part
11927 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[4] );
11928 @}
11929
11930 // Return no error
11931 SetResult( interp, "" );
11932 return SUCCESS;
11933 @}
11934 @end example
11935
11936 Every other command IF, WHILE, FORMAT, PUTS, EXPR, everything works
11937 in the same basic way.
11938
11939 @section OpenOCD Tcl Usage
11940
11941 @subsection source and find commands
11942 @b{Where:} In many configuration files
11943 @* Example: @b{ source [find FILENAME] }
11944 @*Remember the parsing rules
11945 @enumerate
11946 @item The @command{find} command is in square brackets,
11947 and is executed with the parameter FILENAME. It should find and return
11948 the full path to a file with that name; it uses an internal search path.
11949 The RESULT is a string, which is substituted into the command line in
11950 place of the bracketed @command{find} command.
11951 (Don't try to use a FILENAME which includes the "#" character.
11952 That character begins Tcl comments.)
11953 @item The @command{source} command is executed with the resulting filename;
11954 it reads a file and executes as a script.
11955 @end enumerate
11956 @subsection format command
11957 @b{Where:} Generally occurs in numerous places.
11958 @* Tcl has no command like @b{printf()}, instead it has @b{format}, which is really more like
11959 @b{sprintf()}.
11960 @b{Example}
11961 @example
11962 set x 6
11963 set y 7
11964 puts [format "The answer: %d" [expr $x * $y]]
11965 @end example
11966 @enumerate
11967 @item The SET command creates 2 variables, X and Y.
11968 @item The double [nested] EXPR command performs math
11969 @* The EXPR command produces numerical result as a string.
11970 @* Refer to Rule #1
11971 @item The format command is executed, producing a single string
11972 @* Refer to Rule #1.
11973 @item The PUTS command outputs the text.
11974 @end enumerate
11975 @subsection Body or Inlined Text
11976 @b{Where:} Various TARGET scripts.
11977 @example
11978 #1 Good
11979 proc someproc @{@} @{
11980 ... multiple lines of stuff ...
11981 @}
11982 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO someproc
11983 #2 Good - no variables
11984 $_TARGETNAME configure -event foo "this ; that;"
11985 #3 Good Curly Braces
11986 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO @{
11987 puts "Time: [date]"
11988 @}
11989 #4 DANGER DANGER DANGER
11990 $_TARGETNAME configure -event foo "puts \"Time: [date]\""
11991 @end example
11992 @enumerate
11993 @item The $_TARGETNAME is an OpenOCD variable convention.
11994 @*@b{$_TARGETNAME} represents the last target created, the value changes
11995 each time a new target is created. Remember the parsing rules. When
11996 the ascii text is parsed, the @b{$_TARGETNAME} becomes a simple string,
11997 the name of the target which happens to be a TARGET (object)
11998 command.
11999 @item The 2nd parameter to the @option{-event} parameter is a TCBODY
12000 @*There are 4 examples:
12001 @enumerate
12002 @item The TCLBODY is a simple string that happens to be a proc name
12003 @item The TCLBODY is several simple commands separated by semicolons
12004 @item The TCLBODY is a multi-line @{curly-brace@} quoted string
12005 @item The TCLBODY is a string with variables that get expanded.
12006 @end enumerate
12007
12008 In the end, when the target event FOO occurs the TCLBODY is
12009 evaluated. Method @b{#1} and @b{#2} are functionally identical. For
12010 Method @b{#3} and @b{#4} it is more interesting. What is the TCLBODY?
12011
12012 Remember the parsing rules. In case #3, @{curly-braces@} mean the
12013 $VARS and [square-brackets] are expanded later, when the EVENT occurs,
12014 and the text is evaluated. In case #4, they are replaced before the
12015 ``Target Object Command'' is executed. This occurs at the same time
12016 $_TARGETNAME is replaced. In case #4 the date will never
12017 change. @{BTW: [date] is a bad example; at this writing,
12018 Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command@}
12019 @end enumerate
12020 @subsection Global Variables
12021 @b{Where:} You might discover this when writing your own procs @* In
12022 simple terms: Inside a PROC, if you need to access a global variable
12023 you must say so. See also ``upvar''. Example:
12024 @example
12025 proc myproc @{ @} @{
12026 set y 0 #Local variable Y
12027 global x #Global variable X
12028 puts [format "X=%d, Y=%d" $x $y]
12029 @}
12030 @end example
12031 @section Other Tcl Hacks
12032 @b{Dynamic variable creation}
12033 @example
12034 # Dynamically create a bunch of variables.
12035 for @{ set x 0 @} @{ $x < 32 @} @{ set x [expr $x + 1]@} @{
12036 # Create var name
12037 set vn [format "BIT%d" $x]
12038 # Make it a global
12039 global $vn
12040 # Set it.
12041 set $vn [expr (1 << $x)]
12042 @}
12043 @end example
12044 @b{Dynamic proc/command creation}
12045 @example
12046 # One "X" function - 5 uart functions.
12047 foreach who @{A B C D E@}
12048 proc [format "show_uart%c" $who] @{ @} "show_UARTx $who"
12049 @}
12050 @end example
12051
12052 @node License
12053 @appendix The GNU Free Documentation License.
12054 @include fdl.texi
12055
12056 @node OpenOCD Concept Index
12057 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
12058 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
12059 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
12060 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
12061 @unnumbered OpenOCD Concept Index
12062
12063 @printindex cp
12064
12065 @node Command and Driver Index
12066 @unnumbered Command and Driver Index
12067 @printindex fn
12068
12069 @bye

Linking to existing account procedure

If you already have an account and want to add another login method you MUST first sign in with your existing account and then change URL to read https://review.openocd.org/login/?link to get to this page again but this time it'll work for linking. Thank you.

SSH host keys fingerprints

1024 SHA256:YKx8b7u5ZWdcbp7/4AeXNaqElP49m6QrwfXaqQGJAOk gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (DSA)
384 SHA256:jHIbSQa4REvwCFG4cq5LBlBLxmxSqelQPem/EXIrxjk gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
521 SHA256:UAOPYkU9Fjtcao0Ul/Rrlnj/OsQvt+pgdYSZ4jOYdgs gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:A13M5QlnozFOvTllybRZH6vm7iSt0XLxbA48yfc2yfY gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:spYMBqEYoAOtK7yZBrcwE8ZpYt6b68Cfh9yEVetvbXg gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ED25519)
+--[ED25519 256]--+
|=..              |
|+o..   .         |
|*.o   . .        |
|+B . . .         |
|Bo. = o S        |
|Oo.+ + =         |
|oB=.* = . o      |
| =+=.+   + E     |
|. .=o   . o      |
+----[SHA256]-----+
2048 SHA256:0Onrb7/PHjpo6iVZ7xQX2riKN83FJ3KGU0TvI0TaFG4 gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (RSA)